You are on page 1of 454

Nothing contained in this manual shall be deemed to be, and this manual does not constitute, a warranty of,

or representation with respect to, any of the equipment covered. This manual is subject to change without notice and NEC Infrontia Asia Pacific Sdn Bhd has no obligation to provide any updates or corrections to this manual. Further, NEC Infrontia Asia Pacific Sdn Bhd also reserves the right, without prior notice, to make changes in equipment design or components as it deems appropriate. No representation is made that this manual is complete or accurate in all respects and NEC Infrontia shall not be liable for any errors or omissions. In no event shall NEC Infrontia Asia Pacific Sdn Bhd be liable for any incidental or consequential damages in connection with the use of this manual. This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied or reproduced without prior written consent of NEC Infrontia Asia Pacific Sdn Bhd. 2004 by NEC Infrontia Asia Pacific Sdn Bhd Printed in Malaysia All Rights Reserved.

Table of Contents
Introduction to Programming
BEFORE YOU START PROGRAMMING ................................................................... 1

Program 10 : System Configuration Setup


10-01 10-02 10-03 10-04 10-05 10-06 10-07 10-08 10-09 10-12 10-13 10-14 10-15 10-16 10-17 10-18 10-19 10-20 10-21 10-23 10-24 10-25 10-28 10-29 10-30 10-33 11-01 11-02 11-04 11-06 11-07 11-08 11-09 11-10 11-11 11-12 11-15 11-16 12-01 12-02 12-03 12-04 12-05 12-06 12-07 TIME AND DATE .................................................................................... 13 LOCATION SETUP ................................................................................. 14 PCB SETUP......................................................................................... 15 MUSIC ON HOLD SETUP........................................................................ 19 -NOT USEDISDN BRI SETUP ................................................................................ 21 CONVERSATION RECORD CIRCUITS....................................................... 22 PRE-RINGING SETUP ........................................................................... 23 DTMF AND DIAL TONE CIRCUIT SETUP ................................................. 24 EXIFU NETWORK SETUP ..................................................................... 25 IN-DHCP SERVER SETUP .................................................................... 27 MANAGED NETWORK SETUP................................................................. 28 CLIENT INFORMATION SETUP ................................................................ 31 OPTION INFORMATION SETUP ............................................................... 34 H.323 GATEKEEPER SETUP.................................................................. 36 H.323 ALIAS ADDRESS SETUP .............................................................. 38 VOIPU DSP RESOURCE SELECTION..................................................... 39 LAN SETUP FOR EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT ............................................... 40 EXIFU HARDWARE SETUP ................................................................... 41 H.323 SYSTEM INTERCONNECTION SETUP ............................................ 42 DAYLIGHT SAVING SETUP ..................................................................... 43 GATEWAY PREFIX SETUP ...................................................................... 45 SIP SYSTEM INFORMATION SETUP ........................................................ 46 SIP SERVER INFORMATION SETUP ........................................................ 47 SIP AUTHENTICATION INFORMATION SETUP ........................................... 49 SIP REGISTRAR/PROXY INFORMATION BASIC SETUP ............................. 50 SYSTEM NUMBERING ............................................................................ 51 EXTENSION NUMBERING ....................................................................... 54 VIRTUAL EXTENSION NUMBERING.......................................................... 56 ACI EXTENSION NUMBERING ................................................................ 57 DEPARTMENT GROUP PILOT NUMBERS .................................................. 58 ACI GROUP PILOT NUMBERS ................................................................ 59 TRUNK ACCESS CODE .......................................................................... 60 SERVICE CODE SETUP (FOR SYSTEM ADMINISTRATOR) .......................... 62 SERVICE CODE SETUP (FOR SETUP/ENTRY) .......................................... 64 SERVICE CODE SETUP (FOR SERVICE ACCESS) ..................................... 66 SERVICE CODE SETUP (FOR SPECIAL ACCESS)...................................... 69 ONE-DIGIT SERVICE CODE SETUP ........................................................ 71 NIGHT MODE FUNCTION SETUP ............................................................ 73 AUTOMATIC NIGHT SERVICE PATTERNS ................................................. 74 WEEKLY NIGHT SERVICE SWITCHING .................................................... 77 HOLIDAY NIGHT SERVICE SWITCHING .................................................... 79 NIGHT MODE GROUP ASSIGNMENT FOR EXTENSIONS ............................ 80 NIGHT MODE GROUP ASSIGNMENT FOR TRUNKS ................................... 81 TEXT DATA FOR NIGHT MODE ............................................................... 82

Program 11 : System Numbering

Program 12 : Night Mode Setup

Programming Manual

Table of Contents
Program 13 : Abbreviated Dialing
13-01 13-02 13-03 13-04 13-05 13-06 14-01 14-02 14-04 14-05 14-06 14-07 14-08 14-09 14-11 15-01 15-02 15-03 15-05 15-06 15-07 15-08 15-09 15-10 15-11 15-12 15-13 ABBREVIATED DIALING FUNCTION SETUP .............................................. 85 GROUP ABBREVIATED DIALING BINS ...................................................... 86 ABBREVIATED DIALING GROUP ASSIGNMENT FOR EXTENSIONS .............. 87 ABBREVIATED DIALING NUMBER AND NAME ........................................... 88 ABBREVIATED DIALING TRUNK GROUP .................................................. 89 STATION ABBREVIATED DIALING NUMBER AND NAME .............................. 90 BASIC TRUNK DATA SETUP ................................................................... 91 ANALOGUE TRUNK DATA SETUP ............................................................ 95 BEHIND PBX SETUP ............................................................................ 97 TRUNK GROUPS................................................................................... 98 TRUNK GROUP ROUTING ...................................................................... 99 TRUNK ACCESS MAP SETUP ............................................................... 101 MUSIC ON HOLD SOURCE FOR TRUNKS ............................................... 103 CONVERSATION RECORDING DESTINATION FOR TRUNKS ...................... 104 CONVERSATION RECORDING DESTINATION FOR TRUNKS ...................... 105 BASIC EXTENSION DATA SETUP .......................................................... 107 MULTI-LINE TELEPHONE BASIC DATA SETUP ........................................ 108 SINGLE LINE TELEPHONE BASIC DATA SETUP ...................................... 112 IP PHONE TERMINAL BASIC DATA SETUP ............................................. 114 TRUNK ACCESS MAP FOR EXTENSIONS ............................................... 116 PROGRAMMING FUNCTION KEY........................................................... 117 INCOMING VIRTUAL EXTENSION RING TONE SETUP .............................. 123 VIRTUAL EXTENSION RING ASSIGNMENT ............................................. 125 INCOMING VIRTUAL EXTENSION RING TONE ORDER SETUP .................. 126 VIRTUAL EXTENSION DELAYED RING ASSIGNMENT ............................... 127 CONVERSATION RECORDING DESTINATION FOR EXTENSIONS ............... 128 LOOP KEYS........................................................................................ 132

Program 14 : Trunk Basic Setup

Program 15 : Extension Basic Setup

Program 16 : Department Group Setup


16-01 EXTENSION (DEPARTMENT) GROUP BASIC DATA SETUP ....................... 133 16-02 DEPARTMENT GROUP ASSIGNMENT FOR EXTENSIONS .......................... 135 16-03 SECONDARY DEPARTMENT GROUP ..................................................... 136

Program 20 : System Option Setup


20-01 20-02 20-03 20-04 20-05 20-06 20-07 20-08 20-09 20-10 20-11 20-12 20-13 20-14 20-15 20-16 20-17 20-18 20-19 SYSTEM OPTIONS .............................................................................. 137 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR KEY TELEPHONES ........................................... 139 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR SINGLE LINE TELEPHONES ............................... 141 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR VIRTUAL EXTENSIONS ...................................... 143 -NOT USEDCLASS OF SERVICE FOR EXTENSIONS ................................................. 145 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (ADMINISTRATOR LEVEL) ........................ 146 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (OUTGOING CALL SERVICE).................... 148 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (INCOMING CALL SERVICE) ..................... 150 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (ANSWER SERVICE) ............................... 152 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (HOLD/TRANSFER SERVICE) ................... 154 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (CHARGING COST SERVICE) ................... 156 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS (SUPPLEMENTARY SERVICE)................... 157 CLASS OF SERVICE OPTIONS FOR DISA/E&M..................................... 160 RING CYCLE SETUP ........................................................................... 162 SELECTABLE DISPLAY MESSAGES ....................................................... 164 OPERATORS EXTENSION.................................................................... 167 SERVICE TONE TIMERS ...................................................................... 168 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR CALLER ID ...................................................... 170

Programming Manual

II

Table of Contents
20-20 20-21 20-23 20-25 20-26 21-01 21-02 21-03 21-04 21-05 21-06 21-07 21-08 21-09 21-10 21-11 21-12 21-13 21-14 21-15 21-17 21-18 21-19 22-01 22-02 22-03 22-04 22-05 22-06 22-07 22-08 22-09 22-10 22-11 22-12 22-13 22-14 22-15 23-01 23-02 23-03 23-04 24-01 24-02 24-03 24-04 24-05 24-06 24-07 MESSAGE SETUP FOR NON-CALLER ID DATA ...................................... 171 SYSTEM OPTION FOR LONG CONVERSATION ....................................... 172 SYSTEM OPTION FOR CTI SERVICE..................................................... 173 ISDN OPTIONS .................................................................................. 174 MULTIPLIER FOR CHARGE COST ......................................................... 176 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR OUTGOING CALLS............................................ 177 TRUNK GROUP ROUTING FOR EXTENSIONS ......................................... 179 TRUNK GROUP ROUTING FOR TRUNKS ................................................ 180 TOLL RESTRICTION CLASS FOR EXTENSIONS ....................................... 181 TOLL RESTRICTION CLASS.................................................................. 182 TOLL RESTRICTION TABLE DATA SETUP ............................................... 185 TOLL RESTRICTION OVERRIDE PASSWORD SETUP ............................... 188 REPEAT DIAL SETUP .......................................................................... 187 DIAL BLOCK SETUP ............................................................................ 190 DIAL BLOCK RESTRICTION CLASS PER EXTENSIONS ............................ 191 EXTENSION RINGDOWN (HOTLINE) ASSIGNMENT .................................. 192 ISDN CALLING PARTY NUMBER SETUP FOR TRUNKS ........................... 193 ISDN CALLING PARTY NUMBER SETUP FOR EXTENSIONS .................... 194 WALKING TOLL RESTRICTION PASSWORD SETUP ................................. 195 INDIVIDUAL TRUNK GROUP ROUTING FOR EXTENSIONS ........................ 196 IP TRUNK(H.323/SIP) CALLING PARTY NUMBER SETUP FOR TRUNKS .. 197 IP TRUNK(H.323) CALLING PARTY NUMBER SETUP FOR EXTENSIONS .. 198 IP TRUNK(SIP) CALLING PARTY NUMBER SETUP FOR EXTENSIONS ...... 199 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR INCOMING CALLS ............................................. 201 INCOMING CALL TRUNK SETUP ........................................................... 203 TRUNK RING TONE SETUP .................................................................. 205 INCOMING EXTENSION RINGING GROUP ASSIGNMEN ............................ 206 IRG ASSIGNMENT FOR NORMAL RING TRUNK ...................................... 207 NORMAL INCOMING RING MODE .......................................................... 208 DIL ASSIGNMENT ............................................................................... 209 DIL/IRG NO ANSWER DESTINATION .................................................... 210 DID BASIC DATA SETUP ..................................................................... 211 DID TRANSLATION TABLE SETUP ........................................................ 212 DID TRANSLATION NUMBER CONVERSION ........................................... 215 DID INTERCEPT RING GROUP ............................................................. 218 DID TRUNK GROUP TO TRANSLATION TABLE ASSIGNMENTS ................. 220 VRS WAITING DELAYED MESSAGE FOR IRG ....................................... 221 VRS WAITING MESSAGE FOR DEPARTMENT GROUP ............................ 223 -NOT USEDCALL PICKUP GROUPS ....................................................................... 226 UNIVERSAL ANSWER/AUTO ANSWER ................................................... 227 RINGING LINE PREFERENCE FOR VIRTUAL EXTENSIONS ....................... 228 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR HOLD .............................................................. 229 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR TRANSFER ...................................................... 231 PARK GROUP ..................................................................................... 233 AUTO TRUNK-TO-TRUNK TRANSFER TARGET SETUP ............................ 234 DEPARTMENT GROUP TRANSFER TARGET SETUP ................................ 235 FIXED CALL FORWARDING .................................................................. 236 FIXED CALL FORWARDING OFF-PREMISE ............................................ 238

Program 21 : Outgoing Call Setup

Program 22 : Incoming Call Setup

Program 23 : Answer Features Setup

Program 24 : Hold/Transfer Setup

III

Programming Manual

Table of Contents
Program 25 : DID/DISA Setup
25-01 25-02 25-03 25-04 25-05 25-06 25-07 25-08 25-09 25-10 25-11 25-12 25-13 26-01 26-02 26-03 26-04 26-05 26-06 26-07 26-08 26-09 30-01 30-02 30-03 30-04 30-05 31-01 31-02 31-03 31-04 31-05 31-06 31-07 31-08 DID/DISA LINE BASIC DATA SETUP .................................................... 239 DID/DISA TALKIE............................................................................... 240 DID/DISA TRANSFER RING WITH INCORRECT DIALING ......................... 241 DID/DISA TRANSFER RING GROUP WITH NO ANSWER/BUSY .............. 242 DID/DISA ERROR MESSAGE ASSIGNMENT .......................................... 243 DID/DISA ONE DIGIT CODE ATTENDANT SETUP .................................. 244 SYSTEM TIMER FOR DID/DISA........................................................... 246 DISA USER ID SETUP ........................................................................ 248 CLASS OF SERVICE FOR DISA USERS ................................................. 249 TRUNK GROUP ROUTING FOR DISA.................................................... 250 DISA TOLL RESTRICTION CLASS ......................................................... 251 ALTERNATE TRUNK GROUP ROUTING FOR DISA.................................. 252 SYSTEM OPTION FOR DISA................................................................ 253 AUTOMATIC ROUTE SELECTION SERVICE ............................................ 255 DIAL ANALYSIS TABLE FOR ARS.......................................................... 257 ARS DIAL TREATMENT ....................................................................... 259 ARS CLASS OF SERVICE .................................................................... 260 LCR CARRIER TABLE ......................................................................... 261 LCR AUTHORIZATION CODE TABLE ..................................................... 262 LCR COST CENTRE CODE TABLE ....................................................... 263 LCR MANUAL OVERRIDE ACCESS CODE TABLE ................................... 264 LCR MANUAL OVERRIDE EXEMPTION TABLE ....................................... 265 -NOT USEDDSS CONSOLE EXTENSION ASSIGNMENT ............................................ 268 DSS CONSOLE KEY ASSIGNMENT ....................................................... 269 -NOT USEDDSS CONSOLE LAMP TABLE ............................................................... 275 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR INTERNAL/EXTERNAL PAGING ........................... 277 INTERNAL PAGING GROUP ASSIGNMENT .............................................. 279 INTERNAL PAGING GROUP SETTINGS .................................................. 280 EXTERNAL PAGING ZONE GROUP ........................................................ 282 INCOMING RING TONE AUDIBLE ON EXTERNAL SPEAKER ...................... 283 EXTERNAL SPEAKER CONTROL ........................................................... 284 COMBINED PAGING ASSIGNMENT ........................................................ 285 BGM ON EXTERNAL PAGING ............................................................... 286

Program 26 : ARS Service & Least Cost Routing

Program 30 : DSS/DLS Console

Program 31 : External Speaker and Internal Paging

Program 32 : Door Box Setup


32-01 DOOR BOX TIMER .............................................................................. 287 32-02 DOOR BOX RING ASSIGNMENT ........................................................... 288 32-03 DOOR BOX BASIC SETUP ................................................................... 289

Program 33 : Analogue Interface Ports Setup


33-01 ANALOGUE INTERFACE PORT TYPE SETUP .......................................... 291 33-02 ANALOGUE INTERFACE GROUP ASSIGNMENT ....................................... 292

Program 34 : Tie Line Setup


34-01 34-02 34-03 34-04 34-05 E&M TIE LINE BASIC SETUP ............................................................... 293 E&M TIE LINE CLASS OF SERVICE ...................................................... 294 TRUNK GROUP ROUTING FOR E&M TIE LINES ..................................... 295 E&M TIE LINE TOLL RESTRICTION CLASS ............................................ 296 TIE LINE OUTGOING CALL RESTRICTION .............................................. 297

Programming Manual

IV

Table of Contents
34-06 ADD/DELETE DIGIT FOR E&M TIE LINE................................................ 299 34-07 E&M TIE LINE TIMER.......................................................................... 300 34-08 TOLL RESTRICTION DATA FOR E&M TIE LINES ..................................... 301

Program 35 : SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-01 35-02 35-03 35-04 35-05 35-06 40-01 40-02 40-03 40-04 40-05 40-06 40-07 40-08 40-09 40-10 40-11 44-01 44-02 44-03 44-04 44-05 44-06 44-07 44-08 44-09 44-10 SMDR OPTIONS ................................................................................ 303 SMDR OUTPUT OPTIONS ................................................................... 305 SMDR PORT ASSIGNMENT FOR TRUNK GROUP ................................... 308 SMDR PORT ASSIGNMENT FOR DEPARTMENT GROUP ......................... 309 ACCOUNT CODE SETUP...................................................................... 310 VERIFIED ACCOUNT CODE TABLE ........................................................ 312 VOICE MAIL BASIC SETUP .................................................................. 313 MAILBOX SETUP................................................................................. 314 MESSAGE RECORDING SETUP ............................................................ 315 LIVE RECORDING SETUP .................................................................... 316 CALL INFORMATION SETUP ................................................................. 317 VOICE MAIL AUTOMATED ATTENDANT DATA SETUP ............................... 318 VOICE PROMPT LANGUAGE ASSIGNMENT FOR VOICE MAIL ................... 319 VOICE PROMPT LANGUAGE ASSIGNMENT FOR EACH MAIL BOX ............. 320 VOICE MAIL MULTIPLE ADDRESS GROUP SETUP .................................. 321 VOICE ANNOUNCEMENT SERVICE OPTION ........................................... 322 PRE-AMBLE MESSAGE ASSIGNMENT ................................................... 324 SYSTEM OPTIONS FOR ARS/F-ROUTE ................................................ 325 DIAL ANALYSIS TABLE FOR ARS/F-ROUTE ACCESS .............................. 326 DIAL ANALYZE EXTENSION TABLE ........................................................ 328 ARS/F-ROUTE SELECTION FOR TIME SCHEDULE................................. 330 ARS/F-ROUTE TABLE ........................................................................ 331 ADDITIONAL DIAL TABLE ..................................................................... 333 GAIN TABLE FOR F-ROUTE ACCESS .................................................... 334 TIME SCHEDULE FOR ARS/F-ROUTE .................................................. 336 WEEKLY SCHEDULE FOR ARS/F-ROUTE ............................................. 338 HOLIDAY SCHEDULE FOR ARS/F-ROUTE ............................................. 339

Program 40 : Voice Mail Setup

Program 44 : ARS/F-Route Setup

Program 45 : Voice Mail Integration


45-01 VOICE MAIL INTEGRATION OPTIONS .................................................... 341 45-02 NSL OPTION SETUP........................................................................... 343 45-03 NSL TIMER SETUP ............................................................................. 344

Program 80 : Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01 80-02 80-03 80-04 80-05 81-01 81-02 81-03 81-04 81-05 81-06 81-07 81-09 SERVICE TONE SETUP ........................................................................ 345 DTMF TONE SETUP ........................................................................... 351 DTMF TONE RECEIVER SETUP ........................................................... 352 CALL PROGRESS TONE DETECTOR SETUP .......................................... 354 DATA FORMAT FOR SMDR AND SYSTEM REPORTS .............................. 356 ANALOGUE TRUNK INITIAL DATA SETUP ............................................... 357 DIOPU INITIAL DATA SETUP ............................................................... 359 TLIU INITIAL DATA SETUP ................................................................... 361 ISDN BRI LAYER 1(T-POINT) INITIAL DATA SETUP ............................... 363 ISDN BRI LAYER 2(T-POINT) INITIAL DATA SETUP ............................... 364 ISDN BRI LAYER 3(T-POINT) TIMER SETUP ........................................ 365 CODEC FILTER SETUP FOR ANALOGUE TRUNK PORTS ....................... 367 ANALOGUE TRUNK CODEC FILTER SETUP ......................................... 368

Program 81 : Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk

Programming Manual

Table of Contents
Program 82 : Basic Hardware Setup for Extension 82-01 -NOT USED82-02 KEY TELEPHONE LED PARTTERN SETUP............................................. 372 82-03 -NOT USED82-04 ANALOGUE STATION INITIAL DATA SETUP ............................................. 375 82-05 ISDN BRI LAYER 2(S-POINT) INITIAL DATA SETUP ............................... 377 82-06 ISDN BRI LAYER 3(S-POINT) TIMER SETUP........................................ 378 82-07 CODEC FILTER SETUP FOR ANALOGUE STATION PORTS ..................... 380 82-03 -NOT USED82-09 ANALOGUE STATION CODEC FILTER DATA SETUP............................... 382

Program 84 : Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-01 84-02 84-04 84-05 84-06 84-09 84-10 84-12 84-13 84-14 84-15 84-16 84-17 84-18 84-19 84-20 90-01 90-02 90-03 90-04 90-05 90-06 90-07 90-08 90-09 90-10 90-11 90-12 90-13 90-16 90-17 90-19 90-20 90-21 90-23 90-24 90-25 90-26 90-30 CODEC INFORMATION BASIC SETUP .................................................. 383 H.225, H.245 INFORMATION BASIC SETUP .......................................... 388 VOIPU PCB DHCP SERVER MODE SETUP ......................................... 390 VOIPU IP ADDRESS SETUP ................................................................ 391 VOIPU SETUP ................................................................................... 392 VLAN SETUP..................................................................................... 394 TOS SETUP ....................................................................................... 395 H.323 PHONE CODEC INFORMATION BASIC SETUP ............................ 397 SIP TRUNK INFORMATION BASIC SETUP .............................................. 400 SIP TRUNK BASIC INFORMATION SETUP .............................................. 403 H.323/SIP PHONE KEEP ALIVE SETUP ................................................ 404 VOIP LIMITER CONTROL GAIN SETUP ................................................. 405 VOIPU ECHO CANCELLER CONTROL SETUP(IN LEVEL) ....................... 406 VOIPU ECHO CANCELLER CONTROL SETUP(MF LEVEL)...................... 408 SIP EXTENSION CODEC INFORMATION BASIC SETUP ......................... 409 SIP EXTENSION BASIC INFORMATION SETUP ....................................... 412 INSTALL DATE .................................................................................... 413 SETTING THE PROGRAMMING PASSWORD............................................ 414 SAVE DATA ........................................................................................ 416 LOAD DATA ........................................................................................ 417 SLOT CONTROL ................................................................................. 418 TRUNK CONTROL ............................................................................... 419 EXTENSION CONTROL ........................................................................ 420 SYSTEM RESET.................................................................................. 421 AUTOMATIC SYSTEM RESET TIME ....................................................... 422 SYSTEM ALARM SETUP ...................................................................... 423 SYSTEM ALARM REPORT SETUP ......................................................... 425 SYSTEM ALARM OUTPUT .................................................................... 427 SYSTEM INFORMATION OUTPUT .......................................................... 428 MAIN SOFTWARE INFORMATION .......................................................... 429 FIRMWARE INFORMATION .................................................................... 430 DIAL BLOCK RELEASE ........................................................................ 431 TRAFFIC REPORT DATA SETUP............................................................ 432 TRAFFIC REPORT OUTPUT .................................................................. 433 DELETING REGISTRATION OF IP TELEPHONES ..................................... 434 SYSTEM ALARM REPORT NOTIFICATION TIME SETUP ........................... 435 SYSTEM ALARM REPORT CC MAIL SETUP ........................................... 436 SYSTEM DATA PROGRAMMING LEVEL ASSIGNMENT .............................. 437 VOIPU FIRMWARE INFORMATION ........................................................ 438

Program 90 : Maintenance Program

Program 92 : Copy Program


92-01 COPY COMMAND ................................................................................ 439 92-02 DELETE ALL EXTENSION NUMBER ....................................................... 442

Programming Manual

VI

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming Before Reading This Manual
This Manual provides you with detailed information about the system programs. By changing a program, you change the way the feature associated with that program works. In this section, you find out about each program, the features that the program affects and how to enter the program data into system memory. Caution Do not start customizing your system without first reading Software Manual.

When you want to customize a feature, find it in Software Manual and learn about it. Software Manual will tell you what programs you have to change to get the operation you want. Then, look the program up in this section if you have any questions about how to enter the data.

How to Use This Manual


This Manual lists each program in numerical order. For example, Program 10-01 is at the beginning of the section and Program 92-02 is at the end. The information on each program is subdivided into the following headings: Description describes what the program options control. The Default Settings for each program are also included. When you first install the system, it uses the Default Setting for all programs. Along with the Description are the Conditions which describe any limits or special considerations that may apply to the program. The reverse type (Black on white) symbol shows on the page header is the programs access level. You can only use the program if your access level meets or exceeds the level the program requires. Refer to How to Enter the Programming Mode (page 3) for a list of the systems access levels and passwords. Feature Cross Reference provides you with a table of all the features affected by the program. Youll want to keep the referenced features in mind when you change a program. Customizing a feature may have an effect on another feature that you didnt intend.

Telephone Programming Instructions shows you how to enter the programs data into system memory. For example: 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. 15-07-01. 15-07-01 TEL200 KY01 = *01
tells you to enter the programming mode, dial 150701 from the telephone dial pad. After you do, youll see the message 15-07-01 TEL200 on the first line of the telephone display. This indicates the program number (15-07), item number (01), and that the options are being set for extension 200. The second row of the display KY01 = *01 indicates that Key 01 is being programmed with the entry of *01. To learn how to enter the programming mode, see How to Enter the Programming Mode (page 3).

-1-

Programming Manual

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming Location of Controls
One of the following Display Key Telephone is required for the Programming. 6TXD Key Telephone 12TXD Key Telephone

12TXD Telephone

Liquid Crystal Display Indicator CHECK Key CLEAR Key Programmable Function Keys LND Key OPAC Key DC Key CALL Key TRFR Key

Speaker

FLASH Key SPK Key DND/CONF Key HOLD Key MIC Key Microphone Dial Keys VOL. Keys Handset

Programming Manual

-2-

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming How to Enter the Programming Mode
Depending on the mode of programming, the system may allow more than one person in the programming mode at one time. With telephone programming, two people can program simultaneously. Using the PC Program, only one person is allowed in programming. If the same program number is being defined simultaneously, the last changes made to the program will be accepted. To enter the programming mode: 1. Go to any working display telephone. In a newly installed system, use extension 200 (port 1). 2. Do not lift the handset. 3. Press SPK. 4. # * # * 5. Dial the system password + HOLD. Refer to the following table for the default system passwords. To change the passwords, use Program 90-02. Caution It is NOT recommended to change these data unnecessarily. The worst case may happen is that there is no normal way to go into program mode again, if the digits entered is forgotten, then. Level 2(IN) 3(SA) Program at this Level All programs in this Manual not listed below for SA and SB 10-01,10-02,10-12,10-13,10-14,10-15,10-16,10-17,10-18,10-23,10-24,10-25, 10-28,10-29,12-02,12-03,12-04,15-01,15-07,15-09,15-10,15-11,20-16,21-07, 21-14,22-04,22-11,25-08,30-03,32-02,40-02,45-02,45-03,90-03,90-04,90-06, 90-07,90-19 13-04,13-05,13-06

Password 12345678 0000

9999

4(SB)

How to Exit the Programming Mode


To exit the programming mode: When you are done programming, you must be out of a programs options to exit (pressing the DC key will exit the programs option). 1. Press DC key to exit the programs options, if needed.

Program Mode

2. Press SPK. You see, "SavingSystemData" if changes to were to the systems programming. 3. The display shows "CompleteDataSave" when completed and will exit the phone to an idle mode. To save a customers database, a blank Compact Flash Memory Card is required. Insert the card into the EXIFU-A1 and, using Program 90-03, save the software to the Compact Flash Memory Card. (Program 90-04 is used to reload the customer data if necessary.) Note that a Compact Flash Memory Card can only hold one customer database. Each database to be saved will require its own separate card.
Program Mode

-3-

Programming Manual

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming Using Keys to Move Around in the Programs
Once you enter the programming mode, use the keys in the following chart to enter data, edit data and move around in the menus.

Keys for Entering Data Use this Key.. 0-9, , #


HOLD CONF DC Enter data into a program. Complete the programming step you just made (like pressing Enter on a PC keyboard). When a program entry displays, press HOLD to bypass the entry without changing it. Delete the entry to the left (like pressing Backspace on a PC keyboard). Exit one step at the time from the program window currently being viewed. For example, if youre programming item 5 in 15-03, pressing DC will allow you to enter a new option in program 15-03. Pressing DC again will allow you to select a new program in the 15- series. Pressing DC a third time will allow you to enter a new program beginning with 1. Pressing DC one last time will bring you to the beginning program display, allowing you to enter any program number. Switch TEL(extension), Trunk(line), etc. being programmed by pressing FLASH. The cursor moves up to the upper row of the display. Pressing FLASH again moves the cursor back to the lower row. Scroll backward through a list of entry numbers (e.g., from extension 10 to 11, 13, etc.) or through entries in a table (e.g., Common Permit Table). If you enter data and then press this key, the system accepts the data before scrolling forward. Scroll forward through a list of entry numbers (e.g., from extension 200 to 201, 203, etc.) or through entries in a table (e.g., Common Permit Table). If you enter data and then press this key, the system accepts the data before scrolling backward. Change an alphabetic character / number Delete all digits Move the cursor to the left Move the cursor to the right Exit the Programming Mode

When you want to ..

FLASH

VOL.UP

VOL.DOWN

CHECK CLEAR LND OPAC SPK

Programming Manual

-4-

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming Programming Names and Text Messages
Several programs (e.g., Program 20-16: Selectable Display Messages) require you to enter text. Use the following chart when entering and editing text. When using the keypad digits, press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press key 2 three times. Press the key six times display the lower case letter.

Keys for Entering Name and Text Message Use this keypad digit
1 Enter characters: 1 @ [ ] ^ _ ` { | } Press repeatedly to scroll through the list. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters A-C, a-c, 2. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters D-F, a-f, 3. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters G-I, g-i, 4. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters J-L, j-l, 5. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters M-O, m-o, 6. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters P-S, p-s, 7. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters T-V, t-v, 8. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters W-Z, w-z, 9. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters: 0 ! # $ % & ( ) Press repeatedly to scroll through the list. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Enter characters: * + , - . / : ; < = > ? Press repeatedly to scroll through the list. After selecting your entry, press the next letter or use the left scroll (by LND key) or right scroll (by OPAC key) to move the cursor. Clear the character entry one character at a time. Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.

When you want to

2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0

CONF CLEAR

-5-

Programming Manual

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming System Capacities
Maximum System Capacities
Items System Class of Service Toll Restriction Classes Verifiable Account Code Table Day/Night Mode Numbers Day/Night Service Patterns Analogue Caller ID Detector Dial Tone/Busy Tone Detector DTMF Receiver Trunk Trunk Port Number Trunk Ports(Total) Analogue Trunks BRI Trunk Ports E&M Analogue Trunk Ports --Feature Available-DID Analogue Trunk Ports --Feature Available-924M(308M+308E+308E)/924ME(308ME+308E+308E) Analogue Trunk Ports : 4BRIU Physical Port Number (T-point) : Logical Port Number (T-point) : DIOPU(2Lines) : -Feature AvailablePhysical Port Number : Logical Port Number : TLIU(2Lines) : -Feature AvailablePhysical Port Number : Logical Port Number : 4VOIPU(+ 4VOIPDB): Physical Port Number : Logical Port Number : Trunk Group Numbers Trunk Access Maps Trunk Routes Ring Groups DID Translation Tables DID Translation Tables Entries Tie Line Classes of Service Tie Line Toll Restriction Classes 4ch (+4ch) 1-8 1-51 1-25 1-51 1-25 1-8 1-20 2000 15 15 1-51 27+2451 27 24(48B) 12 12 1-9 1-4 1-8 15 15 2000 8 10 924M with DSPDBU: 32 + 924ME: 64 + 924ME: 96 Topaz

Programming Manual

-6-

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming
Maximum System Capacities
Items DISA Classes of Service Users Extension Telephone Extension Port Number(Total) Key Telephones Single Line Telephones Extension Port (Total : 924M+924ME+924ME) Key Telephones & Single Line Telephones 924M(308M+308E+308E)/924ME(308ME+308E+308E) Extension Ports Telephone Extension Number Range Virtual Extension Ports Virtual Extension Port Numbers Virtual Extension Port Number Range Class of Service Operator Access Number Operator Extension DSS Console Number DSS Console Maximum Installed DLS Console Maximum Installed Door Box Numbers Ringdown Assignment Abbreviated Dialing Abbreviated Dialing Groups Abbreviated Dial Bins Automated Attendant VRS Message Numbers Conference Conference Circuits Department and Pickup Groups Department (Extension) Group Numbers Department (Extension) Group Number Range Call Pickup Group Numbers 1-32 1-4 digits 1-8 32ch (16ch x 2) 1-48 1-32 0-1999 1-72 15 1-15 Topaz

72 24 200-295 (default) 50 01-50 Undifined 15 0 or 9 1-8 1-9 9 72 1-6 122

-7-

Programming Manual

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming
Maximum System Capacities
Items Hotline Internal Hotline External Hotline Paging and Park Internal Page Group Numbers External Page Group Numbers External Speakers Park Group Numbers Park Orbits SMDR SMDR Ports VRS VRS(on DSPDB Daughter Board) Voice Mail(DSPDBU) Voice Mail(DSPDB) Mailboxes Voice Mail Channels VoIP RAS Unicast Ports Call Signaling Ports NGT Signal Receive Ports DRS Ports RTP Ports RTCP Ports H.245 Ports DSP Resources H.323 Alias Addresses Passwords User Password for setting Toll restriction Override and Changing Class of Service using a Service Code Programming Passwords Level 2 (IN) Level 3 (SA) Level 4 (SB) Programming Password Users 12345678 0000 9999 1-8 No Setting 0-65535 0-65535 0-65535 0-65535 0-65534 1-65535 0-65535 01-32 1-6 300 16 1 1(COM) 32 6 6 1-64 1-64 72 27 Topaz

Programming Manual

-8-

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming Concept of 308M(Main Unit)
The 308M(Main Unit) has Flash Memories and RAM. The System Software (Program) will be stored the Flash Memory area, and the customer data will be stored to the RAM. 1. Flash Memory For the initial installation, the System will start up from Flash Memory. The data in the Flash Memory is put by the Factory. In case of the Software Up grading, the new System Software (Program) is loaded from a Compact Flash Card to Flash Memory.

2. RAM After starting up the system and completing the programming, all customer data will be stored to the RAM. It will be saved by Lithium Battery even if the power is going to be failed. For your safe, the customer data can be stored to Compact Flash Card or your Hard disk of Personal Computer.

System Start-Up
There are 4 types of Start-up Operation made as below; 1. Initial Installation(COLD Start) This mode may be selected in case of first installation. The System Software(Program) will be loaded from Flash Memory to the RAM. When entering Programming Mode at first time, the operation is as follows; 1) The SW1 on the 308M unit will be set at the left side to C and turn System Power Switch to ON. 2) Wait until 1-2 minutes, LED2(RUN) is going to be lit and the Key Telephones display shows Time & date with Extension number. After you change System Data, you must set the SW1 knob to right side to H to protect your System Data. This switch must always remain in the H position for normal operation. 2. Software Upgrading This mode may be selected in case the existing system is upgraded. The existing System Software (stored to the Flash Memory) will be cleared, then the new System Software will be loaded from new Compact Flash Card. The existing Customer Data (stored to the RAM) will be cleared. When the existing system is going to be upgraded, the new software will be loaded from Compact Flash Card. And EXIFU-A1 unit is required. The operation is as follows; 1) Make sure the Back-up Battery (Lithium Battery) has been installed completely and the SW1 on the 308M unit must be set H position to protect the customer data. 2) If previously powered up, the system must be turned off for upgrading software. 3) Once the system has completed its power down cycle (LED is off), insert the Compact Flash Card containing the software upgrade into the Compact Flash Card Slot(CN4) on the EXIFU-A1 unit. 4) SW1 is set to C side. Turn the system power switch to On.(LED status are as followings.) 5) Wait until 1-2 minutes, when the loading is completed, the fast blinking of LED4 will stop. 6) SW1 is set to H side and Power Off the system. 7) Remove the Compact Flash card from the Compact Flash card slot. 8) Power On the system. Wait until 1-2 minutes, LED2(RUN) is going to be lit. 9) Confirm the Main Software Version Number by OPAC and Dial 3. Re-Installation(COLD Start) This mode may be selected in case of re-installation from factory setting. The existing System Software(stored to the Flash Memory) will be remained, and the existing Customer data(stored to the RAM) will be cleared. When the system requires to re-install from factory setting, the operation is as follows; 1) SW1 on the 308M unit will be set at the left side to C and turn System Power Switch to ON. 2) Wait until 1-2 minutes, LED2(RUN) is going to be lit and the Key Telephones display shows Time & date with Extension number.

3.

-9-

Programming Manual

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming
4. Re-start(HOT Start) This mode may be selected in case of re-start(System Reset). The existing System Software(stored to the Flash Memory) and the Customer data(stored to the RAM) will be remained. When the system requires to Re-Start(System Reset), the operation is as follows; 1) SW1 on the 308M unit will be set at the right side to H and turn System Power Switch to ON. 2) Wait until 1-2 minutes, LED2(RUN) is going to be lit and the Key Telephones display shows Time & date with Extension number.

Before Programming
Before the programming, the Main Software Version and Port Number can be checked by the Display Key Telephone. 1. Confirmation of the Software Version The Software Version can be checked by OPAC key and Dial 3(by off-Hook condition) or PRG90-16-01. 2. Confirmation of the Port Number The Own Port Number can be checked by Press CHECK key and CALL key (by off-Hook condition). The Other Port Number also can be checked by Press CHECK key and Dial Destination Extension Number (by off-Hook condition). 3. Concept of Slot Number Slot Number will be fixed as followings and EXIFU Slots has no slot number.

Programming Manual

- 10 -

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming
4. Concept of Trunk/Extension Port The system decides the regulation of software port calculation as below; - 308M/308ME Unit = Up to 3 Trunk Ports and 8 Extension Ports - 008E Unit = Up to 8 Extension Ports 5. Port Calculation for Trunk and/or Extension In case the Trunk and/or Extension Interface Card (308M,308ME or 008) is Installed to a slot, the system will automatically be detected the type of Interface card, then assign the Trunk port and/or Extension port to a slot. 6. Port Calculation for ISDN BRI The 4BRIU card supports for both T-Bus connection and S-bus connection. Example 1) Port Calculation Slot No. Unit Name Slot1 Slot2 Slot3 Slot4 Slot5 Slot6 308M 308ME 008E 2PGDU 4BRIU(T/S) Circuit 1-2: T Circuit 3-4: S 4BRI(T) Circuit 1-4: T Port Configuration Trunk port 1-3 Extension port 1-8 Trunk port 4-6 Extension port 9-16 Extension port 17-24 Trunk port 7-10 Extension port 25-28 Trunk port 11-18 Remarks

*************************************************************************************

- 11 -

Programming Manual

Introduction to Programming
Before You Start Programming
- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 12 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-01: Time and Date

Description
Use Program 10-01 : Time and Date to change the system Time and Date through system programming. Extension users can also dial Service Code 828 to change the Time if allowed by an extensions Class of Service.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-01-01 10-01-02 10-01-03 10-01-04 10-01-05 10-01-06 10-01-07 Item Year Month Day Week Hour Minute Second Input data 00-99 01-12 01-31 1-7 (Sun-Sat) 00-23 00-59 00-59 Default No setting No setting No setting No setting No setting No setting No setting Description Enter two digits for year (00-99) Enter two digits(01-12) for the month Enter two digits(01-31) for the day Enter digit for the day of the week (1=Sunday,..,7=Saturday) Enter two digits(00-23) for the hour Enter two digits(00-59) for the Minute Enter two digits(00-59) for the second

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Time and Date

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-01 (Time and Date): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 01

10-01-01 Year
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

10-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 13 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-02: Location Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-02 : Location Setup to define the location of the installed system. Used for caller ID editing.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-02-01 10-02-02 10-02-03 10-02-04 10-02-05 Item Country Code International Access Code Other Area Access Code Area Code Trunk Access Code Input data Dial (up to 4 digits) Dial (up to 4 digits) Dial (up to 2 digits) Dial (up to 6 digits) Dial (up to 8 digits) Default No setting 00 0 No setting No setting Description Enter the country code Enter the international access code Enter the other area access code Enter the local area code Add Sub Address to S-point terminal

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Caller-ID

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-02 (Location Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 02

10-02-01 Country Code 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 14 -

IN SA - 15 -3 SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-03: PCB Setup

Description
Use Program 10-03 : PCB Setup to setup and confirm the Basic Configuration data for each PCB. When changing a defined terminal type, first set the type to 0 and then plug the new device in to have the system automatically define it, alternatively redefine the type manually. Program 10-03 allows the editing of installed units (PCBs), you can not edit the settings if the slot is unused, install the PCB first then edit the settings. Note: The items highlighted in grey are read only and cannot be changed.

Input Data
Slot Number 1-18

1.

For HBIU(308M/308E/008E Unit)


Physical Port Number Extension : 1-8 Trunk : 9-11 Input data 0 : No setting 1 : Multi-Line Telephone 2 : Single Line Telephone 10 : DSS Console 13 : Trunk 3-9,11,12 : -Not UsedStation : 0-72 Trunk 0-51 1-63(-15.5.+15.5dB) 1-63(-15.5.+15.5dB) Default 0

Prog. No. 10-03-01 Terminal Type

Item

10-03-02 10-03-03 10-03-04

Logical Port Number(see Note 1) Transmit Gain Level for SLT Receive Gain Level for SLT

0 32(0dB) 32(0dB)

Note 1) Reference and a setup are possible only for a Station port. 2. For 2PGDU Unit
Physical Port Number Prog. No. 10-03-01 Item Input data Physical port Number 1-2 0 : No setting 8 : Doorphone (1-7,10,11 : -Not Used-) Physical port Number 3-4 0 : No setting 6 : External Speaker 7 : External Trunk Audible 9 : External Music Source(MOH or BGM) (1-5,8,10,11 : -Not Used-) 0-6 0-4 (0 : Not Used) 1-4 Default Physical port 1-2: 8 Physical port 3-4 : 6

Terminal Type

10-03-02 10-03-03

Logical Port Number Relay setting(see Note 1)

0 Relay No.1 : 1 Relay No.2 : 2

Note 1) The Relays can be assigned up to 2 ports for a 2PGDU Unit. Programming Manual

- 15 -

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-03: PCB Setup
3. For BRIU Unit
ISDN Line Number Prog. No. 10-03-01 ISDN Line Mode Item 1-4 Input data 0 : No setting 1 : T-Point 2 : S-Point 3 - 5 : Not Used 6 : S-Point(Leased Line) [0 : No setting] : 0 [1 : T-Point] : 1 - 8 [2 : S-Point, 6 : S-Point(Leased Line)] : 11-26 0 : P-MP 1 : P-P 1-5 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Extended Passive Bus 1 : Short Passive Bus 0-4 0 : Enblock sending 1 : Overlap sending 0 : Keypad Facility 1 : Called Party Number -

IN SA SB

Default 1

10-03-02

Logical Port Number(see Note 1)

0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 -

10-03-03 10-03-04 10-03-05 10-03-06 10-03-07 10-03-08 10-03-09 10-03-10 10-03-11 10-03-12 10-03-13 10-03-14

Connection Type Layer 3 Timer Type(see Note 2) CLIP Information Announcement Connection Bus Mode(S-point only) S-point DID digits Dial Sending Mode Dial Information Element (Only for Overlap Sending Mode) -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedService Protocol for S-point

0 : Keypad facility 0 1 : Special Protocol for Topaz system Note 1) The start port number of a BRI line is displayed. Two logic ports are automatically assigned to a BRI line. Note 2) Each timer value of Layer3 are set up for every type of Program 81-06 (Trunk mode) and Program 82-06 (S-Bus).

4.

For VoIPU Unit


Physical Port Number Prog. No. 10-03-01 10-03-02 Item Trunk Logical Port Number Trunk Type 0-51 0 : H.323 1 : SIP 1-8 Input data Default 0 0

Programming Manual

- 16 -

IN SA - 17 -5 SB
5. For TLIU Unit

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-03: PCB Setup

Physical Port Number Prog. No. 10-03-01 10-03-02 Item Logical Port Number 2/4 Wire 0-8 0 : 2-Wire 1 : 4-Wire

1-8 Input data Default 0 1

6.

For DOIPU Unit


Physical Port Number Prog. No. 10-03-01 10-03-02 Item LD/OPX Assignment Logical Port Number 1-8 Input data 0 : LD Trunk 1 : OPX Trunk 0 : For LD Trunk 0-8 1 : For OPX Trunk 11-26 Default 0 0

- 17 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-03: PCB Setup
Conditions None

IN SA SB

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-03 (PCB Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 03

10-03-01SlotNo
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

10-03-xxSlotNoxx xxxxx 4. Select a Slot number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. Or, press FLASH once to select the slot number or press FLASH twice to select a port number. Enter the slot or port number. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 18 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-04: Music on Hold Setup

Description
Use Program 10-04 : Music on Hold Setup to set the Music on Hold selection. For MOH, the system can provide silence to callers on Hold or one of two synthesized selections.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-04-01 Item Music on Hold Source Selection Input data 0: Internal source 1: External source Default 0 Description The Music on Hold (MOH) source can be internal (synthesized) or from a customer-provided music source. The customer-provided source can connect to a 2PGDU. Trunk MOH and Extension MOH music source use the same Music on Hold source. Type 1: Farewell Song (by Chopin)

10-04-02

Music Selection for Internal Source Audio Gain Setup

0- Silence (no sound) 1- Type 1 1-63 (-15.5.. +15.5dB)

10-04-03

32 (0dB)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Music on Hold

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-04 (Music on Hold Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. 10 04 10-04-01 Hold Music Set 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

10-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 19 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-05: Not Used Description
This command is currently not used.

IN SA SB

Programming Manual

- 20 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-06: ISDN BRI Setup

Description
Use Program 10-06 : ISDN BRI Setup defines the TEI selection and DID mode for DID callers when the BRI feature is used. Previously, if the called party number did not match the SPID number, the system would not allow the call to go through. And to enter the SPID (Service Profile ID) assigned to each of the systems BRI ISDN lines. Each BRI PCB has a maximum of two lines and each line can have a maximum of two SPIDs. To use both channels of a BRI ISDN line, two directory numbers must be ordered from telco. A SPID will be assigned for each directory number.

Input Data
SLOT No. ISDN Line No. Prog. No. 10-06-01 10-06-02 10-06-03 10-06-04 Item TEI selection DID mode SPID1 SPID2 Input Data 0 : Select by SPID number 1 : Select by Channel ID Number 0 : Route by Called Party Number 1 : Route by Redirecting Number Dial (Up to 20 digits) Default 0 0 No setting 5,6,11,12,17,18 1-4 Description

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-06 (ISDN BRI Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 06

10-06-01SlotNo1 BRI TEI 0 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-06-xxSlotNox xxxxx 4. Select the Slot Number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 21 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-07: Conversation Record Circuits Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-07 : Conversation Record Circuits to select the number of Conference circuits to be used for Conversation Recording.
Note: Even if this program is set to 0, the telephone conversation recording function can be used.

In this case, 16 circuits will be shared by conference recording and conversation recording. The number of the conference circuits occupied by a conversation recording is two.

Input Data
The number of Conversation Recording 0-16 0 : No setting2-32:Conference Resource Default 0

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Conference

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-07 (Conversation Record Circuits): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 07

10-07-01 No. of Record 0 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-07-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 22 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-08: Pre-Ringing Setup

Description
Use Program 10-08 : Pre-Ringing Setup to enable or disable pre-ringing for trunk calls. This sets how a trunk initially rings a telephone. With pre-ringing, a burst of ringing occurs as soon as the trunks LED flashes. The call then continues ringing with the normal ring cadence cycle. Without pre-ringing, the call starts ringing only when the normal ring cadence cycle occurs. This may cause a ring delay, depending on when call detection occurs in reference to the ring cycle.

Input Data
Input Data 0 : disable 1 : enable Default 0

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Answering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-08 (Pre-Ringing Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 08

10-08-01 Pre-ringing 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-08-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 23 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-09: DTMF and Dial Tone Circuit Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-09 : DTMF and Dial Tone Circuit Setup to allocate the circuits on the 308M PCBs for either DTMF receiving or dial tone detection. The 308M PCB has 16 circuits initially. With additional DSPDBU is installed in 924M Main Cabinet, the system can provide a total of 32 (16+16) circuits. These are used as follows: Extension : DTMF receiver for SLT Trunk : DTMF receiver for analogue trunks, dial tone & busy tone detection for analogue trunks

Input Data
Circuit/ Resource Number 01-96 Input Data 0 : Common Use 1 : Extension Only 2 : Trunk only Default Resource 01-96 = 0(Common) *In case of 924M system: 01-32(Including DSPDBU:16+16) *In case of 924M+924ME: 01-64 *In case of 924M+924ME+924ME: 01-96

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Placing Direct Inward Dialing (DID) Direct Inward System Access(DISA) Tie Line

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-09 (DTMF and Dial Tone Circuit Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 09

10-09-01 Res 1 DTMF DT Detect 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-09-xx Resxx xxxxx 4. Select the Resource Number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 24 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-12: EXIFU Network Setup

Description
Use Program 10-12 : EXIFU Network Setup to setup the IP Address, Subnet-Mask, and Default Gateway addresses of EXIFU.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-12-01 Item Input Data Default 172.16.0.10 224.0.0.0 252.0.0.0. 255.128.0.0 255.248.0.0 255.255.0.0 255.255.224.0 255.255.254.0 255.255.255.192 255.255.255.248 255.255.255.255 The setting of Subnet-Mask is mistaken when all Host Address are 0. If the network section is; 0, 255.255.0.0 127 128.0 191.255 192.0.0 223.255.255 The setting of SubNet-Mask is mistaken. 0.0.0.0 12 IP Address for Router Condition IP 0.0.0.1 - 126.255.255.254 Address 128.0.0.1 - 191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1 - 223.255.254.254 Subnet 128.0.0.0 192.0.0.0 Mask 240.0.0.0 248.0.0.0 254.0.0.0 255.0.0.0 255.192.0.0 255.224.0.0 255.252.0.0 255.254.0.0 255.255.128.0 255.255.192.0 255.255.248.0 255.255.252.0 255.255.255.0 255.255.255.128 255.255.255.224 255.255.255.240 255.255.255.252 255.255.255.254

10-12-02

Default 0.0.0.1 - 126.255.255.254 Gateway 128.0.0.1 - 191.255.255.254 192.0.0.1 - 223.255.255.254 10-12-04 Time 0 to 24 which is equivalent to 12 thru +12 Hours Zone 10-12-05 NIC 0 : Auto Detect 1 : 100Mbps, Full Duplex 2 : 100Mbps, Half Duplex 3 : 10Mbps, Full Duplex 4 : 10Mbps, Half Duplex 10-12-06 NAT 0 : Not Use Router 1 : Use 10-12-07 Default 0.0.0.1 - 126.255.255.254 Gateway 128.0.0.1 - 191.255.255.254 (WAN) 192.0.0.1 - 223.255.255.254 10-12-08 ICMP 0 : Enable(Use Auto Update) MF Level REDIRE 1 : Disable -CT 10-12-03

NIC Auto Negotiate Connect NAT Router or not. IP Address for Router (WAN side)

0 0.0.0.0

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

- 25 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-12: EXIFU Network Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 10-12 (EXIFU Network Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 12

IN SA SB

10-12-01 172.16 .0 .10 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-12-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 26 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-13: In-DHCP Server Setup

Description
Use Program 10-13 : In-DHCP Server Setup to setup the DHCP Server built into the EXIFU.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-13-01 10-13-02 Item DHCP Server Mode Lease Time Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Days : 0-255 Hour : 0-23 Minutes : 0-59 10-13-03 10-13-04 -Not UsedNumber of Networks 0 : Single 1 : Divide same Network Default 0 0 day 0 hour 30 min 0 The number of networks to manage. With a single network, select Single. When dividing and managing the same network as multiple networks, select Divide. Description Enable or disable the use of the built-in DHCP Server. Lease Time of the IP address to a client

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-13 (In-DHCP Server Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 13

10-13-01 DHCP-Serv Mode 0 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-13-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 27 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-14: Managed Network Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-14 : Managed Network Setup to set up the range of the IP address which the DHCP Server leases to a client.

Input Data
Item Scope 1 Input Data Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 1.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Default Description The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. Related program 10-13-04

172.16.0.100

172.16.5.254

Scope 2

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 3

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 4

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 5

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Programming Manual

- 28 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-14: Managed Network Setup

Item Scope 6

Input Data Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Minimum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Maximum; 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254

Default

Description The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered. The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered.

Related program 10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 7

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 8

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 9

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Scope 10

10-13-04

0.0.0.0

0.0.0.0

Conditions
None

- 29 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-14: Managed Network Setup Feature Cross Reference
VoIP

IN SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-14 (Managed Network Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 14

10-14-01 Scope1 . . . 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-14-xx xxxxx 4. Select the scope number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 30 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-15: Client Information Setup

Description
Use Program 10-15 : Client Information Setup to set up the client information when the DHCP server needs to assign a fixed IP address to clients.

Input Data
Scope

01-10

Item Client 1

Input Data MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254

Default 00-00-00-00-00-00

Description The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14.

Related program 10-14

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 2

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 3

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 4

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 5

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 6

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0

- 31 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-15: Client Information Setup
Item Client 7 Input Data MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 -FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Default 00-00-00-00-00-00 Description The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14.

IN SA SB
Related program 10-14

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 8

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 9

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0 The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14. 10-14

Client 10

00-00-00-00-00-00

0.0.0.0

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Programming Manual

- 32 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-15: Client Information Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-15 (Client Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 15

10-15-01Client1 0000-0000-0000 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-15-xxClientxx xxxxx 4. Select the Client number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 33 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-16: Option Information Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-16 : Option Information Setup to set up the option given from the DHCP server to each client.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-16-01 Item Router Code Number 0-255 IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 10-16-02 DNS Server Code Number 0-255 IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 10-16-03 TFTP Server Code Number 0-255 IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 10-16-04 DRS Code Number 0-255 IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 10-16-05 MGC Code Number 0-255 IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Input Data Default 3Fixed 0.0.0.0 6Fixed 0.0.0.0 66Fixed 0.0.0.0 161Fixed 172.16.0.10 129Fixed 172.16.0.10

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Programming Manual

- 34 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-16: Option Information Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-16 (Option Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 16

10-16-01 RouterCode No3 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-16-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 35 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-17: H.323 Gatekeeper Setup Description
Use Program 10-17 : H.323 Gatekeeper Setup to define the H.323 Gatekeeper.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-17-01 Item Gatekeeper Mode Input Data 0 : No GK 1 : Automatic 2 : Manual Default 0 Description An external gatekeeper uses propriety set up. No GK: A gatekeeper is not used Automatic: A gatekeeper is searched and assigned Manual: A gatekeeper's IP address is assigned. Unicast IP address of the External GK. Related Program

10-17-02

Gatekeeper IP Address

IP address 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 Character line (Max.124)

0.0.0.0

This item is effective only when Program 10-17-01 is set to Manual (2). This item is effective only when Program 10-17-01 is set to Automatic (1).

10-17-03 10-17-04

-Not UsedPreferred Gatekeeper

No setting

When registering with an external gatekeeper using gatekeeper search, two or more GRQ may be assigned. In this case, if this ID is set up, it will register with a gatekeeper with this ID.

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Programming Manual

- 36 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-17: H.323 Gatekeeper Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-17 (H.323 Gatekeeper Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 17

10-17-01 GK Mode 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-17-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 37 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-18: H.323 Alias Address Setup Description
Use Program 10-18 : H.323 Alias Address Setup to set up the Alias Address registered into the External Gatekeeper.

IN SA SB

Input Data
The Number of Alias 1-6

Prog. No. 10-18-01

Item Alias Address

Input Data Maximum 12 digits

Default No setting

Description Define the Alias Address of the Topaz system registered into the External Gatekeeper. At this time, it is only the telephone number which can be registered as an Alias Address. In the future, other types of addresses will be available. Define the type of Alias Address registered into the External Gatekeeper. Currently the only type is E.164. However, in the future, other types will also be available.

10-18-02

Type of Alias Address

0 : E164

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-18 (H.323 Alias Address Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 18

10-18-01 Alias1 Add 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-18-xx Aliasx xxxxx 4. Select the Alias number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 38 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-19: VoIPU DSP Resource Selection

Description
Use Program 10-19 : VoIPU DSP Resource Selection to specify the operating mode of the DSP resource on the VoIPU PCB.

Input Data
Slot Number 1-18

DSP Resource Number 1-8

Input Data 0 : Common use for both IP Extensions and Trunks 1 : IP Extension only 2 : IP Trunk only

Default 0

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-19 (VoIPU DSP Resource Selection): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 19

10-19-01SlotNo1 DSP Resource 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-19-xxSlotNox xxxxx 4. Select the Slot number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 39 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-20: LAN Setup for External Equipment Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-20 : LAN Setup for External Equipment to define the TCP port/address/etc. for communicating to external equipment.

Input Data
Type of External Equipment 1 : CTI Server 5 : SMDR Output

Prog. No. 10-20-01 10-20-02 10-20-03 TCP Port -Not UsedKeep alive time

Item 0-65535 1-255(sec)

Input data

Default 0 30

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-20 (LAN Setup for External Equipment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 20

10-20-01 Ex-Dev1 TCP Port 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-20-xx Ex-Devx xxxxx 4. Select the External Device number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 40 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-21: EXIFU Hardware Setup

Description
Use Program 10-21 : EXIFU Hardware Setup to set up various hardware, such as the baud rate of COM port.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-21-01 10-21-02 Item -Not UsedBaud rate for COM Port 0 : 4800 1 : 9600 2 : 19200 3 : 38400 Input Data Default 2 Define the baud rate of the COM port within the EXIFU-A1/B1. Description

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-21 (EXIFU Hardware Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 21

10-21-02 COM Baud Rate 3 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-21-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 41 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-23: H.323 System Interconnection Setup Description
Use Program 10-23 : H.323 System Interconnection Setup to define the IP address of another system, call control port number and alias address for Topaz system inter-connection. This program is activated when Program 10-17-01 and 10-18 are registered. Up to 50 systems can be registered.

IN SA SB

Input Data
System Number 01-1000

Prog. No. 10-23-01 10-23-02

Item System Interconnection IP address Call Control Port --Viewing Only-Dial Number

Input data 0 : No 1 : Yes 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 1-65535 Max.12 addresses

Default 0 0.0.0.0

Related Program

Activated when 10-23-01=1 Activated when 10-23-01=1 Activated when 10-23-01=1

10-23-03 10-23-04

1720

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-23 (H.323 System Interconnection Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 23

10-23-01 No.1 SysInterconnect0 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-23-xx xxxxx 4. Select the slot number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 42 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-24: Daylight Savings Setup

Description
Use Program 10-24 : Daylight Savings Setup to set the options for daylight savings.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-24-01 10-24-02 10-24-03 10-24-04 10-24-05 10-24-06 10-24-07 10-24-08 Item Day light Savings Mode Time for Daylight Savings Start of Month (Summer Time) Start of Week Start of Week day End of Month End of Week End of Week Day 0 : Off 1 : On 0000-2359 1-12 0 : Last Week 1-5 1-7(Sun=1,Mon=2,.etc) 1-12 0 : Last Week 1-5 1-7(Sun=1,Mon=2,.etc) Input Data Default 0 0200 4 1 1 10 0 1 Related Program

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Time and Date

- 43 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-24: Daylight Saving Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 10-24 (Daylight Savings Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 24

IN SA SB

10-24-01 Daylight Saving 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-24-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 44 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-25: H.323 Gateway Prefix Setup

Description
Use Program 10-25 : H.323 Gateway Prefix Setup to set the gateway prefix registered to the outside gatekeeper.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-25-01 10-25-02 Item Gateway Prefix Entry Gateway Prefix Value Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Dial (Up to 12 digits) Default 0 No setting 10-25-01 Related Program

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-25 (H.323 Gateway prifix Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 25

10-25-01 Prifix Reg. 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-25-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 45 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-28: SIP System Information Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 10-28 : SIP System Information Setup to set the basic system information used in SIP Trunk.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-28-01 10-28-02 10-28-03 10-28-04 10-28-05 Item Domain Name Host Name Transport Protocol User ID Domain Assignment Input Data Max. 64 digits Max.48 digits 0 : UDP 1 : TCP Max. 32 digits 0 : IP Address 1 : Domain Name Default No setting No setting 0 No setting 0 Description Set the Domain Name of SIP-URL in the system. UserID@HostName.DomainName Set the Host Name of SIP-URL in the system. UserID@HostName.DomainName The protocol used for connection is set up. Set the User ID of SIP-URL in the system. UserID@HostName.DomainName Below @ of SIP-URL specifies an IP address or a domain name

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-28 (SIP system Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 28

10-28-01 Domain 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-28-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 46 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-29: SIP Server Information Setup

Description
Use Program 10-29 : SIP Server Information Setup to set the SIP Servers information.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-29-01 10-29-02 10-29-03 Item Default Proxy (Transmit) Default Proxy (Receive) Default Proxy IP Address Default Proxy Port Number Registrar Mode Registrar IP Address Registrar Port Number DNS Server Mode DNS Server IP Address DNS Port Number Registrar Domain Name Domain Name Host Name SIP Carrier Selection Input Data 0 : OFF 1 : ON 0 : OFF 1 : ON 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 0-65535 0 : None 1 : Manual 2 : Auto 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 0-65535 0 : OFF 1 : ON 0.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1-191.254.255.254 192.0.0.1-223.255.254.254 0-65535 Max. 128 digits Max. 64 digits Max. 48 digits 0 : Standard 1 : Carrier A : 7 : Carrier G Default 0 0 0.0.0.0 Description The transmission of SIP message is always using for Default Proxy or not. The Receiving of SIP message is only using from Default Proxy or not. Set the IP Address of Default Proxy. This command is effected either the Command 10-29-01 or 10-29-02 is ON. Set the Port Number of Default Proxy. This command is effected either the Command 10-29-01 or 10-29-02 is ON. Set the Registrar Mode into the Registrar Server. Set IP Address of SIP Registrar Server. This command is effected when the command 10-29-01is set 2(:Manual). Set Port number of SIP Registrar Server. This command is effected when the command 10-29-01is set 2(:Manual). Define whether the DNS server is use or not. Set the IP address of DNS Server. This command is effected when the command 10-29-08is set 1(:ON). Set the Port Number of DNS Server. This command is effected when the command 10-29-08is set 1(:ON). Set the Domain Name of Registrar server. Set The Domain Part of SIP Server. HostName.DomainName Set The Host Part of SIP Server. HostName.DomainName Select the Carrier type which offers SIP service. The Expire time is set up in case a SIP trunk performs registration to a SIP server. The update registration performs automatically when the half time of this value is passed.

10-29-04

5060

10-29-05

10-29-06

0.0.0.0

10-29-07 10-29-08 10-29-09

5060 0 0.0.0.0

10-29-10 10-29-11 10-29-12 MF Level 10-29-13 MF Level 10-29-14 MF Level

53 No Setting No Setting No Setting

10-29-15 MF Level

Registration Expiry Time

120-65535 (sec)

3600

Conditions
None

- 47 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-29: SIP Server Information Setup Feature Cross Reference
None

MF SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-29 (SIP Server Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 29

10-29-01 Dflt.Proxy(OB) 0 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-29-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 48 -

IN SA SB

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-30: SIP Authentication Information Setup

Description
Use Program 10-30 : SIP Authentication Information Setup to set the Authentication information used in SIP Trunk.

Input Data
Prog. No. 10-30-01 10-30-02 10-30-03 10-30-04 Item -Not UsedUser Name Password Authentication Trial Max. 48 digits character Max. 24 digits character 0-9 Input Data Default No setting No setting 1 Set the User Name of Authentication. Set the Password of the Authentication. The Password can not enter or check by Keyset programming. Set the Authentication trial number Description

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-30 (SIP Authentication Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 30

10-30-01
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

10-30-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 49 -

Programming Manual

Program 10: System Configuration Setup


10-33: SIP Registrar/Proxy Information Basic Setup Description

MF SA SB

Use Program 10-33 : SIP Registrar/Proxy Information Basic Setup to sets basic information for the SIP Registrar/Proxy.

Input Data
Prog. No. Item Registration Expire Time Authentication Mode Registrar/Proxy Domain Name Registrar/Proxy Host Name Input Data Default Description When Expire value sent from SIP Terminal is out of range or the Expire value is not sent, In case, set the duration time to supervise for SIP terminal is exist or not. The authentication is set or not when the Registration message is received. Domain name of the SIP Registrar/Proxy (for SIP Extension) is set. Host name of the SIP Registrar/Proxy (for SIP Extension) is set.

10-33-01

60-300

120

10-33-02 10-33-03 10-33-04

0 : Disable 1 : Enable Max. 64 characters Max. 48 characters

0 No Setting No Setting

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 10-33 (SIP Registrar/Proxy Information Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 10 33

10-33-01 Expire Time 120 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 10-33-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 50 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-01: System Numbering

Description
Use Program 11-01 : System Numbering to set the systems internal (Intercom) numbering plan. The numbering plan assigns the first and second digits dialed and affects the digits an extension user must dial to access other extensions and features, such as service codes and trunk codes. If the default numbering plan does not meet the site requirements, use this program to tailor the system numbering to the site. CAUTION Improperly programming this option can adversely affect system operation. Make sure you thoroughly understand the default numbering plan before proceeding. If you must change the standard numbering, use the chart for System Numbering (page 52) to keep careful and accurate records of your changes. Before changing your numbering plan, use the PC Program to make a backup copy of your systems data.

Changing the numbering plan consists of three steps: 1. Enter the digits you want to change. 2. Specify the length of the code you select to change. 3. Assign a function to the code selected.

Step 1: Enter the digit you want to change You can make either single or two digit entries. In the Dialed Number column in the System Numbering (page 52) table, the nX rows (e.g., 1x) are for single digit codes. The remaining rows (e.g., 11, 12..., etc.) are for two digit codes. l. Entering a single digit affects all the Dialed Number entries beginning with that digit. For example, entering 6 affects all number plan entries beginning with 6. The entries you make in step 2 and step 3 below affect the entire range of numbers beginning with 6. (For example, if you enter 3 in step 2 the entries affected would be 600-699. If you enter 4 in step 2 below, the entries affected would be 6000-6999.) 2. Entering two digits lets you define codes based on the first two digits a user dials. For example, entering 60 allows you to define the function of all codes beginning with 60. In the default program, only * and # use two-digit codes. All the other codes are single digit. If you enter a two digit code between 0 and 9, be sure to make separate entries for all the other two digit codes within the range as well. This is because in the default program all the two digit codes between 0 and 9 are undefined. Step 2: Specify the length of the code you want to change After you specify a single or two digit code, you must tell the system how many digits comprise the code. This is the Number of Digits Required column in the System Numbering (page 52) table. In the default program, all codes from 100-899 are three digits long. Codes beginning with 0 and 9 are one digit long. Codes beginning with * are 4 digits long and codes beginning with # are also 4 digits long.

- 51 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Configuration Setup


11-01: System Numbering

IN SA SB

Step 3: Assign a function to the code selected After entering a code and specifying its length, you must assign its function. This is the Dial Type column in the System Numbering (page 52) table. The choices are: Dial Types 0 1 Dial Type Description -Not UsedService Code Related Program

11-10: Service Code Setup(for System Administrator) 11-11: Service Code Setup(for Setup/Entry) 11-12: Service Code Setup(for Service Access) 11-15: Service Code Setup(for Special Access) 2 Extension Number 11-02: Extension Number 11-04: Virtual Extension Number 11-06: ACI Extension Numbering 11-07: Department Calling Group Numbers 11-08: ACI Group Pilot Number 3 Trunk Access Number 11-09: Trunk Access Code 4 Special Trunk Access 11-09: Trunk Access Code 5 Operator Access 20-17: Operators Extension 6 ARS/F-Route Access 44-xx l Changing the Dial Type for a range of codes can have a dramatic affect on how your system operates. Assume, for example, the site is a hotel that has room numbers from 100-399. In order to make extension numbers correspond to room numbers, you should: - In Program 11-02, reassign extension numbers on each floor from 100 to 399.(Other applications might also require you to change entries in Program 11-10 through 11-16.) System Numbering table; Dialed Number 1st figure 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 * # 2nd figure 1x 11-1# 2x 21-2# 3x 31-3# 4x 41-4# 5x 51-5# 6x 61-6# 7x 71-7# 8x 81-8# 9x 91-9# 0x 01-0# *x *1-*# #x #1-## Number of digits 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 1 0 1 0 4 0 4 0 Dial Type(Default) 2 (Extension access) 0 (Not Used) 2 (Extension access) 0 (Not Used) 2 (Extension access) 0 (Not Used) 2 (Extension access) 0 (Not Used) 2 (Extension access) 0 (Not Used) 2 (Extension access) 0 (Not Used) 1 (Service code access) 0 (Not used) 1 (Service code access) 0 (Not used) 3 (Trunk access) 0 (Not used) 5 (Operator access) 0 (Not used) 1 (Service code access) 0 (Not used) 1 (Service code access) 0 (Not used) Input data 0 : Not used 1 : Service Code Access 2 : Extension Access 3 : Trunk Access 4 : Special Trunk Access 5 : Operator Access 6 : Flexible Routing Access

Programming Manual

- 52 -

IN SA SB
Conditions None

Program 11: System Numbering


11-01: System Numbering

Feature Cross Reference


Flexible System Numbering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-01 (System Numbering): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 01

11-01-01 Dial 1 1x Digit 3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-01-xx Dialx xxxxx 4. Select the dial number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 53 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-02: Extension Numbering Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-02 : Extension Numbering to set the extension number. The extension number can be up to four digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01. This lets an employee move to a new location (port) and retain the same extension number. Input Data
Extension Port Number 01-96

Extension Number

Description Set up extension numbers for Key Telephones, Single Line Telephones Extension number assignments cannot be duplicated.

Dial (up to 4 digits)

Default
Extension Port Number 1 96 Extension Number 200 295

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Department Calling Flexible System Numbering Intercom

Programming Manual

- 54 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-02: Extension Numbering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-02 (Extension Numbering): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 02

11-02-01Ex Prt1 Extension No200


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-02-xxEx Prtxx xxxxx 4. Select the extension port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 55 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-04: Virtual Extension Numbering Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-04 : Virtual Extension Numbering to define the virtual extension numbers. The extension number can be up to four digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01.

Input Data
Virtual Extension Port Number 01-50

Virtual Extension Number Dial (up to 4 digits)

Description Set up Virtual Extension Numbers. The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-06, 11-07 and 11-08.

Default Virtual Extension Port Number 1-50: No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Flexible System Numbering Multiple Directory Numbering/ Call Coverage

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-04 (Virtual Extension Numbering): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 04

11-04-01V-Port1 Vir Ext No.


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-04-xxV-Portxx xxxxx 4. Select the Virtual port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 56 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-06: ACI Extension Numbering

Description
Use Program 11-06 : ACI Extension Numbering to define the ACI extension numbers. The extension number can be up to four digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01. 1-6

ACI Port Number

ACI Extension Number Dial (up to 4 digits)

Description The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-04, 11-06 and 11-07.

Related Program 10-03

Default ACI Port Number 1-6: No setting (ACI Extension Number) Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Analogue Communication Interface(ACI) Flexible Station Numbering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-06 (ACI Extension Numbering): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 06

11-06-01ACIPort1 ACI Ext No


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-06-xxACIPortx xxxxx 4. Select the ACI Port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 57 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-07: Department Group Pilot Numbers Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-07 : Department Group Pilot Numbers to assign pilot numbers to each Department Group set up in Program 16-02. The pilot number is the number users dial for Department Calling and Department Step Calling. The pilot number can be up to four digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01 as type 2. 1-32

Department (Extension) Group Number

Extension Group Pilot Number Dial (up to 4 digits)

Description Use this program to assign department group pilot numbers. The number set up by Program 11-02 (Extension Numbering) cannot be used. The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-04, 11-06 and 11-08.

Related Program 16-01 : Department (Extension) Group Basic Data Setup 16-02 : Department Group Assignment for Extensions 16-03 : Secondary Department Group

Default Extension Group Number 1-32: No setting (Extension Group Pilot Number) Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Department Calling Department Step Calling

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-07 (Department Group Pilot Numbering): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 07

11-07-01TEL Gr1 Ext Grp No.


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-07-xxTEL Grpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Telephone group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 58 -

IN SA - 59 -9 SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-08: ACI Group Pilot Number

Description
Use Program 11-08 : ACI Group Pilot Number to assign the pilot number to the ACI Groups set in Program 33-02. The pilot number can be up to four digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01 as type 2. 1-4

ACI Group Number

ACI Group Pilot Number Dial (up to 4 digits)

Description The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-04, 11-06 and 11-07.

Related Program 33-07

Default ACI Group Number 1-4: No setting (ACI Group Pilot Number) Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Analogue Communication Interface(ACI)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-08 (ACI Group Pilot Numbering): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 08

11-08-01ACI Grp1 Pilot No


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-08-xxTEL Grpxx xxxxx 4. Select the ACI group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 59 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-09: Trunk Access Code Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-09 : Trunk Access Code to assign the trunk access code (normally 9). The trunk access code can be set from 1 to 4 digits which is defined to type 3 and 4 in Program 11-01. This is the code extension users dial to access Automatic Route Selection. The Individual Trunk Access Code is used when Trunk Group Routing is desired for an outgoing line. Caution The digit 9 is defined in Program 11-01 as Dial Type 3 with the Number of Digits Required set to 1. If you change the trunk access code in Program 11-09, you must make the corresponding changes in Program 11-01.

Input Data
Prog. No. 11-09-01 Item Trunk Access Code (for Type3) Input data Dial (Up to 4 digits) Default 9 Description Use this program to assign the trunk access code (normally 9). This is the code extension users dial to access Automatic Route Selection. Related Program 11-01 : System Numbering 14-01-07 : Trunk Basic Data Setup 14-05 : Trunk Group 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing 11-01 : System Numbering 14-01-07 : Trunk Basic Data Setup 14-05 : Trunk Group 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing 21-02 : Trunk Group Routing for Extensions 21-15: Alternate Trunk Group Routing for Extensions

11-09-02

Alternate Trunk Route Access Code (for Type4)

Dial (Up to 4 digits)

No Setting

Use this program to define additional trunk access codes. When a user dials the Alternate Trunk Route Access Code, the system routes their call to the Alternate Trunk Route.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection Central Office Calls, Placing Trunk Group Routing

Programming Manual

- 60 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-09: Trunk Access Code

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-09 (Trunk Access Code): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 09

11-09-01 Trunk Acs CD 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-09-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 61 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-10: Service Code Setup (for System Administrator) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-10 : Service Code Setup (for System Administrator) to customize the Service Codes for the System Administrator. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-11, 11-12, 11-15, and 11-16. The following chart shows: The number of each code (01- ) The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code The codes default entry. For example, dialing 724 (item 26) allows users to force a trunk line to disconnect. Programs that may be affected with the changing the code.

Input Data
Prog. No. 11-10-01 11-10-02 11-10-03 11-10-04 11-10-05 11-10-06 11-10-07 11-10-08 11-10-09 11-10-10 11-10-11 11-10-12 11-10-13 11-10-14 11-10-15 11-10-16 11-10-17 11-10-18 11-10-19 11-10-20 11-10-21 11-10-22 11-10-23 11-10-24 11-10-25 11-10-26 11-10-27 11-10-28 11-10-29 Item Day / Night Mode Switching Changing the Music on Hold Tone Setting the System Time Storing Common Abbreviated Dialing Numbers Storing Group Abbreviated Dialing Numbers Setting the Automatic Transfer for Each Trunk Line Canceling the Automatic Transfer for Each Trunk Line Setting the Destination for Automatic Trunk Transfer Charging Cost Display -Not UsedEntry of Credit for Toll Restriction Night Mode Switching (Other Groups) -Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedLeaving Message Waiting Dial Block by Supervisor Off-Premise Call Forward by Door Box -Not UsedVRS - Record/Erase Message VRS - General Message Playback VRS - Record or Erase General Message SMDR - Extension Accumulated Printout Code SMDR - Group Accumulated Printout Code Account Code Accumulated Printout Code Forced Trunk Disconnect (For Analogue Trunk only) Trunk Port Disable -Not Used-Not UsedTerminals KTS,SLT KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS KTS KTS KTS,SLT KTS Default 818 881 828 853 854 833 834 835 771 774 718 726 701 822 716 711 712 721 722 723 724 745 Related Program 12-xx 20-07-01 10-04

12-xx

11-11-09 90-19 13-05 20-07-13 20-07-14 20-07-15 20-07-18 20-07-19 20-07-20 20-07-11 20-07-12

Conditions None

Programming Manual

- 62 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-10: Service Code Setup (for Administrator)

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to chart above.

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-10 (Service Code Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 10

11-10-01 NT-Mod SW 818


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-10-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 63 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-11: Service Code Setup (for Setup/Entry) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-11 : Service Code Setup (for Setup/Entry Operation) to customize the Service Codes which are used for registration and setup. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10, 11-12, 11-15 and 11-16. The following chart shows: The number of each code (01- ) The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code The codes default entry. For example, dialing 825 (item 18) allows users to turn on or turn off Background Music. Programs that may be affected with the changing the code.

Input Data
Prog. No. 11-11-01 11-11-02 11-11-03 11-11-04 11-11-05 11-11-06 11-11-07 11-11-08 11-11-09 11-11-10 11-11-11 11-11-12 11-11-13 11-11-14 11-11-15 11-11-16 11-11-17 11-11-18 11-11-19 11-11-20 11-11-21 11-11-22 11-11-23 11-11-24 11-11-25 11-11-26 11-11-27 Item Call Forward - Immediate Call Forward - Busy Call Forward - No Answer Call Forward - Busy/ No Answer Call Forward Dual Ring Call Forward - Select Option Call Forward Follow me Do Not Disturb Answer Message Waiting Cancel All Message Waiting Cancel Message Waiting Alarm Clock Display Language Selection Text Message Setting Incoming Intercom Call mode setting (Voice) Incoming Intercom Call mode setting (Signal) Programmable Function Key Programming (Dialing 851 Service Code) BGM On/Off Key Touch Tone On/Off -Not Used-Not UsedExtension Name Programming DID/DISA/DIL Override for Second call Change Extension Class of Service Allows an extension user to change the COS of another extension. Must be allowed in Program20-13-28. Automatic Transfer Setup for Each Extension Group Automatic Transfer Cancellation for Each Extension Group Destination of Automatic Transfer Each Extension Group Terminals KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS Default 848 843 845 844 842 888 846 847 841 873 871 827 778 836 821 823 851 825 824 800 779 777 702 703 704 20-11-17 24-05 20-11-17 24-05 Related Program

11-10-16

20-01-06 15-02 20-09-05 20-02-12 20-09-05 20-02-12 15-07 11-11-38

15-01 20-13-28

Programming Manual

- 64 -

IN SA SB
Input Data (Contd) Prog. No. 11-11-28 11-11-29 11-11-30 11-11-31 11-11-32 11-11-33 11-11-34 11-11-35 11-11-36 11-11-37 11-11-38 11-11-39 11-11-40 11-11-41 11-11-42 11-11-43

Program 11: System Numbering


11-11: Service Code Setup (for Setup/Entry)
Item Delayed Transfer for Every Extension Group Delayed Transfer Cancellation for Each Extension Group DND Setup for Each Extension Group DND Cancellation for Each Extension Group -Not UsedDial Block Temporary Toll Restriction Override Pilot Group Withdrawing Toll Restriction Override Adjusting Ring Volume Programmable Function Key Programming (Dialing 852 Service Code: Appearance Level)) -Not UsedVAU/ Off-Premise Call Forwarding Tandem Ringing Transfer Dial Setting for Out of Range Headset Ringing Mode Switching Terminals KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS KTS KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS KTS,SLT Default 705 706 707 708 700 875 750 763 829 852 713 744 789 788 Related Program 20-11-17 24-05 24-02-08 20-11-17

21-07 21-14 15-07 11-11-17

13-06

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Conference

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 11-11 (Service Code Setup(for Setup/Entry Operation) ): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 11

11-11-01 CF-Immediate 848


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-11-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 65 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-12: Service Code Setup (for Service Access) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 11-12 : Service Code Setup (for Service Access) to customize the Service Codes which are used for service access. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10, 11-11, 11-15 and 11-16. The following chart shows: The number of each code (01- ) The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code The codes default entry. For example, dialing 805 (code 05) will cancel a previously set Camp-On. Programs that may be affected with the changing the code.

Input Data
Prog. No. Item Call Forwarding / Do Not Disturb Override Activating Call Forwarding/Do Not Disturb Override. This code is only available if you disable the voice mail Single Digit dialing code in Program 11-16-09. Conference Override (Off-Hook Signaling) Camp on/Call Waiting Callback Cancel Camp on Switching of Voice Call and Signal Call Step Call Barge-In Change to STG All Ring Common Abbreviated Dialing Group Abbreviated Dialing Last Number Dial Saved Number Dial Trunk Group Access Specified Trunk Access Trunk Access Via Networking Clear Last Number Dialing Data Clear Saved Number Dialing Data Internal Group Paging External Group Paging Meet Me Answer to Specified Internal Paging Group Meet Me Answer to External Paging Meet Me Answer in Same Paging Group Paging Combined Direct Call Pickup - Own Group Call Pickup for Specified Group Call Pickup Call Pickup for Another Group Direst Extension Call Pickup Specified Trunk Answer Park Terminals Default Related Program 11-16-09

11-12-01 11-12-02 11-12-03 11-12-04 11-12-05 11-12-06 11-12-07 11-12-08 11-12-09 11-12-10 11-12-11 11-12-12 11-12-13 11-12-14 11-12-15 11-12-16 11-12-17 11-12-18 11-12-19 11-12-20 11-12-21 11-12-22 11-12-23 11-12-24 11-12-25 11-12-26 11-12-27 11-12-28 11-12-29 11-12-30 11-12-31

KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT

807 826 809 850 870 812 808 810 780 813 814 816 815 804 805 866 876 885 801 803 864 865 863 751 856 868 867 869 715 772 831

16-02

31-01-01

31-07

24-03

Programming Manual

- 66 -

IN SA SB
Input Data (Contd)
Prog. No. 11-12-32 11-12-33 11-12-34 11-12-35 11-12-36 11-12-37 11-12-38 11-12-39 11-12-40 11-12-41 11-12-42 11-12-43 11-12-44 11-12-45 11-12-46 11-12-47 11-12-48 11-12-49 11-12-50 11-12-51 11-12-52 11-12-53 11-12-54 11-12-55 11-12-56 11-12-57 11-12-58

Program11: System Numbering


11-12: Service Code Setup (for Service Access)
Item Answer for Park Group Hold Answer for Group Hold Extension Park Hold Doorphone Access Common Canceling Service Code -Not UsedVRS Access(for DSPDB) -Not Used-Not UsedFlash on Trunk Line Universal Answer Callback Test for SLT Enable On Hook When Holding (SLT) Answer On Hook When Holding (SLT) Call Waiting Answer / Split Answer for SLT Splitting (switching) between calls Account Code -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedTandem Trunking (Unsupervised Conference) Transfer into Conference Terminals KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT SLT SLT SLT SLT SLT SLT SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT Default 861 832 862 773 802 720 884 806 872 899 849 859 894 891 753 No Setting Related Program 24-03

14-05 14-06 15-03-07 15-03-08 11-12-03

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to chart above.

- 67 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-12: Service Code Setup (for Service Access) Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 11-12 (Service Code Setup(for Service Access)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 12

IN SA SB

11-12-01 Bypass Call 807


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-12-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 68 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-15: Service Code Setup (for Special Access)

Description
Use Program 11-15 : Service Code Setup, Administrative (for Special Access) to customize the special access Service Codes which are used by the administrator. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10 through 11-12 and 11-16. The following chart shows: The number of each code (01-11) The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code. The codes default entry. Programs that may be affected with the changing the code.

Input Data
Prog. No. 11-15-01 11-15-02 11-15-03 11-15-04 11-15-05 11-15-06 11-15-07 11-15-08 11-15-09 11-15-10 11-15-11 Item Remote Maintenance(PC Programming ) -Not UsedBackup Data Save -Not UsedSystem Programming Mode, Log-In -Not UsedRecording Destination in Dial-In Conversion Table Network Message Lamp Control Transfer to Trunk Ring Group Code Allows a call to be transferred to the Universal Night Answer External Paging zones. -Not UsedEthernet Port Reset Terminals KTS KTS Default 830 *9 ** No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting 16-02 Related Program

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to chart above.

- 69 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-15: Service Code Setup (for Special Access) Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 11-15 (Service Code Setup (for Special Access)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 15

IN SA SB

11-15-01 Remote Maint 830


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-15-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 70 -

IN SA SB

Program 11: System Numbering


11-16: One-Digit Service Code Setup

Description
Use Program 11-16 : One-Digit Service Code Setup to customize the one-digit Service Codes used when a busy or ring back signal is heard. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10 through 11-15. The following chart shows: The number of each code (01-10) The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code The codes default entry. For example, dialing 1 (code 03) when calling an extension will switch the call from either a voice or signal call (depending on how its currently defined). Programs that may be affected by changing these codes.

Input Data
Prog. No. 11-16-01 11-16-02 11-16-03 11-16-04 11-16-05 11-16-06 11-16-07 11-16-08 11-16-09 11-16-10 Item Step Call Barge-In Switching of Voice/ Signal Call Intercom Off Hook Signaling Camp-On DND/Call Forward Override Message Waiting -Not UsedAccess to Voice Mail STG All Ring Mode Terminals KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT KTS,SLT Default No setting No setting 1 No setting No setting No setting No setting No setting No setting Related Program

16-01-05

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to chart above.

- 71 -

Programming Manual

Program 11: System Numbering


11-16: One-Digit Service Code Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 11-16 (One-Digit Service Code Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 11 16

IN SA SB

11-16-01 Step Call


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

11-16-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 72 -

IN SA SB

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-01: Night Mode Function Setup

Description
Use Program 12-01 : Night Mode Function Setup to set up the Night Mode options. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

Input Data
Prog. No. 12-01-01 Item Manual Night Service Enable Automatic Night Service Input data 0 : Off 1 : On 0 : Off 1 : On Default 1 Description Related Program 11-10-01

Allows/prevents users from activating Night Service by dialing a service code. According to a preset schedule, enable 12-02 0 12-01-02 or disable Automatic Night Service for 12-03 the system. 12-04 Note: Even if the operation mode is changed manually, the operation mode changes according to the schedule set up.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 12-01 (Night Mode Function Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 01

12-01-01 Manual NT-Mode 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 73 -

Programming Manual

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-02: Automatic Night Service Patterns Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 12-02 : Automatic Night Service Patterns to define the daily pattern of the auto night switch setting. Each Night Mode Group has 10 patterns. These patterns are used in Programs 12-03 and 12-04. The daily pattern consists of 20 timer settings.

Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number 1-4

Time Pattern Number

01-10

Set Time Number

01-20

Start Time 0000-2359

End Time 0000-2359

Operation Mode 1-8

Example 1: 0:00

Time Pattern 1 9:00 12:00 13:00 Mode1 Mode4 Day Rest Mode1 Day 17:00 18:00 22:00 0:00 Mode4 Mode2 Mode3 Rest Night Midnight

Mode3 Midnight

To make the above schedule, it is necessary to set the data as follows: Time Setting 01 : 00:00 09:00 Mode 3 (Midnight) Time Setting 02 : 09:00 12:00 Mode 1 (Day) Time Setting 03 : 12:00 13:00 Mode 4 (Rest) Time Setting 04 : 13:00 17:00 Mode 1 (Day) Time Setting 05 : 17:00 18:00 Mode 4 (Rest) Time Setting 06 : 18:00 22:00 Mode 2 (Night) Time Setting 07 : 22:00 00:00 Mode 3 (Midnight)

Example 2: 0:00

Time Pattern 2 0:00 Mode2 Night

To make the above schedule, it is necessary to set the data as follows: Time Setting 01 : 00:00 00:00 Mode 2 (Night)

Programming Manual

- 74 -

IN - 75SA -3 SB
Default

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-02: Automatic Night Service Patterns

All groups, all patterns:00:00 to 00:00 = Mode 1 All Night Group are as follows;
Time Pattern 1 Set Time Number 01 02 03 04 : 20 Start Time 0000 0800 1700 0000 : 0000 End Time 0800 1700 0000 0000 : 0000 Mode 2 1 2 1 : 1

Time Pattern 2 Set Time Number 01 02 : 20 Start Time 0000 0000 : 0000 End Time 0000 0000 : 0000 Mode 2 1 : 1

Time Pattern 3 - 10 Set Time Number 01 : 20 Start Time 0000 : 0000 End Time 0000 : 0000 Mode 1 : 1

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

- 75 -

Programming Manual

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-02: Automatic Night Service Patterns Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 12-02 (Automatic Night Service Patterns): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 02

IN SA SB

12-02-01ModeGrp1 01-01Start=00:00
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-02-xxModeGrpx xxxxx 4. Select the Night Mode Service Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 76 -

IN - 77SA -5 SB

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-03: Weekly Night Service Switching

Description
Use Program 12-03 : Weekly Night Service Switching to define a weekly schedule of night-switch settings.

Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number

1-4

Day of the Week

Time Schedule Pattern Number

01 = Sunday 02 = Monday 03 = Tuesday 04 = Wednesday 05 = Thursday 06 = Friday 07 = Saturday

01-10

Default
Day of the Week Time Schedule Pattern Number

01 = Sunday 02 = Monday 03 = Tuesday 04 = Wednesday 05 = Thursday 06 = Friday 07 = Saturday

2 1 1 1 1 1 2

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

- 77 -

Programming Manual

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-03: Weekly Night Service Switching Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 12-03 (Weekly Night Service Switching): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 03

IN SA SB

12-03-01ModeGrp1 SUN = Pttrn 2


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-03-xxModeGrpx xxxxx 4. Select the Night Mode Service Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 78 -

IN SA SB

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-04: Holiday Night Service Switching

Description
Use Program 12-04 : Holiday Night Service Switching to define a yearly schedule of holiday night-switch settings. This schedule is used for setting of special days which the company is expected to be closed, such as national holiday.

Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number 1-4

Days and Months 0101-1231 (Ex. 0101 = Jan.1st, 1231 = Dec.31st)

Time Pattern Number 0-10 (0 : No Setting)

Default All Night group are no Holiday settings. Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 12-04 (Holiday Night service Switching): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 04

12-04-01ModeGrp1 Date01/01 Pttrn0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-04-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Night Mode Service Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 79 -

Programming Manual

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-05: Night Mode Group Assignment for Extensions Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 12-05 : Night Mode Group Assignment for Extensions to a assign Day/Night Mode Group for each extension.

Input Data
Extension Number Night Mode Service Group Number 1-4 Max.4 digits Default 1

Default No setting Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 12-05 (Night Mode Group Assignment for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 05

12-05-01 TEL200 Night Mode Grp 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-05-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 80 -

IN SA SB

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-06: Night Mode Group Assignment for Trunks

Description
Use Program 12-06 : Night Mode Group Assignment for Trunks to assign a Day/Night Mode Group for each trunk port.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number Night Mode Service Group Number 1-4 1-51 Default 1

Default No setting Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 12-06 (Night Mode Group Assignment for Trunks): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 06

12-06-01TrkPrt1 Night Mode Grp 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-06-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 81 -

Programming Manual

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-07: Text Data for Night Mode Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 12-07 : Text Data for Night Mode to make an original text message which is displayed on an LCD of key telephone in each Night Mode.

Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number 1-4

Day/ Night Mode

1-8

Text Message Data Maximum 8 Characters (alphabetic or numeric)

Default All Night Mode Service Group has the following default values;
Day/ Night Mode 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Text Message Data No setting Night M-Night Rest Day2 Night2 M-Night2 Rest2

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Night Service

Programming Manual

- 82 -

IN SA SB

Program 12: Night Mode Setup


12-07: Text Data for Night Mode

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 12-07(Text Data for Night Mode): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 12 07

12-07-01ModeGrp1 M1 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

12-07-xxModeGrpx xxxxx 4. Select the Night Mode Service Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 83 -

Programming Manual

Program 12: Night Mode Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 84 -

IN SA SB

Program 13: Abbreviated Dialing


13-01: Abbreviated Dialing Function Setup

Description
Use Program 13-01 : Abbreviated Dialing Function Setup to define the Abbreviated Dialing functions.

Input Data
Prog. No. 13-01-01 13-01-02 13-01-03 Item Abbreviated Dialing Auto Outgoing Call Mode Station Abbreviated Dial Number of Common Abbreviated Dialing Bins Input data 0 : Trunk outgoing mode 1 : Extension outgoing mode 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 100-2000 0 : No Common Abbreviated Dialing Bins (100 bins per 1 unit) Default 0 1 900 Related Program 13-05 13-06 13-04

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Abbreviated Dialing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 13-01 (Abbreviated Dialing Function Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 13 01

13-01-01 ABB Dial Mode 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

13-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 85 -

Programming Manual

Program 13: Abbreviated Dialing


13-02: Group Abbreviated Dialing Bins Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 13-02 : Group Abbreviated Dialing Bins to define the range of bin numbers to be used by each Abbreviated Dialing group (refer to Program 13-03).

Input Data
Abbreviated Dialing Group Number 1-32 Start Address of Abbreviated Dialing Bin 0-1990 End Address of Abbreviated Dialing Bin 0,9-1999

Default No setting Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Abbreviated Dialing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 13-02 (Group Abbreviated Dialing Bins): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 13 02

13-02-01ABB Gr1 ABB Start 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

13-02-xxABB Grxx xxxxx 4. Select the Abbreviated Dialing group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUMEor VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 86 -

IN SA SB

Program 13: Abbreviated Dialing


13-03:
Abbreviated Dialing Group Assignment for Extensions

Description
Use Program 13-03 : Abbreviated Dialing Group Assignment for Extensions to assign Abbreviated Dialing Group for each extension.

Input Data
Extension Number Up to 4 digits

Group Number 1-32

Default Value 1

Default No setting Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Abbreviated Dialing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 13-03 (Abbreviated Dialing Group Assignment for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 13 03

13-03-01 TEL200 Group 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

13-03-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 87 -

Programming Manual

Program 13: Abbreviated Dialing


13-04: Abbreviated Dialing Number and Name Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 13-04 : Abbreviated Dialing Number and Name to store Abbreviated Dialing data into the Abbreviated Dialing areas. This program is also used to define the names assigned to the Abbreviated Dialing numbers.

Input Data
Abbreviated Dialing Bin Number Prog. No. 13-04-01 13-04-02 13-04-03 Item Abbreviated Dialing Data Name Transfer Mode Input data 1-9,0,*,#,,P,R,@ (Max. 36 digits) Max. 12 Characters 0 : Not defined 1 : Internal Dial 2 : Incoming Ring Group (IRG) If Transfer mode are; 1:Internal Dial Mode 1-9, 0, *, #, P,R,@ (Max 36 Characters) 2:Incoming Ring Group: 0-25 (IRG Number) 0-1999 Default No Setting No Setting 0 No Setting Related Program

Destination Number

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Abbreviated Dialing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 13-04(Abbreviated Dialing Number and Name): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 13 04

13-04-01 ABB0 Dial=


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

13-04-xx ABBxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Abbreviated Dialing Bin number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 88 -

IN SA SB

Program 13: Abbreviated Dialing


13-05: Abbreviated Dialing Trunk Group

Description
Use Program 13-05 : Abbreviated Dialing Trunk Group to define the trunk group to be seized for each Abbreviated Dialing number (refer to Program 13-05). If this program has an entry of 0 (no setting), then seizing a line follows the trunk access group routing of the callers extension (refer to Program 14-06). This setting is only available in External Abbreviated Dialing Mode (Program 13-01-01).

Input Data
Abbreviated Dialing Bin Number 0-1999

Trunk Group Number 0-25

Default No setting Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Abbreviated Dialing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 13-05(Abbreviated Dialing Trunk Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 13 05

13-05-01 ABB0 TRK Group No 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

13-05-xx ABBxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Abbreviated Dialing Area number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 89 -

Programming Manual

Program 13: Abbreviated Dialing


13-06: Station Abbreviated Dialing Number and Name Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 13-06 : Station Abbreviated Dialing Number and Name to store Abbreviated Dialing data into the Station Abbreviated Dialing areas. This program is also used to define the names assigned to the Station Abbreviated Dialing numbers.

Input Data
Extension Number Up to 4 digits

Station Abbreviated Dialing Bin Number Prog. No. 13-06-01 Item Abbreviated Dialing Data Name Input data 1-9,0,*,#,,P,R,@ (Max. 36 digits) Max. 12 Characters

01-20 Default No Setting Related Program 13-01-02

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Abbreviated Dialing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 13-06(Station Abbreviated Dialing Number and Name): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 13 06

13-06-01 TEL200 01:


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

13-06-xx TELxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 90 -

IN SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


COPY

14-01: Basic Trunk Data Setup

Description
Use Program 14-01 : Basic Trunk Data Setup to set the basic options for each trunk port. Refer to the chart below for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Prog. No. 14-01-01

Item Trunk Name Set the names for trunks. The trunk name displays at display keysets for incoming and outgoing calls. Transmit CODEC Gain Type Use this option to select the CODEC gain for the trunk. The option sets the amount of gain (signal amplification) for the trunk you are programming. Receive CODEC Gain Type Use this option to select the CODEC gain for the trunk. The option sets the amount of gain (signal amplification) for the trunk you are programming. Transmit Gain Level for Conference and Transfer Calls Use this option to select the CODEC gain type used by the trunk when it is part of an Unsupervised Conference. Receive Gain Level for Conference and Transfer Calls Use this option to select the CODEC gain type used by the trunk when it is part of an Unsupervised Conference. SMDR Print Out Use this option to have the system include/exclude the trunk you are programming form the SMDR printout. See Program 35-01 and 35-02 for SMDR printout options. Outgoing Calls Use this option to allow/prevent outgoing calls on the trunk you are programming.

Input data Up to 12 Characters

Default Refer below

Related Program

14-01-02

1-63 (-15.5dB - +15.5dB in 0.5dB intervals)

32 (0 dB)

14-01-03

1-63 (-15.5dB - +15.5dB in 0.5dB intervals)

32 (0 dB)

14-01-04

1-63 (-15.5dB - +15.5dB in 0.5dB intervals)

22 (-5dB)

14-01-05

1-63 (-15.5dB - +15.5dB in 0.5dB intervals)

22 (-5dB)

14-01-06

0 : No Printout 1 : Printout

14-01-07

0 : Prevented 1 : Allowed

- 91 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-01: Basic Trunk Data
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 14-01-08 Item Toll Restriction Use this option to enable/disabled Toll Restriction for the trunk. If enabled, the trunk follows Toll Restriction programming (ex: Programs 21-05, 21-06). If disabled, the trunk is a toll free line. -Not usedDTMF tone for Outgoing Calls Use this option to enable (1) or disable (0) DTMF back tones for outgoing trunk calls. Account Code required -Not UsedLoop Disconnect Supervision Use this option to enable (1) or disable (0) loop supervision for the trunk. This option is required for Call Forwarding Off-Premise and Tandem Trunking only. Long Conversation Cutoff Use this option to enable or disable the Long Conversation Cutoff feature for each trunk. Long Conversation Alarm before Cutoff Use this option to enable or disable the Long Conversation Alarm for each trunk. Forced Release of Held Call Use this option to enable/disable forced release for calls on Hold. If enabled, the system disconnects a call if it is on Hold longer than a programmed interval (Program 24-01-05). If disabled, forced disconnection does not occur. Program 24-01-01 also affects this option. Trunk to Trunk Warning Tone for Long Conversation Alarm Use this option to enable or disable the Warning Tone for Long Conversation feature for DISA callers. Input data 0 : Restriction Disable 1 : Restriction Enable Default 1

COPY

IN SA SB

Related Program 21-04 21-05 21-06

14-01-09 14-01-10

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

14-01-11 14-01-12 14-01-13

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

1 0

14-01-14

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

20-21-03 20-21-04

14-01-15

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

14-01-16

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

14-01-17

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

Programming Manual

- 92 -

IN SA SB
Prog. No. 14-01-18 14-01-19

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


COPY
Item Warning Beep Tone Signaling Privacy Mode Toggle Option Use this option to enable or disable a trunks ability to be switched from private to non-private mode by pressing the line key or Privacy Release function key. Block Outgoing Caller-ID Allow (0) or Block (1) the system from automatically blocking outgoing Caller ID information when a user places a call. If allowed (i.e. block, enabled), the system automatically inserts the Caller ID block code (defined in 14-01-21) before the user dialed digits. Caller-ID Block Code Enter the code, up to 8 digits, that should be used as the Caller ID Block Code. This code is automatically inserted before dialed digits if Program 14-01-20 is set to 1. Caller-ID to Voice Mail Enable or disable the systems ability to send the Caller ID digits (Remote Log-On Protocol) to voice mail. Least Cost Routing

14-01: Basic Trunk Data Setup


Input data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Default 0 0 Related Program

Input Data(Contd)

14-01-20

0 : Allow 1 : Block

14-01-21

0 : Dial (Up to 8 digits) 1 : Enable

No setting

14-01-22

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

14-01-23

14-01-24

Trunk to Trunk Outgoing Caller-ID Through Mode

0 : LCR Off 1 : LCR On 2 : LCR On (Cost Center Code only) 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

26-01-04 26-05 to 26-08

Default 14-01-01: Trunk Name


Trunk Port Number 1 2 : 51 Name Line 01 Line02 : Line 51

Conditions None

- 93 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-01: Basic Trunk Data Feature Cross Reference
Refer to feature in above chart.

COPY

IN SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-01(Basic Trunk Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 01

14-01-01 Trunk1 TRK Name-Line 00


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-01-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 94 -

IN SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


COPY

14-02: Analogue Trunk Data Setup

Description
Use Program 14-02 : Analogue Trunk Data Setup to set the basic options for each analogue trunk port. Refer to the chart below for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number Prog. No. 14-02-01 Item Signaling Type(DP/DTMF) This option sets the signaling type for the trunk. Ring Detect Type This option to sets Extended Ring Detect or Immediate Ring Detect for the trunk. Flash Type This option to select the Flash type(open loop flash or ground). Always set this option for open loop flash. Flash for Timed Flash or Disconnect This option lets you use Flash for Timed Flash (Program 81-01-14) or Disconnect (Program 81-01-15). (A user implements Flash by pressing the FLASH key while on a trunk call.) Dial Tone Detection for Directly Accessed Trunks Use this option enable/disable dial tone detection for directly accessed trunks. If disabled, the system out dials on the trunks without monitoring for dial tone. Pause at 1st digit after line seize in manual dial mode DP to DTMF Conversion Options Determine how a user can convert a Dial Pulse (DP) call to a DTMF call. For each trunk, set the type of DP to DTMF conversion required. There are three conversion options: Automatic (0), Automatic and Manual (1), or Manual (2). Automatic: DP to DTMF conversion occurs automatically if the extension user waits more than 10 seconds before dialing the next digit. Automatic and Manual: DP to DTMF conversion occurs automatically if the extension user waits more than 10 seconds before dialing the next digit. In addition, the user can dial # to switch a DP trunk to DTMF dialing. Manual: User can dial # to switch a DP trunk to DTMF dialing Answering Condition 1-51 Input data 0 : Dial Pulse (10pps) 1 : Dial Pulse (20pps) 2 : DTMF 0 : Normal/ Delayed 1 : Immediately ringing 0 : Open Loop Flash 1 : Ground Default 2 Related Program

14-02-02

14-02-03

14-02-04

0 : Timed Flash 1 : Disconnect

14-02-05

0 : DTD not used 1 : DTD used

14-02-06 14-02-07

0 : No Pause 1 : Pause 0 : Automatic 1 : Automatic and Manual 2 : Manual

1 2 21-01-03

14-02-08

0 : Polarity reversing 1 : Polarity reversing or timer

21-01-03

- 95 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-02: Analogue Trunk Data Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 14-02-09 14-02-10 Busy Tone Detection Caller-ID Enable or Disable a trunks ability to receive Caller ID information Next Trunk in Rotary if No Dial Tone Use this option to enable/disable the systems ability to skip over a trunk if dial tone is not detected. This option pertains to calls placed using Loop Keys, Speed Dial, ARS, Last Number Redial or Save Number dialed. It does not pertain to line key or Direct Trunk Access calls. Detect Network Disconnect Signal Trunk-to-Trunk Limitation Loop Start/Ground Start -Not UsedCaller-ID Type for Analogue Trunk Item Input data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Default 0 0

COPY

IN SA SB
Related Program

14-02-11

14-02-12 14-02-13 14-02-14 14-02-15 14-02-16

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Loop Start 1 : Ground Start 0 : FSK 1 : DTMF

0 0 0 0 -

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-02(Analogue Trunk Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 02

14-02-01 Trunk1 DP/DTMF 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-02-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 96 -

IN SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


COPY

14-04: Behind PBX Setup

Description
Use Program 14-04 : Behind PBX Setup to indicate if the trunk is installed behind a PBX. There is one item for each of the Night Service Modes:

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/ Night Mode 1-8

Type of Connection 0 : Stand Alone 1 : Behind PBX

Default 0

Related Program 22-02

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Placing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-04(Behind PBX Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 04

14-04-01 Trunk1 Mode1 Connect= 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-04-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 97 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-05: Trunk Groups Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 14-05 : Trunk Groups to assign trunks to Trunk Groups. You can also assign the outbound priority for trunks within the group. When users dial up the trunk group, they seize the trunks in the order you specify in the outbound priority entry.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Trunk Group Number 0-25

Order Number 1-51

Default Trunk Port 1 : 51 Group 1 : 1 Priority(Order) 1 : 51

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Trunk Groups

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-05(Trunk Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 05

14-05-01 Trunk1 Group No. 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-05-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 98 -

IN SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-06: Trunk Group Routing

Description
Use Program 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing to set up an outbound routing table for the trunk groups you assigned in Program 14-05. When users dial 9, the system routes their calls in the order (priority) you specify. For example, if a user dials 9 and all calls in the first group are busy, the system may route the call to another group. Trunk Access Map programming (Programs 14-07) may limit this option. The system contains 25 routing tables for trunk access. Each table has four priority orders for trunk access. Level: Aspire Example for setting: With less than 4 trunk groups, Route number 1 : Order 1 Trunk group 1 : Order 2 Trunk group 2 For the above setting, if all the lines in trunk group 1 are busy, the system searches for an idle line in trunk group 2. With more than 4 trunk groups, Route number 1 : Order 1 Trunk group 1 : Order 2 Trunk group 2 : Order 3 Trunk group 3 : Order 4 1002 (Jump to Route number 2) Route number 2 : Order 1 Trunk group 4 : Order 2 Trunk group 5 For the above setting, if all the lines in the trunk group 1, 2 and 3 are busy, the system searches for an idle line in trunk group 4 and 5.

Input Data
Route Table Number 1-25

Priority Order Number 1-4

Input Data 0 : Not Specified 001-025 : (Trunk Group Number) 1001-1025 : (1000 + Route Table Number)

Related Program 14-01-07 14-05 15-01-02 21-02

Default Route 1, Order Number 1 = 1 (Trunk Group 1), Order Numbers 2, 3, 4 = 0 (not specified) All Other Routes (2-25) and Order Numbers (1-4) = 0 (not specified) Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Trunk Groups

- 99 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-06: Trunk Group Routing Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 14-06(Trunk Group Routing): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 06

IN SA SB

14-06-01 R-TBL1 Order1 Data1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-06-xx R-TBLxx xxxxx 4. Select the Route Table number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 100 -

IN SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-07: Trunk Access Map Setup

Description
Use Program 14-07 : Trunk Access Map Setup to set up the Trunk Access Maps. This sets an extensions access options for trunks. For example, an extension can only place outgoing calls on trunks to which it has outgoing access. There are 51 Access Maps with all 51 trunk ports programmed in Map 1 with full access. An extension can use one of the maps you set up in this program. Use Program 15-06 to assign Trunk Access Maps to extensions. Each trunk can have one of eight access options for each Access Map.

Input Data
Access Map Number 1-51

Trunk Port Number

Input Data 0 : No Access 1 : Outgoing Access only 2 : Incoming Access only 3 : Access when trunk on Hold 4 : Outgoing Access and Access when trunk on Hold 5 : Incoming Access and Access when trunk on Hold 6 : Incoming and Outgoing Access 7 : Incoming Access, Outgoing Access and Access when trunk on Hold

1-51

Default Access Map Number 1 Trunk Port Number 1 2 : 51 1 2 : 51 1 2 : 51 1 2 : 51 Default 7 7 : 7 0 0 : 0 0 0 : 0 0 0 : 0

51

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Answering Central Office Call, Placing

- 101 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-07: Trunk Access Map Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 14-07(Trunk Access Map Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 07

IN SA SB

14-07-01Acs.Map1 TRK01 = 7
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-07-xxAcs.Mapx xxxxx 4. Select the Access Map number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 102 -

IN SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


COPY

14-08: Music on Hold Source for Trunks

Description
Use Program 14-08 : Music on Hold Source for Trunks to define a trunks Music on Hold source as either the ACI or BGM port. Note: If ACI is selected as the source in Item 1, the port number for the source must be selected in Item 2.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Prog. No. 14-08-01

Item MOH Type Select a trunks Music on Hold source. Source Port Number for MOH

Input Data 0 : Internal synthesized MOH 1 : A customer-provided source connected to BGM port. 2 : A customer-provided source connected to ACI port. 0-6 If the MOH type is 2, the source port number is 0-6.

Default 0

14-08-02

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Music on Hold

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-08(Music on Hold Source for Trunks): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 08

14-08-01 Trunk1 MOH Type 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-08-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 103 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-09: Conversation Recording Destination for Trunks Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 14-09 : Conversation Recording Destination for Trunks to set the Conversation Recording destination for each trunk. Note: If both Programs 14-09 and 15-12 define a destination, the destination in Program 15-12 will be followed.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Prog. No. 14-09-01

Item Recording Destination Extension Number

Input Data

Default

Extension Number No (Up to 4 digits) setting 0 : Off 0 Automatic Recording 14-09-02 1 : On 0 : Specifies by Dialing 0 Recording Contents Storing Method 14-09-03 1 : Own Mailbox 0 : Off 0 Automatic Recording for Outgoing Call 14-09-04 1 : On If automatic telephone call recording is set-up, the recording will be started from the time of answering an incoming call. If the PRG14-09-04 is set to 1 , the recording will be started from the time of answering an outgoing call. In case of Conversation recording by the SLT; If the recording destination is set to Voice Mailbox, the service of the feature is only available for the Automatic Conversation Recording and the conversation recording is automatically storing to own mailbox.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-09(Conversation Recording Destination for Trunks): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 09

14-09-01 Trunk1 Rec Dest Ext


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-09-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 104 -

MF SA SB

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup


14-11: ID Setup for IP Trunk

Description
Use Program 14-11: ID Setup for IP Trunk to set the ID for IP Trunk. Note1: This Data is referred to at IP trunk outgoing call or IP trunk incoming call. Note2: This ID is notified at IP trunk outgoing call. Note3: It is not notified when ID is 0. Note4: Incoming Call arrives to the trunk port of the same ID as ID notified from the partner system.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Prog. No. 14-11-01

Input Data ID 0-655350No setting

Default 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VOIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 14-11(ID Setup for IP Trunk): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 14 11

14-11-01 Trunk1 ID 0
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

14-11-xx Trunkxx ID xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 105 -

Programming Manual

Program 14: Trunk Basic Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 106 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-01: Basic Extension Data Setup

Description
Use Program 15-01 : Basic Extension Data Setup to define the basic settings for each extension.

Input Data
Extension Number Max 4 digits

Prog. No. 15-01-01

Item Extension Name Set the extension/virtual extension name Outgoing Trunk Line Preference Use this option to set the extensions outgoing Trunk Line Preference. If enabled, the extension user get trunk dial tone when they lift the handset. The user hears trunk dial tone only if allowed by Trunk Access Map programming (Programs 14-07 and 15-06). Refer to the Line Preference feature for more details. SMDR Printout Use this option to include or exclude the extension you are programming in the SMDR report. Calling Party Number notification (ISDN Trunk) The terminal for restriction in Outgoing Disable On Incoming Line

Input data Up to 12 Characters

Default 200: EXT200 : 295: EXT295 0

Related Program

15-01-02

0 : Off 1 : On

14-06 21-02

15-01-03

0: Do not print on SMDR report 1: Include on SMDR report 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Supervise dial detection 1 : Not Supervise dial detection

15-01-04 15-01-05

21-01-15 21-01-16 21-01-17

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to feature in above chart.

- 107 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-01: Basic Extension Data Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 15-01(Basic Extension Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 01

COPY

IN SA SB

15-01-01 TEL ExtName-EXT 200


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-01-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 108 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-02: Multi-Line Telephone Basic Data Setup

Description
Use Program 15-02 : Multi-Line Telephone Basic Data Setup to set up various keyset options.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Prog. No. 15-02-01

Item Display Language Selection

Input data 1 : English 5 : Spanish 7 : Portuguese 0 : Common and individual Abbreviated Dialing 1 : Group Abbreviated Dialing

Default 1

Related Program

15-02-02 15-02-03 15-02-04

-Not Used-Not UsedAbbreviated Dialing DIAL Key Control Use this option to control the function of the extensions DIAL key when used with Abbreviated Dialing. The DIAL key can access either the Common or Group Abbreviated Dialing numbers. Transfer Key Operation Mode Use this option to set the operation mode of the extensions CONF (TRF) key. The keys can be for Call Transfer, Serial Calling or Flash. When selecting the Flash option (selection 2), refer also to Program 81-01-14. Hold Key Operation Mode Use this option to set the function of the keyset Hold key.The Hold key can activate normal Hold, Exclusive Hold or Park. Automatic Hold for Trunk Key During Trunk Call, press other Trunk key to make a hold or disconnect. Pre-select/One-touch Key Use this option to answer the Incoming Trunk call or hold line by pressing Trunk key. Ringing Line Preference for Intercom Calls Use this option to select between Idle and Ringing Line Preference for Intercom Call. Ringing Line Preference for Trunk Calls Use this option to select between Idle and Ringing Line Preference for Trunk Call.

15-02-05

0 : Transfer 1 : Series call 2 : Flash

15-02-06

0 : Normal Hold 1 : Exclusive Hold 2 : Park Hold 0 : Enable (Hold) 1 : Disable (Disconnect) 0 : Pre-select 1 : One-touch

15-02-07

15-02-08

15-02-09

0 : Off 1 : On

15-02-10

0 : Off 1 : On

- 109 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-02: Multi-Line Telephone Basic Data Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 15-02-11 Item Callback Automatic Answer Use this option to enable or disable automatic answer for Callback. If enabled, extension automatically Answers Callback ringing when user lifts the Handset. If disabled, user must press line appearance key to answer Callback. Off Hook Signaling Use this option to set the keysets Off Hook Signaling. Off Hook Signaling occurs when a keyset user receives a second call while busy on the Handset Call. To enable/disable Off Hook Signaling for an extensions Class of Service Redial List Mode Select whether the Redial List feature should store internal and external numbers (0), or only external numbers (1). -Not UsedStorage of Caller-ID for answered call Handsfree Operation Power Saving Mode -Not Used-Not UsedVirtual Extension Access Mode (when idle Virtual Extension Key pressed) Determine whether an extensions Virtual Extension/Call Coverage Key should be for placing and receiving calls (0), or just receiving incoming calls (2). Multiple Incoming Call from Intercom and Trunk Abbreviated dial Preview Mode -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used0 : Off 1 : On Input data Default 1

COPY

IN SA SB
Related Program

15-02-12

0 : Muted Off Hook Ringing 1 : No Off Hook Ringing 2 : Not Used 3 : 1 beep tone on Speaker 4 : 1 beep tone on Handset

15-02-13

0 : Extension/Trunk Mode 1 : Trunk Mode

15-02-14 15-02-15 15-02-16 15-02-18 15-02-19 15-02-20 15-02-21

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Normal Mode 1 : Power Saving Mode 0 : DSS(Inbound/Outbound) 1 : Outgoing 2 : Ignore Key(Inbound)

1 1 1 2

15-02-22

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Preview 1 : Outgoing immediately -

15-02-23 15-02-24 15-02-25 15-02-26

0 -

Programming Manual

- 110 -

IN SA SB
Conditions
None

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-02: Multi-Line Telephone Basic Data Setup

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to feature in above chart.

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-02(Multi-Line Telephone Basic Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 02

15-02-01 TEL200 Language 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-02-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 111 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-03: Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup Description
COPY

IN SA SB

Use Program 15-03 : Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup to set up various Single Line Telephone options.

Input Data
Extension Number Max.4 digits

Prog. No. 15-03-01 15-03-02 15-03-03

Item SLT Signaling Type -Not UsedTerminal Type Enter 1 for this option to allow a single line port to receive DTMF tones after the initial call setup. Enter 0 to have the port ignore DTMF tones after the initial call setup. For Voice Mail, always enter 1 (e.g., receive DTMF tones). Flashing Enables/disables Flash(Hold) for single line telephones. -Not Used-Not UsedEnabled on hook when holding and press Service code (SLT) Answer on hook when holding (SLT) Extension Number Display Caller Name Display Caller-ID Type for External Module FSK(0) or DTMF(1) the Caller ID signal for an external Caller ID module. Important: If voice mail is used, this setting must be disabled or the system integration codes for disconnect will be incorrect. Fixed Cadence Select Normal Ring or Fixed (2sOn/4sOff) Ring when incoming call is being received.

Input data 0 : Dial Pulse 1 : DTMF 0 : Normal 1 : Special

Default 1 0

Related Program

15-03-04

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : FSK 1 : DTMF

15-03-05 15-03-06 15-03-07 15-03-08 15-03-09 15-03-10 15-03-11

1 1 0 1 0 15-03-09 11-12-45 11-12-46

15-03-12

0 : Normal 1 : Fixed (2s On/4s Off)

Programming Manual

- 112 -

IN SA SB

Program15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-03: Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup

-External Line Reverse & Internal Line Reverse(1) Normal Outgoing Call Idle Idle Reverse (2) (3) (4) (5)

(1) (2)

Off-Hook Calling/Ringing Answer Detect Hang Up On-Hook

Normal Incoming Call Idle Idle Reverse Normal Call Pickup Idle Reverse

(3) (4) (5)

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Single Line Telephone, Analogue

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-03(Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 03

15-03-01 TEL200 SLT Method 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-03-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 113 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-05: IP Phone Terminal Basic Data Setup Description
Use Program 15-05 : IP Phone Terminal Basic Data Setup to set up the basic setting for an IP Phone.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Prog. No. 15-05-01

Item Terminal Type

Input data 0 : NGT 1 : H.323 2 : SIP 3 : MEGACO MAC address 00-00-00-00-00-00 to FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF URL address

Default -

Description *For Viewing only. This item should not be changed. The MAC Address of a terminal which registers extension number

Related Program

15-05-02

NGT fixed port assignment Default URL Address Nickname assignment

15-05-01

00-00-00-00-00-00

15-05-03

No setting The Nickname is set up (In the case of H.323 terminal, an alias address is set up). Each Nickname must be unique in the System.

15-05-01

15-05-04

Up to 48 Character Length

No setting

15-05-01

15-05-05 to 15-05-11 15-05-05

For Viewing only H.323 Terminal Type NGT Terminal Type Using IP address H.323 RAS Port Call Procedure Port NGT Voice Path Port NGT Call Procedure Port System Type

These items should not be changed. 0

1 = Standard H.323 Terminal 2 = Net Meeting 0.0.0.0 255.255.255.255 0-65535 0-65535

15-05-06

0.0.0.0 0 0

15-05-07 15-05-08 15-05-09

15-05-10 15-05-11

0-65535

0 0

15-05-12

0 : Not Used 1 : Topaz system

For System Interconnection

Programming Manual

- 114 -

IN SA SB
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 15-05-13 Item IP Address of other system Call Control Port of other System CODEC Type

Program15: Extension Basic Setup


15-05: IP Phone Terminal Basic Data Setup
Input data
1.0.0.1-126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1-191.255.255.254 192.0.1.1-223.255.255.254

Default 0.0.0.0

Description Set the IP address of the networked system Set the call control port of networked system

Related Program 15-05-12

15-05-14

1-65535

1720

15-05-12 15-05-01 84-11

15-05-15

1 : Type 1 2 : Type 2 3 : Type 3 4 : Type 4 5 : Type 5 Max.24 characters 0 : Nickname 1 : Display Name 2 : User Part 3 : Extension 0 : Not Use 1-10: Group1-10

15-05-16 MF Level 15-05-17 MF Level

Authentication Password Calling Party Display Info IP duplication allowed group

No Setting 0

Set the required Password for Registrar Set the Calling Party Display Information Type Set the Overlap IP address group

15-05-01

15-05-01

15-05-18 MF Level

15-05-01

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-05(IP-Phone Terminal Basic Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 05

15-05-01 TEL200 IP-Phone Type 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-05-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 115 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-06: Trunk Access Map for Extensions Description
COPY

IN SA SB

Use Program 15-06 : Trunk Access Map for Extensions to define the trunk access map for each extension. An extension can only place outgoing calls on trunks to which it has outgoing access. Use Program 14-07 to define the available 51 access maps.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Trunk Access Map No. 1-51

Default 1

Related Program 14-07

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Answering Central Office Calls, Placing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-06(Trunk Access Map for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 06

15-06-01 TEL200 Mode1 Acc-Map1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-06-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 116 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-07: Programmable Function Keys

Description
Use Program 15-07 : Programmable Function Keys to set the functions of an extensions Programmable Function Key. For certain functions, you can append data to the keys basic function. For example, the function 26 appended by data 1 makes a Group Call Pickup key for Pickup Group 1. You can also program Function Keys using Service codes. In order to clear any previously programmed key, press the CLEAR key to erase any displayed code.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Line Key Number 01-46 (KTS with DLS)

Function Number 0-99 : Normal Function Number *00-*99 : Appearance Function Number

Additional data Refer to the Function code List

Default
Key Number KY01 KY02 : KY12 KY13 : KY21 KY22 Function Number *01(Trunk Line Key) *01(Trunk Line Key) : *01(Trunk Line Key) 00 (No Setting) : 00 (No Setting) *05(Hybrid Operation Key(Loop key)) KY23 : KY46 00 (No Setting) : 00 (No Setting) 0 : 0 Additional Data 1 2 : 12 0 : 0 2

- 117 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-06: Trunk Access Map for Extensions
1. Function Number List
Function Number 00 01 Function Not defined DSS/One-Touch Extension number or any numbers(Max. 36 digits) Red On: Extension Busy Off : Extension Idle Rapid Blink(Red): DND Forward Setup Red-On : MIC On Off: MIC Off Red-On : DND Setup Red-On : BGM On Off : BGM Off Red On: Headset Operating None Red-On : Conference Operating Additional Data LED Indication

COPY

IN SA SB

or

Call

02 03 04 05 06 07 08

Microphone Key (ON/OFF) DND Key BGM(ON/OFF) Headset Transfer Key Conference Key Incoming Caller-ID List

09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23

Operation Mode Switch Call Forward-Immediate Call Forward-Busy Call Forward-No Answer Call Forward-Busy/No Answer Call Forward-Both Ring Call Forward - Follow Me Call Forward to Station Call Forward to Device Text Message Setup External Group Paging External All Call Paging Internal Group Paging Internal All Call Paging Meet-Me Answer to Internal Paging

Mode number(1-8)

Slow Blink(Red):Existing New CID Red-On : Existing Check CID Off : No CID Red On : On mode Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Slow Blink(Red): Forwarding state Rapid Blink(Red):Forwarded State Red On: Feature active by Function Key Red On : Active Red On : Active

Message No.(00-20) External Paging Zone No. (1-6) Internal Paging No.1-32

Red On : Active None None

Programming Manual

- 118 -

IN SA SB
Function Number 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY
Function Call Pickup for Own Group Call Pickup for Another Group Call Pickup for Specified Group Abbreviated DialCommon/Private Abbreviated DialGroup Repeat Dial Saved Number Redial Memo Dial Meet-Me Conference Off-Hook Signaling Break-In Camp-On, Call-Back Department Step Call DND/FWD Override Call Message Waiting Room Monitor Handset Transmission Cut-off Secretary(Buzzer) Call Boss-Secretary Call Series Call Common Hold Exclusive Hold Department Group Log Out -Not Used-Not UsedCall Redirect Extension Number Voice Mail Number (Max.4 digits) or

15-07: Programmable Function Keys


Additional Data None None Call Pickup Group Number 01-32 Abbreviated dial No. (Common/ Private) Abbreviated dial No. (Group) None None None Rapid Blink (Red) : Under a repeat dial None None None None None Red-On : Under Camp-On or reservation None None None Rapid Blink(Red) : Monitored Slow Blink(Red) : Monitoring Red On: Transmission Cut-off Extension No. (Max.4 digits) Extension No. (Max.4 digits) Red On : Transmission Side Rapid Blink(Red) : Receiver Side Red On : Boss-Secretary mode None None None Red On : Logged out None LED Indication

Input Data(Contd)

50

Account Code

None

- 119 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-07: Programmable Function Keys
Input Data(Contd)
Function Number 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 63 64 65 66 67 Function -Not UsedIncoming Call Queuing Message Setup Queuing Message Starting External Call Forward by Doorphone Box Extension Name Edit Presence Display Operation Presence Display Indication Department Incoming CallImmediate Department Incoming Call Delay Department Incoming Call DND Outgoing Call Without Caller-ID(ISDN) -Not Used-Not UsedCTI Communication Mail Box(DSPDBU) Extension No. or Department Group No. (Max.4 digits) 1-100 1-100 Extension 01-32 Extension 01-32 Extension 01-32 Group Group Group No. No. No. Incoming No.1-25 Ring Group Additional Data Red On : Under setting Red On : Active Red On : Active None Red On : Presence Red On : Presence Slow Blink(red) : Active Slow Blink(red) : Active Slow Blink(red) : Active Red On : Active Red On : CTI active LED Indication

COPY

IN SA SB

68

Voice Mail Service (DSPDBU)

0 : Skip 1 : Back Skip 2 : Monitor 0 : Conversation recording 1 : Delete, Re-recording 2 : Delete 3 : Immediate delivery Extension No. or Department Group No. (Max.4 digits)

69

Conversation Recording Service(DSPDBU)

70

Automated Attendant for Extension(DSPDBU)

Rapid Blink(Green) : New Message Received Red On : Listening to messages Slow Flash : New Message Restriction Mode 2..In case of Monitor mode; Slow Blink(Red) : Monitor settingAutomatic Red On : Monitor setting- Manual 0..In case of conversation recording Rapid Blink(Red): Under recording (No Destination) Red On : Under recording (Appointed Extension) Red On : Setup All Calls Rapid Blink(Red) : Setup No Answer Calls Slow Blink(Red) : Busy / No Answer Calls Wink Blink(Red) : Busy Calls

Programming Manual

- 120 -

IN SA SB
Function Number 71

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY
Function Change Attendant Message(DSPDBU) -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedToll Restriction in Credit -Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedTandem Ring Setup Key Automatic Transfer to Transfer Key

15-07: Programmable Function Keys


Additional Data Extension Number or Pilot Number (Max.4 digits) Extension Number (Max.4 digits) (Max.4 digits) Trunk Line No.1-51 None LED Indication

Input Data(Contd)

72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81

Red On : Master Side Red On : Set

2. Appearance Function Level (*00-*99)


Function Number *00 *01 *02 *03 Not used Trunk Key Trunk Group/ Loop Key Virtual Extension Key Trunk Number 1-51 Trunk Group Number 01- 25 Extension Number. or Department Group Number (Max.4 digits) Park Number 01-64 0-2 0 : Incoming 1 : Outgoing 2 : Both Function Additional Data LED Indication

*04 *05

Park Hold Key Hybrid Operation Key(Loop key)

Conditions When a key is programmed using service code 852, that key cannot be programmed with a function using the 851 code until the key is undefined (000).

- 121 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-07: Programmable Function Keys Feature Cross Reference
Refer to chart above

COPY

IN SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-07(Programmable Function Keys): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 07

15-07-01 TEL200 KY01 = *01


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-07-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 122 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-08: Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup

Description
Use Program 15-08 : Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup to assign a ring tone range (0-4) to incoming virtual extensions assigned to a Virtual Extension key (Program 15-07). If you enable ringing for the key in Program 15-09, the key rings with the tone you set in this program. Also see Program 22-03. The chart below shows the available tones.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Incoming Ring Pattern 0 : Tone Pattern 1 1 : Tone Pattern 2 2 : Tone Pattern 3 3 : Tone Pattern 4 4 : Incoming Extension Ring Tone

Default 0: Tone Pattern 1

Description When an extension or a virtual extension is assigned to the function key on the key telephone, select the ring tone when receiving a call on that key.

Incoming Signal Frequency Pattern 0: Tone Pattern 1 1: Tone Pattern 2 2: Tone Pattern 3 3: Tone Pattern 4 4: Incoming Extension Ring Tone

Frequency 600/450/16Hz 450/16Hz 600Hz 600/450/16Hz

Modulation FM AM FM

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Multiple Directory Number/ Call Coverage

- 123 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-08: Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 15-08(Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 08

COPY

IN SA SB

15-08-01 TEL200 ICM Tone Pttrn 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-08-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 124 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-09: Virtual Extension Ring Assignment

Description
Use Program 15-09 : Virtual Extension Ring Assignment to assign the ringing options for an extensions Virtual Extension Key or Virtual Extension Group Answer Key which is defined in Program 15-07. You make an assignment for each Night Service Mode. Assign extension numbers and names to virtual extension ports in Program 15-01. Program Virtual Extension keys in Program 15-07 (code *03).

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Key Number (KTS with DLS)

01-46

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Ringing data 0 : No Ringing 1 : Ring

Default 0

Conditions Program the Multiple Directory Number function keys NOT to ring before removing the key from keysets programming.

Feature Cross Reference


Multiple Directory Number / Call Coverage

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-09(Virtual Extension Ring Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 09

15-09-01 TEL200 KY01 Mode1 = 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-09-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 125 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-10: Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup COPY

IN SA SB

Description
Use Program 15-10 : Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup to set the priority (1-4) for the Virtual Extension Ring Tones set in Program 15-08. When Virtual Extension calls ring an extension simultaneously, the tone with the highest order number (e.g., 1) rings. The other keys just flash.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits Related Program

Order

Data 0 : Tone Pattern 1 1 : Tone Pattern 2 2 : Tone Pattern 3 3 : Tone Pattern 4 4 : Incoming Extension ring tone

Description In the case of that two or more virtual extensions are set on a function key on the keyset, and the tone pattern by which the sound of each extension differs, the priority of ring sound is set up.

1-4

15-08

Default By default, Virtual Extension Ring tones have the following order.
Order 1 2 3 4 Ring Tone (Set in Program 15-08) 0 (Tone Pattern 1) 1 (Tone Pattern 2) 2 (Tone Pattern 3) 3 (Tone Pattern 4)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Multiple Directory Number / Call Coverage

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-10(Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 10

15-10-01 TEL200 Order1 RG Pttrn0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-10-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 126 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY 15-11: Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment

Description
Use Program 15-11 : Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment to assign the delayed ringing options for an extensions Virtual Extension or Virtual Extension Group Answer keys (defined in Program 15-09). You make an assignment for each Night Service Mode. Assign extension numbers (Program 11-04) and names (Program 15-01) to virtual extension ports. Program Multiple Directory Number (virtual extension) keys in Program 15-07 (code *03).

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Key Number (KTS with DLS)

01-46

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Ringing data 0 : Immediate Ringing 1 : Delayed Ring

Default 0

Related Program 20-04-03

Conditions Program the Multiple Directory Number function keys NOT to ring before removing the key from keysets programming.

Feature Cross Reference


Multiple Directory Number / Call Coverage

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-11(Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 11

15-11-01 TEL200 KY01 Mode1 = 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-11-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 127 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-12: Conversation Recording Destination for Extensions COPY

IN SA SB

Description
Use Program 15-12 : Conversation Recording Destination for Extensions to set the Conversation Recording destination for each extension.
Note: If both Programs 14-09 and 15-12 define a destination, the destination in Program 15-12 will be followed.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Prog. No. 15-12-01 15-12-02

Item Recording Destination Extension Number Automatic Recording for Incoming Calls

Input data Max.4 digits 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

Default No setting 0

Description

Related Program

When an incoming trunk call is answered, this determines whether or not conversation recording is started automatically.

15-12-03 15-12-04

Recording Contents Storing Method Automatic Recording for Outgoing Calls

0 : Specified 1 : Own Box 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

0 0 If another party response is checked by reversed polarity or digit time out, this determines whether or not the conversation recording is started automatically.

Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail

Programming Manual

- 128 -

IN SA SB

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY 15-12: Conversation recording Destination for Extensions

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-12(Conversation recording Destination for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 12

15-12-01 TEL200 Dest.Ext No


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-12-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 129 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup


15-13: Loop Keys Description
COPY

IN SA SB

Use Program 15-13 : Loop Keys to assign the Loop Key data for each keyset telephone. Loop Keys can be incoming, outgoing or both ways. Outgoing Loop Keys use the Data 1 options. Incoming Loop Keys use the Data 2 option. Both Way Loop Keys use both the Data 1 and Data 2 options.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Key Number (KTS with DLS)

01-46

Prog. No. 15-13-01

Item Data 1(Outgoing) Option Data 2(Incoming) Option

Input Data 0-25 (0- Assigns the Loop Key for ARS, 1-25- Assigns the Loop Key to the trunk group specified) 0-25 (0- Assigns the Loop Key to all trunk groups, 1-25Assigns the Loop key to the trunk group specified)

15-13-02

Default Programmable Function Key No. : 01-46 Data 1 (Outgoing) Option : 0 (Assigns the Loop Key for ARS) Data 2 (Incoming) Option : 0 (Assigns the Loop Key to all trunk groups) Conditions
None

Feature Cross Reference


Loop Key

Programming Manual

- 130 -

IN SA SB

Program15: Extension Basic Setup


COPY

15-13: Loop Keys

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 15-13(Loop Keys): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 15 13

15-13-01 TEL200 OTG KY01 = 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

15-13-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 131 -

Programming Manual

Program 15: Extension Basic Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 132 -

IN SA SB

Program 16: Department Group Setup


COPY

16-01:

Extension (Department) Group Basic Data Setup

Description
Use Program 16-01 : Department Group Basic Data Setup to set the function mode for each department group.

Input Data
Extension(Department) Group Number 1-32

Prog. No. 16-01-01 16-01-02

Item Department Name Department Calling Cycle Use this option to set the call routing for Department Calling. Routing can be either circular (cycles to all phones in group) or priority (cycles to highest priority extensions first). Department Routing When Busy Use this option to set how the system routes an Intercom call to a busy Department Group member. Intercom callers to the extension can either hear busy or route to the first available department number. This only occurs for calls to the extension directly, not the department number. Hunting Mode

Input data Max. 12 Character 0 : Priority Routing 1 : Circular Routing

Default No setting 0

Related Program 11-07 16-02

16-01-03

0 : Normal (Intercom caller to busy department member hears busy) 1 : Circular (Intercom callers to busy department member routes to idle member)

16-01-04

16-01-05 16-01-06 16-01-07 16-01-08 16-01-09

STG All Ring Mode Operation STG Withdraw mode Call Recall Restriction for STG Maximum queuing number of STG Call Department Group Call no Answer Time Set how long a call will ring a Department group extension before hunting occurs. Hunt type Set the type of hunting for each Extension (Department) Group:

0 : A last extension is called and hunting is stopped. 1 : Circular 0 : Manual 1: Automatic 0 : Disable(Camp On) 1 : Enable(Overflow Mode) 0 : Disable(Recall) 1 : Enable(non-Recall) 0-32 (0 : No queuing) 0-64800(sec.)

0 0 0 0 15

11-16-10

16-01-10

0 : No queuing 1 : Hunting When Busy 2 : Hunting When No Answer 3 : Hunting When Busy or No Answer

- 133 -

Programming Manual

Program 16: Department Group Setup


16-01: Extension (Department) Group Basic Data Setup
Conditions None

COPY

IN SA SB

Feature Cross Reference


Department Calling

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 16-01(Extension(Department) Group Basic Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 16 01

16-01-01TEL Gr1 DeptName3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

16-01-xxTEL Grxx xxxxx 4. Select the Department Group number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 134 -

IN SA SB

Program 16: Department Group Setup


16-02: Department Group Assignment for Extensions

Description
Use Program 16-02 : Department Group Assignment for Extensions to set the Department Groups. The system uses these groups for Department Calling. Assign pilot numbers to Department Groups you set up in Program 16-01. This lets system users place calls to the departments. Also use this program to set the priority of each extension within each Department Group. When a call comes into the group, it may ring the extensions in order of their priority.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Group Number 1-32

Priority 1-999

Default 1 xxx (See Note Below)

Description Set up the Department Group called by the pilot number and the extension priority when a group is called. Call Pickup Groups are set up in 23-02.

Related Program 11-07

Note: The initial value of a priority becomes the ports numerical order assigned in Program 11-02 and 11-04.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Department Calling

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 16-02(Department Group Assignment for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 16 02

16-02-01 TEL Extension Grp 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

16-02-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 135 -

Programming Manual

Program 16: Department Group Setup


16-03: Secondary Department Group Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 16-03 : Secondary Department Group to set a second Department Group for extensions. Up to 16 extensions can be assigned per a Department Group.

Input Data
Extension(Department) Group Number 1-32

Secondary Extension No. 01-16

Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Priority Order 0-999

Description This program is set up when using telephone into two or more groups.

Related Program

Default All Extension Groups : No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Department Calling

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 16-03(Secondary Department Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 16 03

16-03-01 PltEx1 01=Ext No


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

16-03-xx PltExx xxxxx 4. Select the Pilot extension number to programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 136 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-01: System Options

Description
Use Program 20-01 : System Options to set various system options.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-01-01 Item Operator Access Mode Test Message Mode DSP Sender Resource Selection -Not UsedDTMF Receive Active Timer Input data 0 : Step 1 : Circular 0 : Call mode 1 : Absent mode (Busy Tone) 0 : Conference 1 : Caller-ID 2 : MFC 0-64800(sec.) Default 0 Description Use this program to set up priority of a call when calling an operator telephone. Use this program to select the mode when calling the telephone which set up the text message. Related Program 20-17

20-01-02

11-11-14 15-07-08

20-01-03

20-01-04 20-01-05

10 For OPXs, analogue telephones and certain analogue trunks (like DISA), the system attaches a DTMF receiver to the port for this interval. The system releases the receiver after the interval expires. This interval sets the duration of the alarm signal. Callback rings an extension for this interval. Trunk Queuing callback rings an extension for this interval. The system cancels an extensions Callback or Trunk Queuing request after this interval. 25-07-01

20-01-06 20-01-07 20-01-08 20-01-09

20-01-10

Alarm Clock Duration Callback Ring Duration Trunk Queuing Callback Time Callback/ Trunk queuing Cancel Time Trunk Guard Timer

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

30 15 15 64800

11-11-12 11-12-05 15-07-35 11-12-05 15-07-35 11-12-05 15-07-35

0-64800(sec.)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Refer to above chart

- 137 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-01: System Options Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 20-01(System Options): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 01

IN SA SB

20-01-01 Operator Access 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 138 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-02: System Options for Key Telephones

Description
Use Program 20-02 : System Options for Multi-Line Telephones to set various system options for Key Telephones.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-02-01 Item Trunk Loop Key Operation Mode Input Data 0 : Indicate the Using Loop Trunk 1 : Not Indicated Mode 0 : Keep Lamp 1 : Extinction Incoming 300 IPM Red Blink Talking Green LightExtinction ing(On Talking (LED off) TEL) Holding 60 IPM Green Extinction blink (on (LED off) Holding TEL 0- Outgoing / Incoming 1- Outgoing 2- Incoming Default

20-02-02

20-02-03 20-02-04

20-02-05

20-02-06

20-02-07

Trunk Loop Access Key Operating Mode Use this option to set the operating mode of the extensions trunk group keys. The keys can be for incoming access, outgoing access or both. -Not UsedRetrieve the Line After Transfer Enable (1) or disable (0) an extensions ability to answer a call after its been transferred, but before its answered. Headset Busy Mode Set the conditions under which a headset extension is busy to incoming callers. Preselection Time When a keyset user preselects a line key, the system remembers the preselection for this interval. Time and Date Display Mode Set how the Time and Date appear on display telephones. There are two display modes. LCD Display Holding Time

0- Not Holding 1- Holding

0-Disable 1-Enable

0-64800(sec.) 5 1-8 1: (12 hour) 5: (24 hour) 0-64800(sec.)

TUE 10 3:15PM TUE 10 15:15

1 5

20-02-08

- 139 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-02: System Options for Key telephones
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 20-02-09 Item Disconnect Supervision Use this option to enable or disable disconnect supervision for the system trunks. Time Before Shifting to Power-Saving Mode (PRG15-02-18 should be set to 1: Power Saving Mode.) 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Input Data

IN SA SB
Default 0

20-02-10

20-02-11 20-02-12

Default Setting of Microphone of Key Telephone Forced Intercom Ringing Use this option to enable or disable Forced Intercom Ringing. If enabled, incoming Intercom calls normally ring. If disabled, Intercom calls voice-announce. -Not UsedHeadset Ringing Cancel Timer

0 : Power-Saving Mode Off 1 : 1 minute (Min.) 2 : 2 minutes 3 : 4 minutes 4 : 8 minutes 5 : 16 minutes 6 : 32 minutes 7 : 64 minutes 0 : Off 1 : On 0 : Disable (Voice) 1 : Enable(Ring)

20-02-13 20-02-14

0 - 64800(sec.) 30

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-02(System Options for Key Telephones): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 02

20-02-01 TRK Loop Key

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 140 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-03: System Options for Single Line Telephones

Description
Use Program 20-03 : System Options for Single Line Telephones to set up various options for Single Line Telephones.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-03-01 Item SLT Call Waiting Answer Mode Input Data 0 : Hook Flash 1 : Hook Flash + Service code (894) 0 : Do Not Ignore 1 : Ignore Description For a busy Single Line Telephone, set the mode used to answer a camped-on trunk call. Use this option to define whether the system should receive dial pulse and DTMF signals (0) or ignore dial pulse and only accept DTMF signals (1) Type 0 : The system keeps the digits dialed by the SLT on a trunk in a buffer. After all the digits have been received, the system sends all the digits to the trunk. If the time space between digits is longer than the timer in Item 4, the system considers all digits received. Type 1 : The system passes the received dial from the SLT to the trunk immediately. If the SLT has a Last Number Dial key without a pause, this key may not be able to use the Last number dialing key with the Type 1 setting. Default Related Program 11-12-47

20-03-02

Ignore Received DP Dial on DTMF SLT Port

15-03-01

20-03-03

SLT DTMF Dial to Trunk Lines

0 : Receive all dialed data, before sending 1 : Direct through out

20-03-04

20-03-04 20-03-05

Trunk Call Dial Sending Time by SLT SLT Operation Mode

0-64800(sec.) 0 : Normal Mode 1 : Extended Mode1 2 : Extended Mode2 0-64800(sec.)

20-03-06

Headset Ringing Cancel Time

Conditions None

- 141 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-03: System Options for Single Line Telephones Feature Cross Reference
Single Line Telephone, Analogue

IN SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-03(System Options for Single Line Telephones): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 03

20-03-01 Call Wait ANS

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-03-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 142 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-04: System Options for Virtual Extensions

Description
Use Program 20-04 : System Options for Virtual Extensions to set up various system options for Virtual Extensions.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-04-01 Item The virtual extension operation mode when answered incoming call Input Data 0 : Release virtual extension after answered incoming call 1 : Holding a virtual extension after answered incoming call 0 64800(sec) 10 15-11 Default Related Program

0 -

20-04-02 20-04-03

-Not UsedCall Coverage Delay Interval Multiple Directory Number/Call Coverage Keys set for Delayed Ringing (see Program 15-11) ring the covering extension after this interval.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Multiple Directory Number / Call Coverage

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-04(System Options for Virtual extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 04

20-04-01 V-Ext Answer

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 143 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-05: Not Used Description
This command is currently not used.

IN SA SB

Programming Manual

- 144 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


COPY

20-06: Class of Service for Extensions

Description
Use Program 20-06 : Class of Service for Extensions to assign a Class of Service to an extension. There are15 Classes of Service that can be assigned. To specify the options in each Class of Service, refer to Programs 20-07 through 20-13. You make eight entries for Program 20-06, one for each Night Service Mode.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Class of Service Extensions 1-15

Default All Extensions are Class 1.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-06(Class of Service for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 06

20-06-01 TEL200 Mode1 ClassNo.1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-06-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 145 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-07: Class of Service Options (Administrator Level) Description
Use Program 20-07 : Class of Service Options (Administrator Level) to define the administrator service availability for each extensions Class of Service.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program 11-10-01

Prog. No. 20-07-01

Item Manual Night Service Enabled Enabled/disabled an extensions ability to use manual Night Service Switching Changing the Music on Hold Tone Enable/disable an extensions ability to change the Music on Hold tone Time Setting Enables/disables an extensions ability to set the Time via Service Code 828. Storing Abbreviated Dialing Entries Enables/disables an extensions ability to store Abbreviated Dialing numbers. With this disabled, an extension will display only the name assigned to the Abbreviated Dialing number - the telephone number will not be displayed. This could be used if you wish to prevent Account Codes from being displayed. Set/Cancel Automatic Transfer to Transfer

Input Data

Default* 0

20-07-02

11-10-02

20-07-03

11-10-03

20-07-04

11-10-04

20-07-05

1 -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedProgrammable Function Key Programming (Appearance Level) Enables/disables an extensions ability to program their Appearance function keys using Service Code 852 (by default). Forced Trunk Disconnect (analogue trunk only) Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Forced Trunk Disconnect Trunk port disable VRS Record Enables/disables extensions ability to record, erase and listen to VRS messages 0 : Off 1 : On -

11-10-06 11-10-07 11-10-08 -

20-07-06 20-07-07 20-07-08 20-07-09 20-07-10

11-11-38

20-07-11

11-10-26

20-07-12 20-07-13

0 1

11-10-27 11-10-19

Programming Manual

- 146 -

IN SA SB
Prog. No. 20-07-14

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-07: Class of Service Options (Administrator Level)
Item VRS General Message Listen Enables/disables extensions ability to dial 4 or Service Code 711 and listen to the General Message VRS General Message Record Enables/disables extensions ability to dial Service Code 712 and record, listen to or erase the General Message -Not Used-Not UsedSMDR printout accumulated extension data SMDR printout accumulated STG data SMDR printout accumulated account code data 0 : Off 1 : On Input Data Default* 1 Related Program 11-10-21

Input Data(Contd)

20-07-15

1 0 0 0

11-10-22

20-07-16 20-07-17 20-07-18 20-07-19 20-07-20

11-10-23 11-10-24 11-10-25

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-07(Class of Service Options(Administrator Level)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 07

20-07-01 F-Cls1 SW Man NT serv 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-07-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 147 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-08: Class of Service Options (Outgoing Call Service) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-08 : Class of Service Options (Outgoing Call Service) to define the Outgoing call feature availability for each extensions Class of Service.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program

Prog. No. 20-08-01 20-08-02 20-08-03 20-08-04 20-08-05

Item Intercom Calls Enable/disable Intercom calling for the extension. Trunk Calls Enable/disable outgoing trunk calling for the extension. Common Abbreviated Dialing Group Abbreviated Dialing Dial Number Preview Enable/disable an extensions ability to use Dial Number Preview. Toll Restriction Override Enables/disables Toll Restricting Override (Service Code 875). Repeat Redial Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Repeat Redial. Toll Restriction Dial Block Enable (1) or disable (0) an extensions ability to use Dial Block. Hotline/Extension Ringdown Enables/disables Ringdown Extension for extensions with this COS. Switching from Handsfree Answerback to Forced Intercom Ringing Enables/disables an extensions ability to force Handsfree Answerback or Forced Intercom Ringing for outgoing Intercom calls. Protect for the call mode switching from caller (Internal Call) Department Group Step Calling Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Department Group Step Calling CLIP Set calling Party Number Call Sub-Address Information

Input Data

Default* 1 1 1 1 1

20-08-06

21-01-07 21-07

20-08-07

1 0 : Off 1 : On

20-08-08

20-08-09

20-08-10

20-08-11 20-08-12

0 1 1 0 10-03-05

20-08-13 20-08-14

Programming Manual

- 148 -

IN SA SB
Prog. No. 20-08-15

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-08: Class of Service Options (Outgoing Call Service)
Item Block Outgoing Caller ID Enable (1) or disable (0) the systems ability to automatically block outgoing Caller ID information when a user places a call. If this option is on, the system automatically inserts the Caller ID block code (defined in Program 14-01-21) before the users dialed digits. -Not UsedARS Override Access Map 0 : Disable (Not Override) 1 : Enable Override) Input Data Default* Related Program

Input Data(Contd)

0 : Off 1 : On

14-01-20 14-01-21

20-08-16 20-08-17

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-08(Class of Service Options(Outgoing Call Service)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 08

20-08-01 F-Cls1 Intercom Call 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-08-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 149 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-09: Class of Service Options (Incoming Call Service) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-09 : Class of Service Options (Incoming Call Service) to define the incoming call feature availability for each extensions Class of Service.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program

Prog. No. 20-09-01

Item Second Call for DID/ DISA/ DIL/ E&M Enables/disables the extensions ability to receive a second call from a DID, DISA, DIL, or tie line caller. Note: With this option set to 1, the destination extension must be busy in order for a second DNIS caller to ring through. If the destination extension does not have a line or loop key available for the second call and a previous call is ringing the extension but has not yet been answered, the second caller will hear busy regardless of this programs setting. Caller ID Display Enables/disables the Caller ID display at an extension. Sub Address Identification Notification for Incoming Call List existence Setting Handsfree Answerback or Forced Intercom Ringing Allows/prevents an extension from enabling Handsfree Answerback or Forced Intercom Ringing for their incoming Intercom calls.

Input Data

Default*

20-09-02 20-09-03 20-09-04 20-09-05

0 : Off 1 : On

1 0 1 11-11-15 11-11-16

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Programming Manual

- 150 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-09: Class of Service Options (Incoming Call Service)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-09(Class of Service Options(Incoming Call Service)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 09

20-09-01 F-Cls1 2nd Call DID OR0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-09-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 151 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-10: Class of Service Options (Answer Service) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-10 : Class of Service Options (Answer Service) to define the answer feature availability for each extensions Class of Service.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program

Prog. No. 20-10-01

Item Group Call Pickup (Within Group) Enables/disables Group Call Pickup for calls ringing an extensions own Pickup Group as well as ring group calls (Service Code 867). Group Call Pickup (Another Group) Enables/disables Group Call Pickup for calls ringing outside a group (Service Code 869). Group Call Pickup for Specific Group Enables/disables Group Call Pickup for a specific group using service code 868. Group Call Pickup Enable/disable an extensions ability to pick up a call ringing into a Pickup Group (Service Codes 867 and 856). Directed Call Pickup for Own Group Enables/disables Directed Call Pickup for calls ringing an extensions own Pickup Group (Service Code 856). Meet Me Conference and Paging Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Meet Me Conference and Paging. Automatic Answer of Universal Calls Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Universal Auto Answer (no service code required). Auto Off-Hook Answer for Call Coverage Keys Enables (1) or disables (0) an extensions ability to answer an incoming call on a Call Coverage Key simply by lifting the handset.

Input Data

Default*

20-10-02

20-10-03

20-10-04

1 0 : Off 1 : On 1

20-10-05

20-10-06

20-10-07

20-10-08

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Programming Manual

- 152 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-10: Class of Service Options (Answer Service)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-10(Class of Service Options(Answer Service)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 10

20-10-01 F-Cls1 Call Pickup 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-10-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 153 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-11: Class of Service Options (Hold/Transfer Service) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-11 : Class of Service Options (Hold/Transfer Service) to define the Hold and Transfer feature availability for each extensions Class of Service.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program

Prog. No. 20-11-01

Item Call Forward Immediate Enables/disables an extensions ability to initiate Call Forwarding Immediate Call Forward When Busy Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Call Forward When Busy. Call Forwarding When Unanswered Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Call Forward When Unanswered. Call Forwarding (Both Ringing) Enables/Disables an extensions ability to activate Call Forwarding with Both Ringing. Call Forwarding with Follow Me Enables/disables an extensions ability to initiate Call Forwarding with Follow Me. Unscreened Transfer Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Unscreened Transfer. Transfer Without Holding Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Transfer Without Holding. Transfer Information Display Enables/disables an extensions incoming Transfer pre-answer display. Group Hold Initiate Enables/disables an extensions ability to initiate a Group Hold. Group Hold Answer Enables/disables an extensions ability to pick up a call on Group Hold Automatic On Hook Transfer Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Automatic On Hook Transfer Call Forwarding Off-Premise Enables/disables an extensions ability to set up Call Forwarding Off-Premise for their phone. Operator Transfer After Hold Callback Enables/disables an extensions ability to have a call which recalls from hold transfer to the operator. Trunk to Trunk Transfer Restriction Disable (0) or enable (1) the Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Restriction option. If enabled, trunk-to-trunk transfer is not possible.

Input Data

Default* 1

20-11-02

20-11-03

20-11-04

20-11-05

20-11-06

20-11-07

0 0 : Off 1 : On

20-11-08

20-11-09

20-11-10

20-11-11

20-11-12

20-11-13

20-11-14

Programming Manual

- 154 -

IN SA SB
Prog. No. 20-11-15

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-11: Class of Service Options (Hold/Transfer Service)
Item VRS Personal Greeting Enables/disables extensions ability to dial Service Code 713 to record, listen to or erase the Personal Greeting Message. Call Redirect Enable or disable a keyset users ability to transfer a call to a pre-defined destination (such as an operator, voice mail, or another extension) without answering the call. Call transfer setup for each telephone group No Recall Allow (0) or prevent (1) answered Transferred calls from recalling the originating extension. Normal/Extended Park Determine if an extensions Class of Service should allow either a normal or extended Park. Ring Inward recall disable On Hook Trunk to Trunk Transfer Restriction Input Data Default* Related Program

Input Data(Contd)

20-11-16

0 0 : Off 1 : On 1 0

20-11-17 20-11-18

20-11-19

0 0 0

20-11-20 20-11-21

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-11(Class of Service Options(Hold/Transfer Service)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 11

20-11-01 F-Cls1 Call Forward 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-11-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 155 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-12: Class of Service Options (Charging Cost Service) Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-12 : Class of Service Options (Charging Cost Service) to define the Charging Cost feature availability for each extensions Class of Service.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program -

Prog. No. 20-12-02 20-12-03

Item Advice of Charge (ISDN-AOC) -Not used-

Input Data 0 : Off 1 : On

Default* 1 -

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-12(Class of Service Options(Charging Cost Service)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 12

20-12-01 F-Cls1 Advice Charge 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-12-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 156 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-13: Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service)

Description
Use Program 20-13 : Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service) to define the supplementary feature availability for each extensions.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program

Prog. No. 20-13-01

Item Long Conversation Alarm Enables/disables the Warning Tone for Long conversation (not for SLTs). Long Conversation Cutoff (Incoming) Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Long Conversation Cutoff for incoming calls. Long Conversation Cutoff (Outgoing) Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Long Conversation Cutoff for outgoing calls. Call Forwarding/DND Override Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Call Forwarding/ DND Override. Intercom Off Hook Signaling Enables (1) or disables (0) an extensions ability to receive off hook signals. Automatic Off Hook Signaling Allows a busy extension to manually (0) or automatically (1) receive off hook signals. Message Waiting Enables/disables an extensions ability to leave Message Waiting. Conference Enables/disables an extensions ability to initiate a conference or Meet Me Conference. Privacy Release Enables/disables an extensions ability to initiate a Voice Call Conference. Barge In Mode Enables the extensions Barge In to be speech mode (0) or Monitor mode (1). Room Monitor, Initiating Extension Enable/disable an extensions ability to initiate Room Monitor. Room Monitor, Extension Being Monitored Enable/disable an extensions ability to be monitored. Continued Dialing Enable/disable an extensions ability to use Continued Dialing which allows DTMF signal sending while talking on extension. Department Calling Enable/disable an extensions ability to call a Department Group.

Input Data

Default* 1

20-13-02

20-13-03

20-13-04

20-13-05

20-13-06

20-13-07

1 0 : Off 1 : On 1

20-13-08

20-13-09

20-13-10

20-13-11

0 0

20-13-12 20-13-13

20-13-14

- 157 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-13: Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service)
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 20-13-15 20-13-16 20-13-17 Item Barge In, Initiate Enables/disables Barge In at initiating extension. Barge In, Receive Blocks/allows Barge In at the receiving extension. Barge In Tone/Display Use this option to enable/disable the Barge In tone. If enabled, callers hear an alert tone and their display indicates the Barge In when another extension barges into their conversation. If disabled, there is no alert tone or display indication. Programmable Function Key Programming (General Level) Enables/disables an extensions ability to program their General function keys using Service Code 851 (by default). (Refer to Program 20-07-10 for Service Code 852.) Selectable Display Messaging Enables/disables an extensions ability to use Selectable Display Messaging Account Code/Toll Restriction Operator Alert Enables/disables operator alert when an extension improperly enters an Account Code or violates Toll Restriction. Extension Name Enables/disables an extensions ability to program its name Called Party Status Display the detail state of called party Display the Reason for Transfer Select whether an extension should display the reason a call is being transferred to their extension (Call Forward Busy, Call Forward No Answer, DND). Privacy Release by Pressing Line Key Enable (1) or disable (0) a users ability to press a line key to barge into an outside call. The Barge In feature must be enabled if this option is to be used. -Not Used-Not UsedBusy on seizing virtual extension Allow COS to be Changed Enable (1) or disable (0) the ability of an extensions COS to be changed via Service Code 177. Paging Display Enables (1) or disables (0) an extensions ability to display paging information. Background Music In an extensions Class of Service, allow (1) or prevent (0) an extension from turning Background Music on and off. Input Data Default* 1 1

IN SA SB
Related Program

20-13-18

20-13-19

20-13-20

20-13-21

0 : Off 1 : On

1 0

20-13-22 20-13-23

20-13-24

0 1 0

20-13-25 20-13-26 20-13-27 20-13-28

20-13-29

20-13-30

Programming Manual

- 158 -

IN SA SB
Prog. No. 20-13-31 20-13-32

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-13: Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service)
Item Connected Line identification (COLP) Deny Multiple Barge-In Enable (1) or disable (0) the extensions ability to have multiple users Barge In to their conversation. -Not UsedBlock Manual Off-Hook Signaling Enable (1) or disable (0) an extensions ability to block off-hook signals manually sent from a co-worker. Block Camp-On Enable (1) or disable (0) an extensions ability to block callers from dialing 2 to Camp On. Call Timer In an extensions Class of Service, enable (1) or disable (0) an extensions ability to use the Call Timer. -Not usedHeadset Ear Piece Ringing Input Data Default* 0 0 0 0 : Off 1 : On 0 Related Program

Input Data(Contd)

20-13-33 20-13-34

20-13-35

20-13-36

1 0

20-13-37 20-13-38

*All Classes are above mentioned default value.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-13(Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service)): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 13

20-13-01 F-Cls1 Long Conv Alarm1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-13-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 159 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-14: Class of Service Options for DISA/E&M Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-14 : Class of Service Options for DISA/E&M to enable/disable DISA and tie line Class of Service options. You assign a DISA Class of Service to DISA users in Program 25-09. Assign tie line Classes of Service in 34-02. Up to 15 DISA/E&M Classes of Service can be defined.
Note: Analogue trunk-to-analogue trunk and ISDN trunk-to-ISDN trunk calls are supported by this program.

However, analogue trunk-to-ISDN trunk and ISDN trunk-to-analogue trunk

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15 Related Program

Prog. No. 20-14-01

Item First Digit Absorption For tie lines, enable or disable the ability to absorb (ignore) the first incoming digit. Use this to make the tie trunk compatible with 3- and 4-digit tie line service. This option does not apply to DISA. Trunk Group Routing/ARS Access This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to dial 9 for Trunk Group Routing or Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Trunk Group Access This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to access trunk groups for outside calls (Service Code 814). Common Abbreviated Dialing This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the systems Common Abbreviated Dialing. Operator Calling This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to dial 0 for the telephone system operator. Internal Paging This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the telephone systems Internal Paging. External Paging This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the telephone systems External Paging. Direct Trunk Access This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use Direct Trunk Access (Service Code 815).

Input Data

Default

20-14-02

20-14-03

20-14-04

0 : Off 1 : On

20-14-05

20-14-06

20-14-07

20-14-08

Programming Manual

- 160 -

IN SA SB
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 20-14-09

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-14: Class of Service Options for DISA/E&M
Item Forced Trunk Disconnect <Not for ISDN T-point> This option enables or disables a tie trunk callers ability to use Forced Trunk Disconnect (Service Code *26). This option is not available to DISA callers. Call Forward Setting by Remote Via DISA DISA/Tie Trunk Barge-In This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the Barge In feature. Input Data Default Related Program

0 0 : Off 1 : On 0 0

20-14-10 20-14-11

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Class of Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-14(Class of Service Options for DISA/E&M): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 14

20-14-01 F-Cls1 Del 1digit Dial 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-14-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 161 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-15: Ring Cycle Setup Description
Use Program 20-15 : Ring Cycle Setup to define the ringing cycles for each ring type.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-15-01 20-15-02 20-15-03 20-15-04 20-15-05 20-15-06 20-15-07 20-15-08 20-15-09 20-15-10 20-15-11 Incoming Ring Type Normal Incoming Call on Trunk PBX,CES incoming Call Internal Incoming Call DID/DISA DID Dial-In in the E&M Tie Line Door Box ringing for SLT Virtual Extension Ring Call-back Alarm for SLT VRS Waiting Message Incoming Call 1-13 Ring Cycle No. Default 3 8 8 8 8 8 2 8 4 5 6 Related Program

Ring Cycle
Ring Cycle No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Ring Cycle Not Supported On:2.0 / Off:4.0 On:1.0 / Off:2.0 On:0.5 / Off:0.5 On:0.3 / Off:0.3 On:0.5 / Off:0.5 / On:0.5 / Off:1.5 On:0.3 / Off:0.3 / On:0.3 / Off:5.1 On:0.3 / Off:0.3 / On:0.3 / Off:2.1 On:0.2 / Off:0.2 / On:0.2 / Off:0.2 / On:0.2 / Off:2.0 On:1.0 / Off:4.0 On:0.3 / Off:0.3 / On:0.3 / Off:4.1 On:1.0 / Off:3.0 On:0.3 / Off:0.3 / On:0.3 / Off:2.1

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Programming Manual

- 162 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-15: Ring Cycle Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-15(Ring Cycle Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 15

20-15-01 TRK Normal INC 3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-15-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 163 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-16: Selectable Display Messages Description
Use Program 20-16 : Selectable Display Messages to enter the Selectable Display Messages. There are 20 alphanumeric messages, up to 16 characters long. Use the following chart when programming messages.

IN SA SB

Key
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 *
LND OPAC CLEAR FLASH

Number of pressing the Key


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

1 A D G J M P T W 0 *

@ B E H K N Q U X ! +

[ C F I L O R V Y ,

a d g j m S t Z # -

] b e h k n p u w $ .

^ c f i l o q v x % /

_ 2 3 4 5 6 r 8 y & :

s z ;

7 9 ( < ) = > ?

Move the cursor to the left Move the cursor to the right Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right. Switch the cursor moves to the upper row of the display and pressing FLASH again to moves the cursor back to the lower row.

Input Data
Selectable Display Message Number 01-20

Text data 16 characters

Programming Manual

- 164 -

IN SA SB
Default
Message Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-16: Selectable Display Messages
Message MEETING_BY_##:## ROOM_ -_ ####### COME BACK ##:## CALL_ ########## CALL_AFTER_##:## LUNCH_BACK_##:## B.TRIP_BACK##/## B.TRIP########## GONE_FOR_THE_DAY DAY_OFF_BY_##/## MESSAGE_11 MESSAGE_12 MESSAGE_13 MESSAGE_14 MESSAGE_15 MESSAGE_16 MESSAGE_17 MESSAGE_18 MESSAGE_19 MESSAGE_20

Conditions
_ means space.

Feature Cross Reference


Selectable Display Messages

- 165 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-16: Selectable Display Messages Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 20-16(Selectable Display Messages): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 16

IN SA SB

20-16-01TxtMsg1 MEETING BY ##:##


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-16-xxTxtMsgxx xxxxx 4. Select the Text Message number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 166 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-17: Operators Extension

Description
Use Program 20-17 : Operators Extension to designate an operator. When an extension user dials 0 or 9 (defined by Program 11-01 Type 5), calls go to the operator selected in this program. If you dont assign an extension in Program 90-11-01, system alarms appear on the extension assigned in this option.

Input Data
Operator Number 1-8 Related Program 11-01

Prog. No. 20-17-01 20-17-02

Item Operator Extension Number Operator Console

Input Data Max. 4 digits 0 : Normal KTS 1 : Special Operator Console

Default No setting 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Intercom

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-17(Operators Extension): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 17

20-17-01 Operat1 Oper.Ext.No.


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-17-xxOperatx xxxxx 4. Select the Operator number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 167 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-18: Service Tone Timers Description
Use Program 20-18 : Service Tone Timer to set the values for the system service tone timers. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-18-01 Item Extension Dial Tone sending Timer Busy Tone sending Timer Congestion Tone sending Timer Warning Tone sending Timer Input data 0 - 64800(sec.) Default 30 Description After getting Intercom dial tone, a KTS user has this interval to dial the first digit of the Intercom call. Related Program

20-18-02 20-18-03

0 - 64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

15 10 A Busy Tone when system resources run short. (such as DTMF receiver resources) This option sets the interval between Call Waiting tones. This timer also sets the interval between Off Hook Signaling alerts.

20-18-04

0-64800(sec.)

10

20-18-05

20-18-06 20-18-07

KTS Confirmation Tone sending Timer Interval of Call Waiting Tone Intrusion Tone

0-64800(sec.)

10

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

10 0 After a call is interrupted (such as Barge In, Voice Mail Conversation Recording, Voice Over, etc), the system repeats the Intrusion Tone after this interval. Normally, you should enter 0 to disable this interval.

20-18-08 20-18-09

Conference tone Interval Warning Beep Tone Signaling Interval

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

0 60 14-01-18

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Distinctive Ringing, Tones, and Flash Patterns

Programming Manual

- 168 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-18: Service Tone Timers

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-18(Service Tone Timers): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 18

20-18-01 Ext DT Time30


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-18-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 169 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-19: System Options for Caller ID Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-19 : System Options for Caller ID to define the system options for the Caller ID feature.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-19-01 20-19-02 Item Caller ID Displaying Format if Displaying Digits are more than 12 digits. Caller ID Wait Timer When an incoming CO call is received, the system starts the timer. It will wait the programmed time for Caller ID information from telco before connecting the CO call. Caller ID Edit Mode Edit Caller ID Enables/disables an extensions ability to edit the stored Caller ID information Wait Facility IE Timer Caller-ID Sender active Timer Caller-ID Sender Guard Timer Input data 0 : First 10 digits 1 : Last 10 digits 0-30(sec.) Default 0 5

20-19-03

0 : Off 1 : On 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

20-19-04 20-19-05 20-19-06

10 0 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Distinctive Ringing, Tones, and Flash Patterns

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-19(System Options for Caller ID): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 19

20-19-01 CallerID Format0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-19-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 170 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-20: Message Setup for Non-Caller ID Data

Description
Use Program 20-20 : Message Setup for Non-Caller ID Data to define the messages which will be displayed when no Caller ID information is received.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-20-01 20-20-02 20-20-03 Private Call Call from out of service area Call information with error Up to 16 Alphanumeric Characters Item Input data Default UNAVAILABLE INFO OUT-OF-STATE NO CALLER INFO

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Caller ID

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-20(Message Setup for Non-Caller ID Data): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 20

20-20-01 UNAVAILABLE INFO


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-20-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 171 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-21: System Option for Long Conversation Description
Use Program 20-21 : System Options for Long Conversation to define the system options for the Long Conversation feature.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-21-01 Item Long Conversation Alarm 1 The warning tone for long toll calls sounds after this interval. Long Conversation Alarm 2 After the initial long toll call warning tone, additional warning tones sound after this interval. Long Conversation Cutoff for Incoming Call This timer determines how long the system will wait before disconnecting an incoming call. Long Conversation Cutoff for Outgoing Call This timer determines how long the system will wait before disconnecting an outgoing call. Input data 0-64800(sec.) Default 170

20-21-02

0-64800(sec.)

180

20-21-03

0-64800(sec.)

20-21-04

0-64800(sec.)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Long Conversation Cutoff

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-21(System Options for Long Conversation): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 21

20-21-01 Alarm 1

170

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-21-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 172 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-23: System Option for CTI Service

Description
Use Program 20-23 : System Options for CTI Service to define the system options for the CTI feature.

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-23-01 20-23-02 20-23-03 Delayed ring timer for CTI ALERT reply time (CTI) Trunk Virtual Bridge - TSP Driver Enable or disable the systems ability to send trunk or virtual extension information to the TSP driver. The timer which waits for an off-hook for SLT Item Input data 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0 : Off 1 : On 0-64800(sec.) Default 30 8 0

20-23-04

30

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Computer Telephony Integration Application(CTI)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-23(System Options for CTI Service): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 23

20-23-01 CTI DelayRG30


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-23-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 173 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-25: ISDN Options Description
Use Program 20-25 : ISDN Options to define the ISDN system options.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 20-25-01 20-25-02 20-25-03 20-25-04 Item Send the Release Message After Subscriber Hang Up Progress Indicate Information element detect Bearer Capability select from SLT Outgoing Send DT Until User Dials the First Digit (Overlap Sending Mode) With Overlap Sending Mode, if the network side stops dial tone when CLI is included in the SETUP message, the system sends dial tone until the user dials the first digit instead of the network. T305 Timer Start After Sending Disconnect Message Call Proceeding Send Mode Busy Tone Mode Set When Disconnect Message Received Use of Low Layer Compatibility (LLC) Use of High Layer Compatibility (HLC) Sending S-Point Terminal Seizes Analogue Trunk Automatic Changing System Clock When Date/Time Information Element Received Incoming Calls Forwarded Out Automatically Return Connect Message When Outgoing Call Receives Alerting Message Use busy tone when trunk call receives RELEASE message 0 : Service Off 1 : Service On Input data 0 : Service Off 1 : Service On 0 : 3.1kHz Audio 1 : Speech Default 1 1 0

20-25-05 20-25-06 20-25-07 20-25-08 20-25-09 20-25-10 20-25-11 20-25-12

1 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 0

20-25-13

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Programming Manual

- 174 -

IN SA SB

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-25: ISDN Options

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-25(ISDN Options): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 25

20-25-01 Send ReleaseMsg1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-25-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 175 -

Programming Manual

Program 20: System Option Setup


20-26: Multiplier for Charge Cost Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 20-26 : Multiplier for Charge Cost to define the amount that the Network charge units will be increased by.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 01-15

Prog. No. 20-26-01

Item Percentage to multiply the unit charge

Input data 100-500%

Default 100

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 20-26(Multiplier for Charge Cost): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 20 26

20-26-01SvcCls1 Value 100


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

20-26-xxSvcClsxx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 176 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-01: System Options for Outgoing Calls

Description
Use Program 21-01 : System Options for Outgoing Calls to set the system options for Outgoing Call Service.

Input Data
Prog. No. 21-01-01 21-01-02 Item Seizure Trunk Line Mode Intercom Interdigit Time When placing Intercom calls, extension users must dial each digit within this interval. Trunk Interdigit Time (External) The system waits for this timer to expire before placing the call in a talk state (Call Timer starts after timer expires, Barge-In are not allowed until after timer expires). Researched time for DTD circuit Dial Tone Detection Time If dial tone detection is enabled, the system will wait this interval for the Telco to return dial tone. When the interval expires, the system assumes dial tone is not present. To disable this timer (and have the system wait continuously), enter 0. Dial pause at first digit Toll Restriction Override Time After dialing the Toll Restriction Override codes, the system removes Toll Restriction from the extension for this interval. Preset dial display hold time Ringdown Extension Timer A Ringdown extension automatically calls its programmed destination after this interval. Dial Digits for Toll Restriction Path control Inter-Digit Time for Toll Restriction Path control -Not Used-Not UsedInput data 0 : Route to Priority order 1 : Route to circular 0-64800(sec.) Default 0 10 Related Program 14-05 14-06

21-01-03

0-64800(sec.)

10

14-02-08

21-01-04 21-01-05

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

5 0

21-01-06 21-01-07

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

3 10

21-01-08 21-01-09

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

5 5

21-01-10 21-01-11 21-01-12 21-01-13

0-36 0-60(sec.) -

0 0 -

- 177 -

Programming Manual

Program21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-01: System Option for Outgoing Calls
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 21-01-14 Item Forced Account Code Inter-digit Timer The system waits this interval for a user to enter a Forced Account code. Outgoing Disable- on Incoming Line Input data 0-64800(sec.) Default 3

IN SA SB
Related Program

21-01-15

0 : Service Off 1 : Service On 0-64800(sec.)

21-01-16

Timer to Supervise a dial Detection

20

21-01-17

Restriction digit in Outgoing Disable- on Incoming Line

1-9 (digit)

15-01-05 21-01-16 21-07-17 15-01-05 21-01-15 21-01-17 15-01-05 21-01-15 21-01-16

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Placing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-01(System Options for Outgoing service): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 01

21-01-01 TRK Line Mode

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 178 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


COPY

21-02: Trunk Group Routing for Extensions

Description
Use Program 21-02 : Trunk Group Routing for Extensions to assign Program 14-06 routes to extensions.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Day/ Night Mode 1-8

Route table number 0-25 ( 0 : No setting)

Default 1

Related Program 14-06 14-01-07

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-02(Trunk Group Routing for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 02

21-02-01 TEL200 Mode1=RouteTBL1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-02-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 179 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-03: Trunk Group Routing for Trunks Description
COPY

IN SA SB

Use Program 21-03 : Trunk Group Routing for Trunks to set the Trunk Route Table for Automatic External Call Forward. The Route Table is set in Program 14-06.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/ Night Mode 1-8

Route table number 0-25 ( 0 : No setting)

Default 0

Related Program 14-06 14-01-07

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Trunk Group Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-03(Trunk Group Routing for Trunks): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 03

21-03-01 Trunk1 Mode1=RouteTBL0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-03-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 180 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


COPY 21-04: Toll Restriction Class for Extensions

Description
Use Program 21-04 : Toll Restriction Class for Extensions to assign a Toll Restriction class to an extension. The details of Toll Restriction are defined in Program 21-05 and 21-06.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Day/ Night Mode 1-8

Restriction Class 1-15

Default 2

Related Program 14-01-08 21-05

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-04(Toll Restriction Class for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 04

21-04-01 TEL200 Mode1=T/RClass2


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-04-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 181 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-05: Toll Restriction Class Description
Use Program 21-05 : Toll Restriction Class to set the systems Toll Restriction classes (1-15).

IN SA SB

Input Data
Toll Restriction Class Number 1-15 Related Program 21-06-01

Prog. No. 21-05-01

Item International Call restriction table

Input Data

Description This option assigns/ unassigns the International Call Restrict Table for the Toll Restriction Class you are programming. Enter International Call Restrict Table data in Program 21-06-01. This option assigns/ unassigns the International Call Permit Table for the Toll Restriction Class you are programming. Enter International Call Permit Table data in Program 21-06-02. Select the table (defined in 21-06-03) to be used to determine the maximum number of digits allowed for outgoing calls.

21-05-02

International Call permit code table

0 : Not assigned 1 : Assigned

21-06-02

21-05-03 21-05-04

-Not usedMaximum Number of Digits Table Assignment

21-05-05 21-05-06 21-05-07 21-05-08

Common permit code table Common restriction table Permit code table Restriction table

21-05-09

Restriction for common ABB dials

0 : Disable 1 : Assigned for table 1 2 : Assigned for table 2 3 : Assigned for table 3 4 : Assigned for table 4 0 : Not assigned 1 : Assigned 0 : Not assigned 1 : Assigned 0 : Disable 1 : Assigned for table 1 2 : Assigned for table 2 3 : Assigned for table 3 4 : Assigned for table 4 0 : Not restricted 1 : Following restriction table

21-06-04

It chooses whether the table set up by 21-06-04 is referred to, or not referred to. It chooses whether the table set up by 21-06-05 is referred to, or not referred to. Set the tables 1-4 when referring to the table set up by 21-06-06. Set the tables 1-4 when referring to the table set up by 21-06-07.

21-06-05 21-06-06 21-06-07

21-05-10

Restriction for group ABB dials

0 : Not restricted 1 : Following restriction table

21-05-11

Intercom Call Restriction

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

Use this option to enable/disable Toll Restriction for Common Abbreviated Dialing numbers. If enabled, Common Abbreviated Dialing numbers have the same restrictions as manually dialed numbers. Use this option to enable/disable Toll Restriction for Group Abbreviated Dialing numbers. If enabled, Group Abbreviated Dialing numbers have the same restrictions as manually dialed numbers. It chooses whether ICM incoming call is restricted.

Programming Manual

- 182 -

IN SA SB
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 21-05-12 Item PBX Call Restriction

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-05: Toll Restriction Class
Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Description Use this option to set how the system Toll Restricts calls over PBX trunks. If you enable PBX Toll Restriction, the system begins Toll Restriction after the PBX access code. The user cannot dial a PBX extension. If you disable PBX Toll Restriction, the system only restricts calls that contain the PBX access code. The system does not restrict calls to PBX extensions. Refer to the PBX compatibility feature. Make sure Program 21-05-04 (Maximum Number of Digits Table Assignment) allows for PBX Toll Call Dialing (normally 12 digits). It chooses whether the toll restriction of the dial set up by 34-08 is enabled or disabled. Related Program

21-05-13

Restriction of Tie call

0 : Disable 1 : Enable

34-08

Default Class 01 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 02 03 04 05 Programming No.21-0506 07 08 09 10 11 12 13

Conditions None

- 183 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-05: Toll Restriction Class Feature Cross Reference
Toll Restriction

IN SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-05(Toll Restriction Class): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 05

21-05-01TolCls1 Intl Rest TBL 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-05-xx TolClsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Toll Restriction Class number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 184 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-06: Toll Restriction Table Data Setup

Description
Use Program 21-06 : Toll Restriction Table Data Setup to set the systems Toll Restriction data. Dial 1-9, 0, *, # can be entered in each table.

Input Data
Prog. No. 21-06-01 Item International Call restriction table 1-10 Table Input Data Dial (Up to 4 digits) No setting 1-20 Dial (Up to 6 digits) Table 1-4 = 30 digits No setting 1-10 Dial (Up to 4 digits) No setting 1-10 Dial (Up to 12 digits) No setting 1-4 (table) 1-200 (entry) Default No setting Description This option lets you program the Restrict Table for international calls. The system has 10 International Call Restrict Tables. Each entry can be up to four digits long. This option lets you program the Permit Table for international calls. The system has 20 International Call Permit Table. Each entry can be up to six digits long, using. This option selects the maximum number of digits allowed in outgoing calls for each table. This option lets you program the Common Permit Code Table. This table contains up to 10 codes you commonly allow users to dial This option lets you program the Common Restrict Code Table. This table contains up to 10 codes you commonly prevent users from dialing. This option lets you program the Permit Code Tables. If the system has Toll Restriction enabled, users can dial numbers only if permitted by these tables and the Common Permit Table (21-06-04). There are four Permit Code Tables, with up to 200 entries in each table. The system permits calls exactly as you enter the code. This option lets you program the Restrict Code Tables. If the system has Toll Restriction enabled, users cannot dial numbers listed in these tables. There are four Restrict Code Tables, with up to 200 entries in each table. The system restricts calls exactly as you enter the code.

21-06-02

International Call permit code table

21-06-03

21-06-04

Maximum Number of Digits Table Assignment Common permit code table

1-4

4-30

21-06-05

Common restriction table

21-06-06

Permit code table

Dial (Up to 12 digits)

21-06-07

Restriction table 1-4 (table) 1-60 (entry) Dial (Up to 12 digits)

No setting

- 185 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-06: Toll Restriction Table Data Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 21-06-08 Item PBX Access Code Table 1-4 Input Data Dial (Up to 2 digits) Default No setting Description

IN SA SB

Use this option to enter the PBX Access Code. When the system is behind a PBX, this is the code users dial to access a PBX trunk. Toll Restriction begins after the PBX access code. For PBX trunks (Program 14-04) the system only Toll Restricts calls that contain the access code. Always program this option when the system is behind a PBX, even if you dont want to use Toll Restriction. PBX Access Codes can be up to 2 digits, using 0-9, #, * and LINE KEY 1 (dont care). When using Account Codes, do not use an asterisk within a PBX access code. Otherwise, after the *, the trunk would stop sending digits to the central office. Entries 1-4 correspond to the 4 PBX Access Codes. Each code can have up to 2 digits.

21-06-09 21-06-10

Specific dial outgoing code Outgoing Call Code Setup

1-20 1-20

Dial (Up to 8 digits) Dial (Up to 4 digits)

No setting No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction

Programming Manual

- 186 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-06: Toll Restriction Table Data Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-06(Toll Restriction Table Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 06

21-06-01IntTBL1 Rest TBL


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-06-xxIntTBLx xxxxx 4. Select the International Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 187 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-07: Toll Restriction Override Password Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 21-07 - Toll Restriction Override Password Setup to assign Toll Restriction Override codes to extension ports. Each code must be four digits long, using any combination of 0-9, # and *. Each extension can have a separate code, or many extensions can share the same override code.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Password 4 digits fixed

Default No setting

Related Program 21-01-07 20-08-06

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction Override

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-07(Toll Restriction Class): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 07

21-07-01 TEL200 Password


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-07-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 188 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-08: Repeat Dial Setup

Description
Use Program 21-08 : Repeat Dial Setup to define the automatic Repeat Dial data.

Input Data
Prog. No. 21-08-01 Item Repeat Redial Count Set how many times a Repeat Redial will automatically repeat if the call does not go through. Repeat Redial Interval Time This timer sets the interval between Repeat Redial attempts. Repeat Dial Calling Timer After dialing the trunk call, Repeat Redial maintains the call after this interval. After this interval, the system terminates the call, waits the Repeat Redial Time (Timer 02) and tries again. Time for Send Busy Tone for ISDN Trunk Set the timer (sec) to send out Busy Tone with an ISDN line, when called party is in busy. Input Data 0-255 Default 3 Related Program

21-08-02

0-64800(sec.)

60

21-08-03

0-64800(sec.)

30

21-08-04

0-64800(sec.)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Repeat Dial

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-08(Repeat Dial Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 08

21-08-01 Repeat Times 3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-08-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 189 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-09: Dial Block Setup Description
Use Program 21-09 : Dial Block Setup to defines the Dial Blocking Toll Restriction Class and Dial Block Password to be used by the Supervisor extension.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 21-09-01 Item Toll Restriction Class With Dial Block Assign a Toll Restriction Class of Service when the Dial Block feature is used. Supervisor Password Assign a 4-digit password to be used by the supervisor to enable or disable Dial Block for other extensions. Input Data 1-15 0-9,*,# 4-digits Fixed Default 1 Related Program

21-09-02

No setting

Conditions This function works by password and Class of Service control (the supervisor is not an assigned extension). If Dial Block is available for all Classes of Service, everyone may become a supervisor if they know the Dial Block password.

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-09(Dial Block Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 09

21-09-01 Dial Block T/R1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-09-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 190 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-10: Dial Block Restriction Class Per Extensions

Description
Use Program 21-10 : Dial Block Restriction Class Per Extensions to define the Toll Restriction Class to each extension when the extension is set for Dial Block Restriction. If this data is 0, Toll Restriction Class follows Program 21-09-01.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Toll Restriction Class 0,1-15(0 : No setting)

Default 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-10(Dial Block Restriction Class Per Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 10

21-10-01 TEL200 T/R Class 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-10-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 191 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-11: Extension Ringdown (Hotline) Assignment COPY Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 21-11 : Extension Ringdown (Hotline) Assignment to define the Hotline destination number for each extension number.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Hotline Destination Number 0-9,*,#, Pause, Hooking, @(Code to wait for response) (Max. 36 digits)

Default No setting

Related Program 20-08-09 21-01-09

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Ringdown Extension

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-11(Extension Ringdown (Hotline) Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 11

21-11-01 TEL200 Hotline No


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-11-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 192 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


COPY

21-12: ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks

Description
Use Program 21-12 : ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks to assign Calling Party Numbers for each trunk (maximum 16 digits per entry). When a call is made by an extension which does not have an Extension Calling Number assigned (Program 21-13), the system sends the calling number for the ISDN trunk defined in 21-12.
Note: If the Calling Party Number is assigned in both Programs 21-12 and 21-13, the system sends the data in

Program 21-13.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Calling Party Number 0-9,*,# (Max. 16 digits)

Default No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-12(ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 12

21-12-01 Trunk1 PartyNo


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-12-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 193 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-13: ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 21-13 : ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions to assign each extension a Calling Party Number (maximum 16 digits per entry). The calling number is the subscriber number of the dial-in number. When a call is made by an extension which does not have an Extension Calling Number assigned (Program 21-12), the system sends the calling number for the ISDN trunk defined in Program 21-13.
Note: If the Calling Party Number is assigned in both Programs 21-12 and 21-13, the system sends the data in

Program 21-13.

Input Data
Extension Port Number Max. 4 digits

Calling Party Number 0-9,*,# (Max. 16 digits)

Default No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-13(Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 13

21-13-01 TEL200 PartyNo


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-13-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 194 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-14: Walking Toll Restriction Password Setup

Description
Use Program 21-14 : Walking Toll Restriction Password Setup to assign the password and Toll Restriction Class for Walking Toll Restriction. Each code is six digits long, using any combination of 0-9, # and *.

Input Data
ID Table Number 1-500

Prog. No. 21-14-01 User ID

Item

Input Data Dial (6 digits Fixed) 1-15

Default No setting 15

Related Program

21-14-02

Walking Toll Restriction Class Number

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-14(Walking Toll Restriction Password Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 14

21-14-01 TBL1 User ID


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-14-xx TBLxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the ID Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 195 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-15: Individual Trunk Group Routing for Extensions Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 21-15 : Individual Trunk Group Route for Extensions to designate the alternate trunk access route accessed when a user dials the Alternate Trunk Route Access Code. Refer to Program 11-09-02 - Alternate Trunk Access Code when setting up alternate trunk codes. Turn to Program 14-06 - Trunk Group Routing to set up the trunk routes. When entering data for this option, enter the route number or 0 to prevent routing.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Route Table Number 0-25 (0 : No setting)

Default 0

Related Program 11-09-02 14-01-07 14-06

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Placing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-15(Individual Trunk Group Routing for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 15

21-15-01 TEL200 Mode1=RouteTbl0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-15-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 196 -

IN SA SB

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-17:
IP Trunk(H.323/SIP) Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks

Description
Use Program 21-17 : IP Trunk(H.323/SIP) Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks to assign Calling Party Number for each IP trunk. The assigned number shall be sent to the exchange when the caller places an outgoing call. Note: In case Calling Party Number is assigned by both PRG 21-17 and 21-18/21-19, then the system priors to the data in PRG 21-18/21-19.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Calling Party Number 0-9,*,# (Max. 16 digits)

Default No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-17(IP Trunk(H.323/SIP) Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 17

21-17-01 Trunk1 PartyNo


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-17-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 197 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-18:
IP Trunk(H.323) Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions

IN SA SB

Description
Use Program 21-18 : IP Trunk(H.323) Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions to assign Calling Party Number for each IP extension. The assigned number shall be sent to the exchange when the caller places an outgoing call. Note: In case Calling Party Number is assigned by both PRG 21-17 and 21-18/21-19, then the system priors to the data in PRG 21-18/21-19.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Calling Party Number 0-9,*,# (Max. 16 digits)

Default No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-18(IP Trunk(H.323) Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 18

21-18-01 TEL200 PartyNo


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-18-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 198 -

IN SA SB

Program21: Outgoing Call Setup


21-19:
IP Trunk(SIP) Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions

Description
Use Program 21-19 : IP Trunk(SIP) Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions to assign Calling Party Number for each IP extension. The assigned number shall be sent to the exchange when the caller places an outgoing call. Note: In case Calling Party Number is assigned by both PRG 21-17 and 21-18/21-19, then the system priors to the data in PRG 21-18/21-19.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Calling Party Number 0-9,*,# (Max. 16 digits)

Default No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 21-19(IP Trunk(SIP) Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 21 19

21-19-01 TEL200 PartyNo


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

21-19-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 199 -

Programming Manual

Program 21: Outgoing Call Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 200 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-01: System Options for Incoming Calls

Description
Use Program 22-01 : System Options for Incoming Calls to define the system options for incoming calls.

Input Data
Prog. No. 22-01-01 Item Incoming Call Priority Input data 0 : Intercom Call Priority 1 : Trunk Call Priority 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Default 1 Description Use this option to determine if Intercom calls or trunk calls have answer priority when both are ringing simultaneously. If enabled, an incoming call that rings longer than the Ring No Answer Alarm interval (22-01-03), will change to a unique ring cadence to indicate that the call has been ringing too long. If disabled, this will not occur. If a trunk rings a key telephone longer than this interval, the system changes the ring cadence. This indicates to the user that the call has been ringing too long A DIL that rings its programmed destination longer than this interval diverts to the DIL No Answer Ring Group (set in Program 22-08). 20 In systems with DID Ring-NoAnswer Intercept, this interval sets the Ring-No-Answer time. This interval is how long a DID call rings the destination extension before rerouting to the intercept ring group. 22-12 Related Program

22-01-02

Incoming Call Ring No Answer Alarm

22-01-03 22-01-04

22-01-03

Incoming Call Ring No Answer Tone

0-64800(sec.)

60

22-01-02

22-01-04

DIL No Answer Recall Time

0-64800(sec.)

22-01-05 22-01-06

-Not usedDID Ring-No-Answer Time

0-64800(sec.)

22-01-07

22-01-08 22-01-09

DID Incoming Ring Group no answer timer DID Pilot Call No answer timer DID to Trunk to Trunk no answer timer

0-64800(sec.)

20

0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.)

60 20

- 201 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-01: System Options for Incoming Calls
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 22-01-10 Item VRS Waiting Message Operation Input data 0 : Enable always 1 : Charge by manual operation Default 0 Description This program set up the operation mode for Auto Attendant and Queuing Message.

IN SA SB
Related Program 22-14 22-15 22-08 22-04 22-01-04 20-15-11 15-07 22-14-06 22-15-06

22-01-11

VRS Waiting Message Interval Time

0-64800(sec.)

20

Setup the sending duration time of the Auto - Attendant & Queuing. The message is repeatedly sent out within the specified time.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central office Calls, Answering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-01(System Options for Incoming Calls): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 01

22-01-01 ICM Priority

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 202 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


COPY

22-02: Incoming Call Trunk Setup

Description
Use Program 22-02 : Incoming Call Trunk Setup to assign the incoming trunk type for each trunk. There is one item for each Night Service Mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number Day/Night Mode. 1-8 1-51 Related Program 14-04

Incoming Type 0 : Normal 1 : VRS(Second Dial Tone if no VRS installed) 2 : DISA 3 : DID 4 : DIL 5 : E&M Tie line 6 : Delayed DID

Default 0

Description Use this option to set the feature type for the trunk you are programming.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central office Calls, Answering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-02(Incoming Call Trunk Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 02

22-02-01 Trunk1 Mode1 TRK Type=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-02-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the trunk number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 203 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-03: Trunk Ring Tone Setup Description
COPY

IN SA SB

Use Program 22-03 : Trunk Ring Tone Setup to select the ring tone range for the trunk. The trunk uses a ring tone within the range selected when it rings an extension. There are three ring tones available.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 Related Program

Ring Tone Pattern

Default

Description Use this program to select the ring tone range for the trunk. The trunk uses a ring tone within the range selected when it rings an extension. There are three ring tones available. Frequency 600/450/16Hz 450/16Hz 600Hz Modulation FM AM

0-2 Ring Tone pattern 1-3

15-02

Incoming Signal Frequency Pattern 0: Tone Pattern 1 1: Tone Pattern 2 2: Tone Pattern 3

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Selectable Ring Tones

Programming Manual

- 204 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


COPY

22-03: Trunk Ring Tone Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-03(Trunk Ring Tone Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 03

22-03-01 Trunk1 Ring Tone Pat 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-03-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the trunk number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 205 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-04: Incoming Extension Ring Group Assignment Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 22-04 : Incoming Extension Ring Group Assignment to assign extensions to Ring Groups. Calls ring extensions according to Ring Group programming. Use Program 22-05 to assign trunks to Ring Groups. IRG can have up to 32 extension numbers assigned.

Input Data
Incoming Ring Group Number Incoming Ring Group No. 01-32 Extension Number Max. 4 digits 1-25 Related Program 22-02 22-05 22-06

Description Use this program to assign extensions to Ring Groups. Calls ring extensions according to Ring Group programming.

Default Extension 200 rings for incoming Ring Group 1 calls. All other extensions do not ring for incoming Ring Group 1 calls. Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Ring Groups

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-04(Incoming Extension Ring Group Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 04

22-04-01INC Gr1 Memb.01= 200


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-04-xx INCGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Incoming Ring Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 206 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


COPY

22-05: IRG Assignment for Normal Ring Trunk

Description
Use Program 22-05 : Incoming Trunk Ring Group Assignment to assign trunks to incoming Ring Groups.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number Day/Night Mode 1-8 1-51 Related Program 22-04 22-06

Incoming Group Number 0 : No setting 1-25 : Incoming Ring Group 101 : DSPDB-VM

Default

Description Use this program to assign Normal Ring Trunks (22-02) to Incoming Ring Groups (22-04).

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Ring Groups

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-05(Incoming Trunk Ring Group Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 05

22-05-01 Trunk1 Mode1 IRG =1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-05-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 207 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-06: Normal Incoming Ring Mode Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 22-06 : Normal Incoming Ring Mode to define whether or not an extension should ring for the Normal Incoming Ring Mode.

Input Data
Extension Number Day/Night Mode 1-8 Max. 4 digits

Incoming Group Number 0 : No Ring 1 : Ring

Default 1

Related Program 22-04 22-05

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Answering

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-06(Normal Incoming Ring Mode): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 06

22-06-01 TEL200 Mode1 =1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-06-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 208 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-07: DIL Assignment

Description
Use Program 22-07 : DIL Assignment to assign the destination extension or Department Calling Group for each DIL Incoming trunk. A DIL rings an extension directly, without any other Access Map or Ring Group programming. If an extension has a line key, the DIL rings the line key. If the extension does not have a line key, the DIL rings loop keys (if programmed) or the CALL key (CALL key will always ring). Use Program 22-02 to designate a trunk as a DIL). You can make eight DIL assignments, one for each Night Service mode:

Input Data
Trunk Port Number Day/Night Mode 1-8 1-51

Number of Transferring Destination Extension number (Max. 4 digits) Department Group number (Max.4 digits)

Default

Related Program

No setting

22-02

Conditions
Program 22-02 must be set to 4 for the trunk.

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Line (DIL)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-07(DIL Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 07

22-07-01 Trunk1 Mode1 No =


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-07-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 209 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-08: DIL/IRG No Answer Destination Description
COPY

IN SA SB

For DIL Delayed Ringing, use Program 22-08 : DIL/IRG No Answer Destination to assign the DIL No Answer Ring Group. An unanswered DIL rings this group after the DIL No Answer Time expires (Program 22-01-04). DIL Delayed Ringing can also reroute outside calls ringing a Ring Group. You make eight assignments, one for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number Day/Night Mode 1-8 1-51

Incoming Group Number 0 : No setting 1-25 : Incoming Ring Group 101 : DSPDB-VM

Default

Related Program

22-01-04

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Line (DIL) Ring Group

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-08(DIL/IRG No Answer Destination): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 08

22-08-01 Trunk1 Mode1 IRG =0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-08-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 210 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-09: DID Basic Data Setup

Description
Use Program 22-09 : DID Basic Data Setup to define the basic setting of Dial-In incoming calls for each trunk group.

Input Data
Trunk Group Number 1-25

Prog. No. 22-09-01

Item Expected Number of Digits Enter the number of digits the table expects to receive from the telco. Use this program to make the system compatible with three- and four-digit DID service Received Vacant Number Operation Use this option to enable or disable Vacant Number Intercept. Sub-addressing Mode DID Receiving Mode for ISDN Local Code Digits (Only Overlap Receiving Mode) Local Code (Only Overlap Receiving Mode) Pilot Code (Only Overlap Receiving Mode) T302 Time-out Operation (Only Overlap Receiving Mode)

Input Data

Default

1-8

22-09-02

0 : Disconnect 1 : Transfer (Program 22-12) 0 : Extension Number specify 1 : DID Conversion Table 0 : Enbloc receiving 1 : Overlap receiving 0-15 (0 : No Local Code) Dial (Max. 16 digits) Dial (1 digit : 0-9) 0 : Disconnect 1 : Transfer (Program 22-12)

0 0 0 0 No setting No setting 0

22-09-03 22-09-04 22-09-05 22-09-06 22-09-07 22-09-08

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Dialing (DID)

- 211 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-09: DID Basic Data Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 22-09(DID Basic Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 09

IN SA SB

22-09-01TrkGrp1 D-In Recv digit4


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-09-xxTrkGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 212 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-10: DID Translation Table Setup

Description
Use Program 22-10 : DID Translation Table Setup to specify the size of the DID Translation Tables. There are 2000 Translation Table entries that you can allocate among 20 Translation Tables.

Input Data
Conversion Table Area Number 1-20

Item 1st Area Setup (Start Address) 1st Area Setup (End Address) 2 Area Setup (Start Address) 2nd Area Setup (End Address)
nd

Input data

0-2000 (0 : No setting)

Default
Conversion Table Area 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 20 1st Start Table 1 201 401 601 801 1001 1201 1401 1601 1801 : 0 End Table 200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 : 0 Start Table 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 : 0 2nd End Table 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 : 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Dialing (DID) Programming Manual

- 213 -

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-10: DID Translation Table Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 22-10(DID Translation Table Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 10

IN SA SB

22-10-01C-Area1 1st Start 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-10-xxC-Areaxx xxxxx 4. Select the Conversion Table Area number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 214 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-11: DID Translation Number Conversion

Description
Use Program 22-11 : DID Translation Number Conversion to specify for each Translation Table entry (2000): The digits received by the system (eight max.) The extension the system dials after translation (36 digits max.) The name that should show on the dialed extensions display when it rings (twelve characters max.) The Transfer Target-1 and 2 If the Transfer Targets are busy or receive no answer, those calls are transferred to the final transfer destination (Program 22-10). Operation mode Use the following chart when entering and editing text for names. Press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press 2 three times.

Key
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 *
LND OPAC CONF CLEAR FLASH

Number of pressing the Key


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

1 A D G J M P T W 0 *

@ B E H K N Q U X ! +

[ C F I L O R V Y ,

a d g j m S t Z # -

] b e h k n p u w $ .

^ c f i l o q v x % /

_ 2 3 4 5 6 r 8 y & :

s z ;

7 9 ( < ) = > ?

Move the cursor to the left Move the cursor to the right Clear the character entry to the left, one character at a time (Backspace Key) Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right. Switch the cursor moves to the upper row of the display and pressing FLASH again to moves the cursor back to the lower row.

- 215 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-11: DID Translation Number Conversion
Input Data
Conversion Table Number 1-2000

IN SA SB

Prog. No. 22-11-01 22-11-02 22-11-03 22-11-04

Item Received Number Target Number DID Name Transfer Operation Mode Max. 8 digits Max. 36 digits

Input Data

Default see Default see Default No setting 0

Max. 12 Characters 0 : No Transfer 1 : Busy 2 : No Answer 3 : Busy/ No Answer 0 : No setting 1-25 : Incoming Ring Group 101 : DSPDB-VM 201-232 : Department Group 400 : DID 401 : DISA 1000-1999 : Common ABB Dial (000-999) 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-51 (0 : No limit) 0 : MOH Tone 1 : BGM Source 2 : Music Source Port 0-6 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

22-11-05

Transfer Destination Number-1

22-11-06 22-11-07 22-11-08 22-11-09

Transfer Destination Number-2 Call Waiting Maximum Number of DID Calls Music on Hold Source

0 0 0 0 0 1

22-11-10 22-11-11

Music Source Port Number IRG Transfer

Default
Conversion Table Received Number Target Number

1 2 : 100 : 2000

00 01 : 99 : No setting

200 201 : 299 : No setting

Conditions None

Programming Manual

- 216 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-11: DID Translation Number Conversion

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Dialing (DID)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-11(DID Translation Number Conversion): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 11

22-11-01 TBL1 Recv No 00


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-11-xx TBLxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Conversion Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 217 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-12: DID Intercept Ring Group Description

IN SA SB

For each DID Translation Table, use Program 22-12 : DID Intercept Ring Group to define the first destination group for DID calls. Depending on the entry in Program 22-09 and 22-11, the incoming calls will route to the first destination group by the following; Vacant number intercept (vacant number means that there is no phone connected, no station card installed, or the extension number is not defined in Program 11-02) Busy intercept Ring-no-answer intercept If the destination is '0', the calls will be forwarded to the trunk ring group defined in Program 22-11 based on the table assigned to the DID trunk.
Note: If Program 22-09-05 and 22-09-06 are set, the priority of transferring will be in this order:

Program 22-09-05

Program 22-09-06

Program 22-12

Input Data
Conversion Table Area Number Day/Night Mode 1-8 1-20

Incoming Group Number 0 : No setting 1-25 : Incoming Ring Group 101 : DSPDB-VM

Default

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Dialing (DID)

Programming Manual

- 218 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-12: DID Intercept Ring Group

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-12(DID Intercept Ring Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 12

22-12-01C-Area1 Mode1 =0
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-12-xxC-Areaxx xxxxx 4. Select the Conversion Area Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 219 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-13: DID Trunk Group to Translation Table Assignment Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 22-13 : DID Trunk Group to Translation Table Assignment to assign the DID Trunk Groups to DID Translation Tables. DID trunks should be in their own group. If you have more than one type of DID trunk, put each type in a separate Trunk Group. For each Trunk Group, you make a Translation Table entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Group Number Day/Night Mode 1-8 1-25

Conversion Table Area Number 0-20 (0 : No setting)

Default 1

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward Dialing (DID)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 22-13(DID Trunk Group to Translation Table Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 13

22-13-01TrkGrp1 Mode1 =1
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-13-xxTrkGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 220 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-14: VRS Waiting Delayed Message for IRG

Description
Use Program 22-14 : VRS Waiting Delayed Message for IRG to define for each incoming ring group the timers, VRS message number and tone kind for VRS Waiting Message.

Input Data
Incoming Ring Group Number 1-25

Prog. No. 22-14-01 22-14-02


st

Item 1st Waiting Message start timing 1 Waiting Message Number

Input Data 0-64800(sec.) 0-49 (0 : No Message, 49 : Fixed message) 0-255 0-49 (0 : No Message, 49 : Fixed message) 0-255 0 : Ring Back Tone 1 : MOH Tone 2 : BGM Source 0-64800(sec.) (0 : Not Disconnected)

Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 60

22-14-03 22-14-04

1st Waiting Message sending count 2 Waiting Message Number


nd

22-14-05 22-14-06

2nd Waiting Message sending count Tone kind at Message Interval

22-14-07

Disconnect time after the end of VRS Waiting Message

ExampleTime chart for VRS Waiting Message (PRG22-14-03 = 3 counts, PRG22-14-05=2 counts)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

- 221 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-14: VRS Waiting Delayed Message for IRG Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 22-14(VRS Waiting Delayed Message for IRG): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 14

IN SA SB

22-14-01INCGrp1 MSG1 StatTM0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-14-xxINCGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Incoming Ring Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 222 -

IN SA SB

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-15: VRS Waiting Message for Department Group

Description
Use Program 22-15 : VRS Waiting Message for Department Group to define for each Department (Extension) Group the timers, VRS message number and tone kind for VRS Waiting Message.

Input Data
Extension Group Number 01-32

Prog. No. 22-15-01 22-15-02


st

Item 1st Waiting Message start timing 1 Waiting Message Number

Input Data 0-64800(sec.) 0-49 (0 : No Message, 49 : Fixed message) 0-255 0-49 (0 : No Message, 49 : Fixed message) 0-255 0 : Ring Back Tone 1 : MOH Tone 2 : BGM Source 0-64800(sec.) (0 : Not Disconnected)

Default 0 49 0 49 0 0 60

22-15-03 22-15-04

1st Waiting Message sending count 2 Waiting Message Number


nd

22-15-05 22-15-06

2nd Waiting Message sending count Tone kind at Message Interval

22-15-07

Disconnect time after the end of VRS Waiting Message

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Department Group

- 223 -

Programming Manual

Program 22: Incoming Call Setup


22-15: VRS Waiting Message for Department Group Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 22-15(VRS Waiting Message for Department Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 22 15

IN SA SB

22-15-01 Ex.Gr1 MSG1 StatTM0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

22-15-xx Ex.Grxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 224 -

IN SA SB

Program 23: Answer Features Setup


23-01: Not used

Description
This feature is currently not available.

- 225 -

Programming Manual

Program 23: Answer Features Setup


23-02: Call Pickup Groups Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 23-02 : Call Pickup Groups to assign extensions to Call Pickup Groups. This program also lets you assign an extensions Call Pickup Group priority. If two extensions in a group are ringing at the same time, Group Call Pickup intercepts the highest priority extension first.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Group Number

Priority

Default

Description

1-32

1-999

1-xxx

Use this program to assign extensions to Call Pickup Groups other than the extension group set up by a Program 16-02.

Related Program 11-12-26 11-12-27 11-12-28 15-07-24 15-07-25 15-07-26

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Group Call Pickup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 23-02(Call Pickup Groups): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 23 02

23-02-01 TEL200 Group No 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

23-02-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 226 -

IN SA SB

Program 23: Answer Features Setup


COPY

23-03: Universal Answer/Auto Answer

Description
Use Program 23-03 : Universal Answer/Auto Answer to assign trunk routes 1-25 (set in Program 14-06) to extensions for Universal Answer. If the call ringing the paging system is in an extensions assigned route, the user can dial the Universal Answer code (843) to pick up the call. You can also use this program to let an extension user automatically answer trunk calls that ring other extensions (not their own). When the user lifts the handset, they automatically answer the ringing calls based on Trunk Group Routing programming (defined in Program 14-06). The extension users own ringing calls, however, always have priority over calls ringing other co-workers extensions. Refer to the Line Preference feature for more information. You make one entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Extension Number Day/Night Mode. Route Table Number Max. 4 digits Related Program

Default

Description Use this program to let an extension user automatically answer trunk calls that ring other extensions. When the user lifts the handset, they automatically answer the ringing calls based on Trunk Group Routing programming (defined in Program 14-06).

1-8

0-25

14-06

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Line Preference Night Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 23-03(Universal Answer/Auto Answer): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 23 03

23-03-01 TEL200 Mode1 Route=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

23-03-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 227 -

Program 23: Answer Features Setup


23-04:
Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions

COPY

IN SA SB

Description
Use Program 23-04 : Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions to set the off-hook automatic response priority for calls ringing virtual extension keys on a telephone.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Priority order

Extension Group Number 0-32 (0 : No setting)

Default

Description When an extension has a virtual extension assigned to a Programmable Function Key, this program determines the priority for automatically answering the ringing calls when the handset is lifted. If 0 is selected, when the user lifts the handset, the user will answer a ringing call from any group.

Related Program

1-4

16-02 20-10-08

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Multiple Directory Numbers/ Call Coverage

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 23-04(Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 23 04

23-04-01 TEL200 Order1 STG=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

23-04-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 228 -

IN SA SB

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-01: System Options for Hold

Description
Use Program 24-01 : System Options for Hold to define the system options for the Hold feature

Input Data
Prog. No. 24-01-01 Item Hold Recall Time A call on Hold recalls the extension that placed it on Hold after this interval. This timer works with the Hold Recall Callback Timer (Item 2). Hold Recall Callback Time A trunk recalling from Hold or Park rings an extension for this interval. This timer works with timer 01 (Hold Recall Time) or timer 06 and 07 (Park Recall Time). After this interval, the system invokes the Hold recall time again. Cycling between timer 01 and 02 and 06 and 07 continues until a user answers the call. Exclusive Hold Recall Time A call left on Exclusive Hold recalls the extension that placed it on Hold after this interval. Exclusive Hold Recall Callback Time An Exclusive Hold Recall rings an extension for this interval. If not picked up, the call goes back on System Hold. Forced Release of Held Call Depending on the setting of Program 14-01-16, the system disconnects calls on Hold longer than this interval Park Hold Time Normal A call left parked longer than this interval recalls the extension that initially parked it. Park Hold Time Extended A call left parked longer than this interval recalls the extension that initially parked it. Input Data 0-64800Sec. Default 90 Related Program

24-01-02

0-64800Sec.

30

24-01-03

0-64800Sec.

90

24-01-04

0-64800Sec.

30

24-01-05

0-64800Sec.

64800

24-01-06

0-64800Sec.

90

24-01-07

0-64800Sec.

300

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Hold Park

- 229 -

Programming Manual

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-01: System Options for Hold Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 24-01(System Options for Hold): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 01

IN SA SB

24-01-01 Hold Recall90


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 230 -

IN SA SB

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-02: System Options for Transfer

Description
Use Program 24-02 : System Options for Transfer to define the system options for Transfer feature.

Input Data
Prog. No. 24-02-01 Item Busy Transfer Use this option to prevent or allow extensions to Transfer calls to busy extensions. MOH or Ringback on Transferred Calls Use this option to enable or disable MOH on Transfer. If enabled (0), a transferred caller hears MOH while their call rings the destination extension. If disabled (1), a transferred caller hears ringback while their call rings the destination extension. Delayed Call Forwarding Time If activated at an extension, Delayed Call Forwarding occurs after this interval. This also sets how long a Transferred call waits at an extension forwarded to Voice Mail before routing to the called extensions mailbox. Transfer Recall Time An unanswered transferred call recalls to the extension that initially transferred it after this interval. Message Wait Ring Interval Timer For SLTs without message waiting lamps, this timer determines the amount of time between intermittent ringing. If this timer is set to '0' then the system rings once. Forced release timer for Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Delayed transfer timer for all extension groups 0-64800(Sec.) Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Default 0 Related Program

24-02-02

0 0 : Hold Tone 1 : Ring Back Tone 10 0-64800(Sec.)

24-02-03

24-02-04

30 0-64800(Sec.) 30 0-64800(Sec.)

24-02-05

24-02-07 24-02-08

0-64800(Sec.)

1800 10 11-11-28 11-11-29 15-07-59

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Transfer

- 231 -

Programming Manual

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-02: System Options for Transfer Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 24-02(System Options for Transfer): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 02

IN SA SB

24-02-01 Busy Ext TRF

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 232 -

IN SA SB

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


COPY

24-03: Park Group

Description
Use Program 24-03 : Park Group to assign an extension to a Park Group. The system allows a total of 64 Park Groups. An extension can only pick up a call parked in orbit by an extension in its own group.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Park Group Number 1-64

Default

Description Assign an extension to a Park Group. The system allows a total of 64 Park Groups. In a Key Telephone, Park Key can be assigned for a Function Key.

Related Program 15-07-01

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Park

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 24-03(Park Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 03

24-03-01 TEL200 ParkHold GrpNo1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-03-xx xxxxx 4. Select Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 233 -

Programming Manual

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-04: Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Target Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 24-04 : Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Target Setup to assign the Abbreviated Dialing number bin which should be used as the destination of the Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/Night Mode

Abbreviated Dial Area Number 0-1999

Default

Description The destination of telephone number of the Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer uses the number registered into the Abbreviated Dial. Use this program to setup the Abbreviated Dial area.

Related Program 11-10-8 13-04 24-05

1-8

1999

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Transfer

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 24-04(Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Target Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 04

24-04-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 ABB =1999


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-04-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 234 -

IN SA SB

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-05: Department Group Transfer Target Setup

Description
Use Program 24-05 : Department Group Transfer Target Setup to assign the Abbreviated Dialing bin which is used as the destination of the extension for the Department Group.

Input Data
Department Group Number 1-32

Day/Night Mode

Abbreviated Dial Area Number 0-1999

Default

Description The Abbreviated Dialing area is used as the registration place for the destination of the transferred telephone number at the time of the extension group transfer use.

Related Program 11-11-27 13-04 24-04

1-8

1999

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Transfer

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 24-05(Department Group Transfer Target Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 05

24-05-01 Ex Gr1 Mode1 ABB =1999


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-05-xx Ex.Grxx xxxxx 4. Select extension Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 235 -

Programming Manual

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-06: Fixed Call Forwarding Description

IN SA SB

For each extension/virtual extension port, use Program 24-06 : Fixed Call Forwarding to assign the Fixed Call Forwarding Type (0-4) and the destination extension/virtual extension. The following chart shows the Fixed Call Forwarding types: Fixed Call Forwarding Type 0 1 2 3 4 Description Fixed Call Forwarding Disable Fixed Call Forwarding with both extension ringing Fixed Call Forwarding when unanswered Fixed Call Forwarding immediate Fixed Call Forwarding when busy or unanswered

The Fixed Call Forwarding destination can be an on- or off-premise extension or a Voice Mail extension.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Fixed Call Forwarding Type 0 : Call Forwarding Disable 1 : Call Forwarding with both extension ringing 2 : Call Forwarding when unanswered 3 : Fixed Call Forwarding immediate 4 : Call Forwarding when busy or unanswered

Transferred Telephone Number

Default

Description Set the type of Fixed Call Forward type and specify the extension number transferred on originated telephone.

Max. 4 digits

Conditions
Do not use Fixed Call Forwarding Type 1 (Both Ringing) with Voice Mail ports.

Feature Cross Reference


Call Forwarding, Fixed

Programming Manual

- 236 -

IN SA SB

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-06: Fixed Call Forwarding

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 24-06(Fixed Call Forwarding): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 06

24-06-01 TEL200 Fix Cfwd Type 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-06-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 237 -

Programming Manual

Program 24: Hold/Transfer Setup


24-07: Fixed Call Forwarding Off-Premise Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 24-07 : Fixed Call Forwarding Off-Premise to assign the Fixed Call Forwarding Off-Premise telephone number for each extension/virtual extension. The off-premise destination can be up to 36 digits long, using 0-9, *, # and P (pause). Be sure to include the trunk access code (e.g., 9) in the number.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Off-Premise Destination Number 0-9, * #,P,R,@ (Max. 36 digits)

Default No setting

Conditions
None.

Feature Cross Reference


Call Forwarding, Off-Premise

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 24-07(Fixed Call Forwarding Off-Premise): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 24 07

24-07-01 TEL200 Dial=


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

24-07-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 238 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-01: DID/DISA Line Basic Data Setup

Description
Use Program 25-01 : DID/DISA Line Basic Data Setup to define the basic setting of each DID/DISA line.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Prog. No. 25-01-01

Item DID/DISA Dial-In Mode

Input Data 0 : Extension number/ Service Code Specify 1 : Use Dial Conversion Table of PRG 22-11 0 : Off 1 : On 0 : Normal Ringing 1 : Alarm

Default 0

Related Program 22-11

25-01-02 25-01-03

DISA User-ID DID/DISA Transfer Alarm

1 0

25-08

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-01(DID/DISA Line Basic Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 01

25-01-01TrkPrt1 Dial-In Mode 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-01-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 239 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-02: DID/DISA Talkie Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-02 : DID/DISA Talkie to assign the VRS message number to be used as the Automated Attendant Error Message for each trunk which is assigned as a DID/DISA.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Talkie Type 0 : No Talkie 1 : VRS 2 : ACI 3 : SLT

Additional data 1 : VRS 01-48 (VRS Message No.) 2 : ACI 1-4 (ACI Group No.) 3 : SLT 1-32 (Station Group No.)

Default

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-02(DID/DISA Talkie): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 02

25-02-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 Talkie= 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-02-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 240 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-03: DID/DISA Transfer Ring with Incorrect Dialing

Description
Use Program 25-03 : DID/DISA Transfer Ring Group with Incorrect Dialing to set what happens to a call when the DISA caller dials incorrectly or waits too long to dial. The call can either disconnect (0) or Transfer to an alternate destination (a ring group or voice mail). When setting the DISA and DID Operating Mode, you make an entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Incoming Group Number 0 : Disconnect 1-25 : Incoming Ring Group 101 : (DSPDB-VM)

Default

Related Program 22-04

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-03(DID/DISA Transfer ring Group with Incorrect Dialing): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 03

25-03-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 IRG No=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-03-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 241 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-04: DID/DISA Transfer Ring Group with No Answer/Busy Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-04 : DID/DISA Transfer Ring Group with No Answer/Busy to set the operating mode of each DISA trunk. This sets what happens to the call when the DISA caller calls a busy or unanswered extension. The call can either disconnect (0) or Transfer to an alternate destination (a ring group or voice mail). When setting the DISA and DID Operating Mode, you make an entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Incoming Group Number 0 : Disconnect 1-25 : Incoming Ring Group 101 : (DSPDB-VM)

Default

Related Program 22-04

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-04(DID/DISA Transfer Ring Group with No Answer/Busy): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 04

25-04-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 IRG No=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-04-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 242 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-05: DID/DISA Error Message Assignment

Description
Use Program 25-05 : DID/DISA Error Message Assignment to assign the VRS message number to be used as the Automated Attendant error message. For each DID/DISA trunk that the VRS will answer, enter the VRS message (1-48) the outside caller hears if they dial incorrectly. If you enter 0 (i.e., no error message), the call reroutes according to Program 25-03 and 25-04. For each trunk, you make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/Night Mode 1-8

VRS Message Number 0-48 (0 : No setting)

Default 0

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-05(DID/DISA Error Message Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 05

25-05-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 MSG No=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-05-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 243 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-06: DID/DISA One Digit Code Attendant Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-06 : DID/DISA One-Digit Code Attendant Setup to set up single digit dialing through the VRS. This gives VRS callers single key access to extensions, the company operator, Department Calling Groups and Voice Mail. For each VRS message set to answer outside calls (see Program 25-04 and 25-05), you specify: The digit the VRS caller dials (0-9, *, #). (Keep in mind that if you assign destinations to digits, outside callers will not be able to dial system extensions. The destination reached (eight digits max.) when the caller dials the specified digit. The destination can be an extension, a Department Calling pilot number or the Voice Mail master number. A onedigit code can be assigned for each Automated Attendant message. Example: Attendant Message Number=01, Received Dial=2, Next Attendant Message Number=0, Destination Number=399, In this example, when 2 is dialed by an outside caller, the system transfers the call to 399. This means that ext 200-299 cannot receive calls from DID / DISA users during/after VRS Message 01.

Input Data
Attendant Message Number 01-48

Received Dial

0-9,*,#

Prog. No. 25-06-01 25-06-02

Item Next Attendant Message Number Destination Number

Input Data 0-48 ( 0 : no setting) Max. 4 digits

Default 1 No setting

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Voice Response System (VRS)

Programming Manual

- 244 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-06: DID/DISA One Digit Code Attendant Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-06(DID/DISA One Digit Code Attendant Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 06

25-06-01Attend 1 Recv1 MSG No=0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-06-xxAttendxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 245 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-07: System Timer for DID/DISA Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-07 : System Timers for DID/DISA to set the value for the system timers which affect DID and DISA. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

Input Data
Prog. No. 25-07-01 Item DISA Dial Tone Time After answering a DISA trunk, the system waits this interval for the caller to dial the first digit of the DISA password. If the caller fails to dial within this interval, the system drops the call DID/DISA No Answer Time A DISA caller can ring an extension for this interval before the system sets the call as a Ring No Answer. After this interval expires, the call follows the programmed Ring No Answer routing (set in Program 25-03 and 25-04). Disconnect after DID/DISA re-transfer to IRG Calling Time to Automatic answering Telephone set Duration time for Guidance Message by Automatic answering telephone set Duration time for Guidance Message by ACI Talkie DISA Conversation Warning Tone Time Determine the length of time a DISA caller can talk before the Long Conversation tone is heard. DISA Long Conversation Disconnect This timer determines how long the system will wait before disconnecting a call after the Long Conversation tone is heard. DISA Internal Paging Time This is the maximum length of an Internal Page placed by a DISA caller. If the Page continues longer than this interval, the system terminates the DISA call. DISA External Paging Time This is the maximum length of an External Page placed by a DISA caller. If the Page continues longer than this interval, the system terminates the DISA call DID/DISA Answer Delay Timer -Not UsedDID/DISA Busy Tone Interval If a DISA caller dials a busy extension (and Program 25-04 = 0), the system plays busy tone for this interval before disconnecting. Delayed DID Answer Timer Assign the delay time from switching from a normal incoming status to DID mode. If this time is set to 0, the call will switch to DID mode immediately. Input Data Default Related Program

0-64800(sec)

10

25-04

25-07-02

0-64800(sec)

10

25-04

25-07-03 25-07-04 25-07-05 25-07-06 25-07-07

0-64800(sec) 0-64800(sec) 0-64800(sec) 0-64800(sec) 0-64800(sec)

60 10 10 10 30

25-07-08

0-64800(sec)

15

25-07-09

0-64800(sec)

30

25-07-10

0-64800(sec) 0-64800(sec) 0-64800(sec)

30 0 5

25-07-11 25-07-12 25-07-13

25-07-14

0-64800(sec)

10

Programming Manual

- 246 -

IN SA SB
Conditions None

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-07: System Timer for DID/DISA

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-07(System Timers for DID/DISA): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 07

25-07-01 VRS Dial TN 10


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-07-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 247 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-08: DISA User ID Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-08 : DISA User ID Setup to set the 6-digit DISA password for each user. There are 15 users each with one 6-digit password.

Input Data
DISA User Number 1-15

Password Dial (6 digits fixed)

Default No setting

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-08(DISA User ID Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 08

25-08-01DISA-U1 Password
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-08-xxDISA-Uxx xxxxx 4. Select the DISA User number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 248 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-09: Class of Service for DISA Users

Description
Use Program 25-09 : Class of Service for DISA Users to set the DISA Class of Service for each user. When a DISA caller enters a password (defined in Program 25-08), the system identifies the user and associates the appropriate DISA Class of Service with the call. Assign the DISA Class of Service options in Program 20-14. When programming DISA Class of Service, you make one entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
DISA User Number 1-15

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Class of Service 1-15

Default 1

Conditions 1) The DISA Class of Service cannot be 0. 2) You cannot use Program 20-06 to assign Class of Service to DISA trunks.

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-09(Class of service for DISA Users): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 09

25-09-01DISA-U1 Mode1 Class 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-09-xxDISA-Uxx xxxxx 4. Select the DISA User number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 249 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-10: Trunk Group Routing for DISA Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-10 : Trunk Group Routing for DISA to assign the Trunk Group route chosen when a user places a DISA call into the system and dials 9. Set Trunk Group Routing in Program 14-06. Enable or disable the DISA callers ability to dial 9 in Program 20-14-02. You assign a route to each DISA Class of Service (1-15). The system assigns a DISA Class of Service to a call based on the password the DISA caller dials. When programming, you make a separate entry for each Night Service Mode.

Input Data
DISA User Number 1-15

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Route Table Number 0-25 (0 : No Setting)

Default 1

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-10(Trunk Group Routing for DISA): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 10

25-10-01DISA-U1 Mode1 RouteTbl1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-10-xxDISA-Uxx xxxxx 4. Select the DISA User number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 250 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-11: DISA Toll Restriction Class

Description
For systems that use Toll Restriction, use Program 25-11 : DISA Toll Restriction Class to assign a Toll Restriction Class (1-15) to each DISA user (1-15). The system uses the Toll Restriction Class you enter in Program 21-05 and 21-06. The Toll Restriction Class assigned to a DISA call is based on the DISA Class of Service and user, which is determined by the password the caller dials. When programming, you make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
DISA User Number 1-15

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Toll Restriction Class 1-15

Default 2

Conditions
You cannot use Program 21-05 to assign Toll Restriction to DISA trunks.

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Toll Restriction

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-11(DISA Toll Restriction Class): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 11

25-11-01DISA-U1 Mode1 T/RClass2


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-11-xxDISA-Uxx xxxxx 4. Select Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 251 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-12: Alternate Trunk Group Routing for DISA Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 25-12 : Alternate Trunk Group Routing for DISA to define the trunk route selected when a DISA caller dials the Alternate Trunk Access Code. The route selected is based on the DISA callers Class of Service, which is in turn determined by the password the caller dials. When programming, you make a separate entry for each Night Service Mode. Use Program 11-09-02 to set the Alternate Trunk Access Code. Use Program 14-06 to set trunk routes.

Input Data
DISA User Number 1-15

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Route Table Number 0-25 (0 : No setting)

Default 0

Conditions
You cannot use Program 21-15 to assign Alternate Trunk Routing to DISA trunks.

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Trunk Group Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 25-12(Alternate Trunk Group Routing for DISA): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 12

25-12-01DISA-U1 Mode1 RouteTbl 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-12-xxDISA-Uxx xxxxx 4. Select the DISA User number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 252 -

IN SA SB

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-13: System Option for DISA

Description
Use Program 25-13 : System Option for DISA to enter the password DISA callers must dial before the system will allow them to record, listen to and or erase the VRS messages. This program also is used to define additional DISA call options.

Input Data
Prog. No. 25-13-01 Item VRS Password Enter the password DISA callers must dial before the system will allow them to record, listen to and or erase the VAU messages. Continue Code for DISA Trunk to Trunk Program the Continue code. This code is used with the Warning Tone for Long Conversation for DISA callers. This allows the user to press the programmed code to continue the conversation the call. If the Continue code is entered, this resets the timer in Program 25-07-07. Disconnect Code for DISA Trunk to Trunk Program the Disconnect code. This code is used with the Warning Tone for Long Conversation for DISA callers. This allows the user to press the programmed code to disconnect the call. If the Disconnect code is entered, the call is disconnected immediately. Input Data 0-9,*,# (Fixed 6 digits) Default Related Program

000000

25-13-02

0-9,*,# (1 digits)

No setting

25-13-03

0-9,*,# (1 digits)

No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Inward System Access (DISA) Voice Response System (VRS)

- 253 -

Programming Manual

Program 25: DID/DISA Setup


25-13: System Option for DISA Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 25-13(System Option for DISA): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 25 13

IN SA SB

25-13-01 Access PWD000000


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

25-13-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 254 -

IN SA SB

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-01: Automatic Route Selection Service

Description
Use Program 26-01 : Automatic Route Selection Service to define the system options for Automatic Route Selection (ARS).

Input Data
Prog. No. 26-01-01 ARS Service Enable or disable ARS Network Outgoing Inter-Digit ARS Timer With Networking, this timer replaces 20-03-04 when determining if all network protocol digits have been received. If ARS is enabled at Site B, this timer can be programmed for 5 (500 msec) at Site A. If ARS is disabled and Site B is using F-Route for outbound dialing, this timer should be programmed for 30 (3 seconds) at Site A. ARS Misdialed Number Handling If a user dials a number not programmed in ARS, this option determines if the system should route over trunk group 1 or play error tone. LCR Mode Use this option to define the operation of dialed numbers beginning with digit 1. Item Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-64800(x 100ms) Default 0 Related Program 26-02 26-03 26-04 20-03-04

26-01-02

30(3 sec.)

26-01-03

26-01-04

0 : Route to Trunk Group 1 : Play Warning Tone to Dialer 0 : UK Mode 1 : Not UK Mode

21-02

26-02 26-05 26-06 26-07 26-08 26-09

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection (ARS)

- 255 -

Programming Manual

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-01: Automatic Route Selection Service Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 26-01(Automatic Route Selection Service): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 01

IN SA SB

26-01-01 ARS Service

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 256 -

IN SA SB

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-02: Dial Analysis Table for ARS

Description
Use Program 26-02 : Dial Analysis Table for ARS to set pre-transaction tables for selecting Automatic Route Selection (ARS). Service Type 1 (Route to Trunk Group Number) - the number routes to a trunk group. Service Type 2 (F-Route Selected) - The number is controlled by the F-Route table.

Input Data
Dial Analysis Table Number 1-200

Prog. No. 26-02-01 26-02-02 Dial

Item Max. 16 digits

Input Data ( 0-9,*,#,@)

Default No setting 0

Related Program

Service Type

26-02-03

Service Number

0 : No ARS 1 : Route to Trunk Group 2 : Select F-Route access In Service Type 1: Select Trunk Group Number (0-25, 0=no route) In Service Type 2: F-Route Time Schedule Not Used = 0-500 (F-Route Table Number). Refer to Program 44-05. F-Route Time Schedule Used = 0-500 (F-Route Selection Number). Refer to Program 44-04.

44-04 44-05

26-02-04 26-02-05 26-02-06

ARS Class of Service Dial Treatment LCR Carrier Table

0-16 0-15 0-25

0 0 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection

- 257 -

Programming Manual

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-02: Dial Analysis Table for ARS Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 26-02(Dial Analysis Table for ARS): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 02

IN SA SB

26-02-01AnaTb1 Dial
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-02-xxAnaTbxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Dial Analysis Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 258 -

IN SA SB

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-03: ARS Dial Treatment

Description
Use Program 26-03 : ARS Dial Treatments to assign the 15 Dial Treatments for automatic ARS Dialing translation. Assign Dial Treatments to Service Numbers (Trunk Groups) in Program 26-02. The ARS Dial Treatment options are: 3 - Delete the NPA if dialed as part of the initial call. 2 - Delete the leading digit if dialed as part of the initial call. 1 - Add a leading 1 if not dialed as part of the initial call. INPA - Insert the NPA specified by NPA. DNN - Outdial the NN number of digits or execute the code that follows. For example, D041234 out-dials 1234. Valid entries are 0-9, #, *, Wnn (wait nn seconds) and P (pause). Each digits code counts as a digit. So for example, if a P was added for a pause, the entry would look like: D05P1234. This Dial Treatment can only be added from telephone programming. Wnn - Wait nn seconds. P - Pause in analogue trunk. R - Redial the initially dialed number, including any modifications E - End of Dial Treatment. All Dial Treatments must end with the E code. X - When ARS is enabled, X must be entered in the Dial Treatment in order for the system to output the extension number of the calls originator to the black box for the E911 feature.

Input Data
Prog. No. 26-03-01 Dial Treatment Table Number 1-15 Input Data Max. 36 characters Default No setting Related Program 26-02

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-03(ARS Dial Treatments): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 03

26-03-01ARS-T1
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-03-xxARS-Txx xxxxx 4. Select the Dial Treatment Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 259 -

Programming Manual

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-04: ARS Class of Service Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 26-04 : ARS Class of Service to set an extensions ARS Class of Service. Automatic Route Selection uses ARS Class of Service when determining how to route an extensions calls.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Prog. No. 26-04-01

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Class 0-16

Default 0

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-04(ARS Class of Service): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 04

26-04-01 TEL200 Mode1 :COS 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-04-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 260 -

IN SA SB

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-05: LCR Carrier Table

Description
Use Program 26-05 : LCR Carrier Table to define the LCR Access Codes and routing options. These options include Authorization codes and Cost Centre Codes.

Input Data
Carrier Table Number 1-25 Related Program

Prog. No. 26-05-01

Description Delete Digits Enter the quantity of leading digits that need to be deleted Access Code Enter the Access Code and Option to route to the Indirect Carrier Authorization Code Table Enter the table number that contains the correct Authorization code. Cost Centre Code Optionally enter a cost centre code. 0-16

Input Data

Default 0

26-05-02

Max. 16 digits (0-9,*,#,@,Pause) No setting 0-10 0 0 : Not used 1 : Used 0

26-05-03

26-05-04

Conditions The settings must comply with the requirements of the Indirect Carrier. The operation of the @ symbol within the Access Code depend on the type of trunk. For analogue trunk set as Dial Pulse the @ symbol defines change to DTMF dialing. For ISDN trunks the @ symbol defines that a Connect Message is received and then DTMF digits are sent in the B-Channel.

Feature Cross Reference


Least Cost Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-05(LCR Carrier Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 05

26-05-01CarTBL1 Delete digit 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-05-xx CarTBLxx xxxxx 4. Select the Carrier Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 261 -

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-06: LCR Authorization Code Table Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 26-06 : LCR Authorization Code Table to define the optional Authorization code (or PIN code) required by the Indirect Carrier. The Authorization code is inserted if set in Program 26-05-03.

Input Data
Authorization Table Number 1-10 Description Authorization Code Input Data Max. 10 digits0-9,*,# Default No setting Related Program 26-05-03

Conditions The settings must comply with the requirements of the Indirect Carrier. The Authorization Code is used by the Indirect Carrier to identify the customer for billing purposes.

Feature Cross Reference


Least Cost Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-06(LCR Authorization Code Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 06

26-06-01AthCod1 Dial
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-06-xxAthCodxx Dialxxxxxxxxxxxxx 4. Select the Authorization Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 262 -

IN SA SB

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-07: LCR Cost Centre Code Table

Description
Use Program 26-07 : LCR Cost Centre Code Table to define the optional cost centre code required by the Indirect Carrier. The cost centre code is set for each extension. The cost centre code is inserted if set in Program 26-05-04.

Input Data
Extension Number Max. 4 digits Input Data Max. 6 digits0-9,*,# Default No setting Related Program 26-05-04

Conditions The settings must comply with the requirements of the Indirect Carrier. The Authorization Code is used by the Indirect Carrier to identify the customer for billing purposes.

Feature Cross Reference


Least Cost Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-07(LCR Cost Centre Code Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 07

26-07-01 TEL200 Center CD


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-07-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 263 -

Programming Manual

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-08: LCR Manual Override Access Code Table Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 26-08 : LCR Manual Override Access Code Table to define the access codes that the users can dial to select an indirect carrier i.e. bypass the automatic selection of Program 26-02.

Input Data
Manual Override Access Code Table Number 1-10

Prog. No. 26-08-01

Description Manual Override Access Code This code is dialed by the user to bypass the automatic selection. Carrier table No. The carrier table number of Program 26-05.

Input Data Max.4 digits( 0-9,*,#)

Default No setting

Related Program 26-02

26-08-02

0-25

26-05

Conditions The override code must begin with a digit 1 or it will not be checked against this table. There can also exemptions to this table in Program 26-09.

Feature Cross Reference


Least Cost Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-08(LCR Manual Override Access Code Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 08

26-08-01Manual 1 Dial
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-08-xx Manualxx xxxxx 4. Select the Manual Override Access Code Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 264 -

IN SA SB

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing


26-09: LCR Manual Override Exemption Table

Description
Use Program 26-09 : LCR Manual Override Exemption Table to define the numbers that must not be sent via an indirect carrier when the user dials a Manual Override Access Code. The exemptions are normally Emergency Services that may not be supported by the indirect carrier.

Input Data
Manual Override Exemption Table Number 1-25

Prog. No. 26-09-01

Description Exemption Number

Input Data Max.4 digits ( 0-9,*,#) Do not include the Access Code.

Default Table No.1: 999 Table No.2: 112 Others are no setting

Related Program 26-08

Conditions If the number dialed by the user corresponds to an entry in Program 26-09 the Topaz will delete the Manual Access code (Program 26-08) and route the call to the direct carrier. If the number specifies an Emergency Service you must ensure that the direct carrier will accept the call.

Feature Cross Reference


Least Cost Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 26-09(LCR Manual Override Exemption Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 26 09

26-09-01Exempt1 Dial 999


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

26-09-xx Exemptxx xxxxx 4. Select the Exemption Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 265 -

Programming Manual

Program 26: ARS Service & Least Cost Routing

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 266 -

IN SA SB

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-01: Not used

Description
This command is currently not available.

- 267 -

Programming Manual

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-02: DSS Console Extension Assignment Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 30-02 : DSS Console Extension Assignment to identify which extensions have DSS Consoles assigned. You can have up to 9 different DSS Consoles. A single extension can have up to 9 64-Button DSS Consoles (9 is the maximum allowed per system). Each extension in the system can have one 24-Button DLS Console (72 maximum). An extension can have a 24-Button DLS Console in addition to 64-Button DSS Consoles. When programming, each extension/DSS Console combination is called a Console Number. There are 9 Console Numbers (1-9). You assign Console Numbers to extensions. When entering data, you normally make the assignment for Console Number 1 first.

Input Data
DSS Console Number 1-9 The Extension Number for Key Telephone connected with the DSS Console Max. 4 digits Default No setting Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 30-02(DSS Console Extension Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 30 02

30-02-01 DSS1 Ext.Number


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

30-02-xx DSSx xxxxx 4. Select the DSS Console number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 268 -

IN SA SB

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


COPY

30-03: DSS Console Key Assignment

Description
Use Program 30-03 : DSS Console Key Assignments to customize the key assignments for 64-Button DSS Consoles. A DSS Console key can have any function up to four digits long (e.g., extension number or Service Code).

Input Data
DSS Console Number 1-9

Key Number 01-64

Function Number 00-99(Normal Function Level) *00-*99(Appearance Function Level)

Additional data Refer to Functional Number List

Function Number Lists 1)General Functional Level (00-99)


Function Number 00 01 Function Not Defined DSS/One-Touch Microphone Key (On/Off) DND Key BGM(On/Off) Headset Transfer Key Conference Key Incoming Call Log Operation Mode Switch Call Forward Immediate Call Forward Busy Call Forward No Answer Mode Number (1-8) Extension number or number (Max.36 digits) any Red On: Extension Busy Off : Extension Idle Rapid Blink Red : DND or Call Forward Red On: MIC On Off : MIC Off Red On: DND Setup Red On: BGM On Off : BGM Off Red On: Headset Operating None Red On: Under Conference Operation Rapid Blink Red : New Call Log Red On: Call Log Off : No Call Log Red On: On mode Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Additional Data LED Indication

02

03 04 05 06 07 08

09 10 11 12

- 269 -

Programming Manual

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-03: DSS Console Key Assignment
Function Number Lists(Contd)
Function Number 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 Function Call Forward Busy or No Answer Call Forward Both Ring Call forward Follow me Call Forward to Station Call Forward to Device Text Message Setup External Group Paging External All Paging Internal Group Paging Internal; All Call Paging Meet-me answer to Internal Paging Call Pickup for Own Group Call Pickup for another Group Call Pickup for specified Group Common Abbreviated dial Group Abbreviated Dial Repeat Dial Saved Number Redial Memo dial Meet me conference Override(Off-hook signaling) Break-in Camp on Department Step Call Internal Paging Number (1-32) Additional Data LED Indication

COPY

IN SA SB

Message Number(01-20) External Paging Number (1-6)

Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Slow Blink Red : Forwarding state Rapid Blink Red : Forwarded state Red On: Under Setting Red On: Active Red On: Active Red On: Active None None None None

Call Pickup Group Number (01-32) Common Abbreviated dial number (00-99 or 000-999) Group Abbreviated dial Number (00-99 or 000-999)

None None None Rapid Blink Red : Under a repeat dial None None None None None Red On: Under camp-on or reservation None

Programming Manual

- 270 -

IN SA SB

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


COPY

30-03: DSS Console Key Assignment

Function Number Lists(Contd)


Function Number 37 38 39 40 Function DND/ Call FWD Override Call Message Waiting Room Monitoring Handset Transmission cutoff Secretary (Buzzer) Call Boss-Secretary Series Call Common Hold Exclusive Hold Department Hunt Group Withdrawing -Not Used-Not UsedCall Redirection Account Code -Not UsedIncoming Call queuing Setup Queuing Message Starting External Call Forward by Door Box Extension Name Edit Presence Display Operation Presence Display Indication Automatic Transfer at Department Group Call Delayed Transfer at Department Group Call Incoming Ring Group (01-25) Extension Number or Voice Mail Number (Max.4 digits) Additional Data None None Rapid Blink Red : Under Monitored Slow Blink Red : Under Monitoring Red On : Transmission Cut-Off LED Indication

41 42 43 44 45 46

Extension Number (Max.4digits) Extension Number (Max.4digits)

Red On : Transmission side Rapid Blink Red : Receiver side Red On : Boss-Secretary Mode None None None Red On : Withdrawing

47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54

None None Red On : Under setting Red On: Active Red On: Active

55 56 57 58

None 1-100 1-100 Group No. 01-32 Group No. 01-32 Red On: Presence Red On: Presence None None

59

- 271 -

Programming Manual

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-03: DSS Console Key Assignment
Function Number Lists(Contd)
Function Number 60 Function DND at Department Group Call Calling Line Identification Restriction Mode CTI Communication Mail Box(DSPDB) Additional Data Group No.01-32 None LED Indication

COPY

IN SA SB

63

Red On: Active

66 67

Red On: CTI active Extension Number or Department group Number (Max. 4 digits) 0 : Play Skip 1 : Play Back Skip 2 : Monitor 0 : Conversation recording 1 : Delete, Re-recording 2 : Delete Extension Number or Department group Number (Max.4 digits) Extension Number or Department group Number (Max.4 digits) Extension Number(Max.4 digits) Trunk Line No.01-51 Rapid Blink Red : New message received Red On : There are messages. Slow Blink Red : The message store regulation is under setup. 2 : In case of monitor mode, Slow Blink Red : Monitor setting Automatic Red On : Monitor setting - Manual 0 : In case of Conversation recording, Rapid Blink Red : Under recording (No destination) Red On : Under recording (Appointed destination) Red On : All Calls Slow Blink Red : Busy/ No Answer Calls

68

Voice Mail Service (DSPDB)

69

Conversation recording service (DSPDB) Automated Attendant for extension (DSPDB) Message change for Voice Attendant -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedTandem Ringing Setup Key Automatic Transfer to Transfer Key

70

71

None

72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81

Red On : Master side Slow Blink Red : Slave Side Red On : Set Off : Cancel

Programming Manual

- 272 -

IN SA SB

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


COPY

30-03: DSS Console Key Assignment

2)Appearance Functional Level (*00-*99)


Function Number *01 *04 Function Trunk key Park key Additional Data Trunk Number (01-51) Park Number (01-64) LED Indication

Default All DSS Console


Key Number DSS01 DSS02 : DSS64 Function Number 01(DSS Key) 01(DSS Key) : 01(DSS Key) Additional Data 200 201 : 263

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 30-03(DSS Console Key Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 30 03

30-03-01 DSS 1 KY01=01


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

30-03-xx DSS x xxxxx 4. Select the DSS Console number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 273 -

Programming Manual

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-04: Not Used Description
This command is currently not available.

IN SA SB

Programming Manual

- 274 -

IN SA SB

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-05: DSS Console Lamp Table

Description
Use Program 30-05 : DSS Console Lamp Table to defines the LED patterns for functions on each DSS console.

Input Data
Prog. No. 30-05-01 30-05-02 30-05-03 Idle Extension Busy Extension DND Extension Item Lamp Pattern Data 0-3,5,7 (4,6: Not Used) 0-3,5,7 (4,6: Not Used) 0-3,5,7 (4,6: Not Used) Default 0(Off) 7(On) 3(RW) Related Program

- 275 -

Programming Manual

Program 30: DSS/DLS Console


30-05: DSS Console Lamp Table
Conditions None

IN SA SB

Feature Cross Reference


Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 30-05(DSS Console Lamp Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 30 05

30-05-01 Idle Extension

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

30-05-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 276 -

IN SA SB

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-01: System Options for Internal/External Paging

Description
Use Program 31-01 : System Options for Internal/External Paging to define the system options for Internal / External Paging. The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. Use the following chart when entering and editing text. When using the keypad digits, press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press key 2 three times. Press the key six times display the lower case letter.

Key
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 *
LND OPAC CONF CLEAR

Number of pressing the Key


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

1 A D G J M P T W 0 *

@ B E H K N Q U X ! +

[ C F I L O R V Y ,

a d g j m S t Z # -

] b e h k n p u w $ .

^ c f i l o q v x % /

_ 2 3 4 5 6 r 8 y & :

s z ;

7 9 ( < ) = > ?

Move the cursor to the left Move the cursor to the right Clear the character entry to the left, one character at a time (Backspace Key) Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.

Input Data
Prog. No. Item Input Data Default Description Assign a name to each All Call Internal Paging zone. The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. This timer sets the maximum length of Page announcements. Once the user initiates a Meet Me Conference or Voice Call Conference, the system waits this interval for the Paged party to join the call. Related Program 11-12-19 31-02-02

31-01-01

All Call Paging Zone Name Page Announcement Duration -Not Used-

Up to Characters

GRP ALL

31-01-02 31-01-03

0-64800(Sec.) -

1200 -

31-01-04

Privacy release Time

0-64800(Sec.)

90

- 277 -

Programming Manual

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-01: System Options for Internal/External Paging
Conditions None

COPY

IN SA SB

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, External Paging, Internal

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-01(System Options for Internal/External Paging): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 01

31-01-01 Name-Group all


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 278 -

IN SA SB

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


COPY

31-02 Internal Paging Group Assignment

Description
Use Program 31-02 : Internal Paging Group Assignment to assign extensions to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones). The setting in this program also determines if the Internal Page Group can receive Internal All Call Paging. The system can have up to 32 paging groups. An extension can be in only one Internal Paging Group.

Input Data
Prog. No. 31-02-01 Extension Number Max. 4 digits Item Internal Paging Group Number Assign extensions to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones). The system allows up to 64 Internal Paging Groups. An extension can be in only one Internal Paging Group. Internal All Call Paging Receiving Allow or prevent All Call Internal Paging for each extension. If allowed, extension can place and receive All Call Internal Paging announcements. If prevented, extension can only make (not receive) All Call Internal Paging announcements. Input Data 0-32(0 : no setting) Default 0

31-02-02

0 : Off 1 : On

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, Internal

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-02(Internal Paging Group Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 02

31-02-01 TEL200 INT PG GP No 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-02-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Select the Extension number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 279 -

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-03: Internal Paging Group Settings Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 31-03 : Internal Paging Group Settings to assign names to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones) and to define the splash tone for Internal Paging. The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. Use the following chart when entering and editing text. When using the keypad digits, press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press key 2 three times. Press the key six times display the lower case letter.

Key
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 *
LND OPAC CONF CLEAR

Number of pressing the Key


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

1 A D G J M P T W 0 *

@ B E H K N Q U X ! +

[ C F I L O R V Y ,

a d g j m S t Z # -

] b e h k n p u w $ .

^ c f i l o q v x % /

_ 2 3 4 5 6 r 8 y & :

s z ;

7 9 ( < ) = > ?

Move the cursor to the left Move the cursor to the right Clear the character entry to the left, one character at a time (Backspace Key) Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.

Input Data
Internal Paging Group Number 1-32

Prog. No. 31-03-01

Item Internal Paging Group Name

Input Data Up to 12 Characters

Default see Default

Description Assign names to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones). The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. Allow an extension to have normal (0), muted (1) or no (2) Internal Paging alert beeps before a Paging announcement.

31-03-02

Internal Paging Splash Tone

0 : Ordinary Volume 1 : Mute 2 : No tone

Programming Manual

- 280 -

IN SA SB
Default

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-03: Internal Paging Group Settings

Program Number

Internal Paging Group 1

Name Group 1 Group 2 : Group 32

31-03-01 Internal Paging Group Name

2 : 32

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, Internal

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-03(Internal Paging Group Settings): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 03

31-03-01Paging1 Name-Group 1
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-03-xxPagingxx xxxxx 4. Select the Internal Paging Group number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 281 -

Programming Manual

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-04: External Paging Zone Group Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 31-04 : External Paging Zone Group to assign each External Paging zone to an External Paging group. Users call the External Paging group when broadcasting announcements to the external zone. When programming, the zones on the PGDU are numbers 1-6. To simplify programming and troubleshooting, always make the External Paging Zone Group the same number as the External Paging zone (i.e., 1 = 1, 2 = 2, etc.).

Input Data
External Speaker Number 1-6 External Paging Group No. 0-6 (0 : No setting) Default Speaker 1 (2PGDU-1) : 1 (Group 1) Speaker 2 (2PGDU-1) : 2 (Group 2) Speaker 3 (2PGDU-2) : 3 (Group 3) Speaker 4 (2PGDU-2) : 4 (Group 4) Speaker 5 (2PGDU-3) : 5 (Group 5) Speaker 6 (2PGDU-3) : 6 (Group 6)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, External

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-04(External Paging Zone Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 04

31-04-01 SPK 1 Paging Zone GP 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-04-xx SPK x xxxxx 4. Select the External Speaker number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 282 -

IN SA SB

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


COPY 31-05: Incoming Ring Tone Audible on External Speaker

Description
Use Program 31-05 : Incoming Ring Tone Audible on External Speaker to assign Universal Night Answer ringing to each External Paging zone. For each trunk port (1-51), you make a separate entry for each External Paging zone (1-6). When programming, the zones on the PGDU are numbers 1-6. For Incoming Ring Tone Audible on External Speaker, you make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port No. 1-51 External Speaker No. 1-6 Day/Night Mode 1-8 Input Data 0 : No Ringing 1 : Ringing Default 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, External Night Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-05(Universal Night Answer): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 05

31-05-01 Trunk1 Spkr1 Mode1 = 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-05-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 283 -

Programming Manual

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-06: External Speaker Control Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 31-06 : External Speaker Control to define the settings for the external speaker using an amplifier.

Input Data
Prog. No. 31-06-01 External Speaker No. Item Broadcast Splash Tone Before Paging Use this option to enabled or disable splash tone before Paging over an external zone. If enabled, the system broadcasts a splash tone before the External Paging announcement. Broadcast Splash Tone After Paging Use this option to enabled or disable splash tone after Paging over an external zone. If enabled, the system broadcasts a splash tone at the end of an External Paging announcement. Speech Path2PGDUSpeaker CODEC Transmit Gain Setup CODEC Receive Gain Setup Input Data 0 : No tone 1 : Splash tone 2 : Chime tone Default 2

31-06-02 1-6

0 : No tone 1 : Splash tone 2 : Chime tone

31-06-03 31-06-04 31-06-05

0 : Both way 1 : One way 1-63(-15.5...+15.5) 1-63(-15.5...+15.5)

1 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, External

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-06(External Speaker Control): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 06

31-06-01 SPK 1 PG Start Tone 2


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-06-xx xxxxx 4. Select the External Speaker number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 284 -

IN SA SB

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-07: Combined Paging Assignments

Description
Use Program 31-07 : Combined Paging Assignments to assign an External Paging Zone (0-6) to an Internal Paging Zone (0-6) for Combined Paging. When an extension user makes a Combined Page, they simultaneously broadcast into both the External and Internal Zone.

Input Data
External Paging Group Number 0-6 (0 : All External Paging) Internal Paging Group Number 0-8 (0 : All Internal Paging) Default 1

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Paging, External Paging Internal

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-07(Combined Paging Assignments): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 07

31-07-01 PG Grp0 Intn PAG Grp No1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-07-xx PG Grpx xxxxx 4. Select the External Paging Group number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 285 -

Programming Manual

Program 31: External Speaker and Internal Paging


31-08: BGM on External Paging Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 31-08 : BGM on External Paging to set the Background Music option for each External Paging zone. If enabled, the system will play Background Music over the zone when it is idle. When programming, the zones on the PGDU Units are numbers 1-6.

Input Data
External Speaker Number 1-6 Input Data 0 : Disable (BGM Prevented) 1 : Enable (BGM allowed) Description Use this option to allow or prevent the External Paging zone you select from broadcasting Background Music when it is idle. Default 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Back Ground Music Paging External

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 31-08(BGM on External Paging): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 31 08

31-08-01 BGM

SPK 1 0

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

31-08-xx SPK x xxxxx 4. Select the External Speaker number to be Programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 286 -

IN SA SB

Program 32: Door Box Setup


32-01 Door Box Timers

Description
Use Program 32-01 : Door Box Timers to assign the timers used for the Door Box.

Input Data
Prog. No. 32-01-01 Item Door Box Answer Time A keyset user must answer Door Box chimes within this interval. Door Lock Cancel Time When a single line telephone user hook flashes or a keyset user presses the FLASH key while talking to a Door Box, the strike stays open for this interval. Off-Premise Call Forward by Door Box Disconnect Timer Define the conversation period for an Off-Premise Call Forward by Door Box call. When this timer expires, the caller will hear busy tone for 3 seconds (fixed timer) and the call will then be disconnected. Input Data 0-64800(sec.) Default 30 Related Program

32-01-02

0-64800(sec.)

10

32-01-03

0-64800(sec.)

60

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Door Box

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 32-01(Door Box Timers): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 32 01

32-01-01 Answer TM 30
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

32-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 287 -

Programming Manual

Program 32: Door Box Setup


32-02: Door Box Ring Assignment Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 32-02 : Door Box Ring Assignments to assign the extension which will ring when a caller presses the associated Door Boxs call button.

Input Data
Door Box Number 1-6

Day/Night Mode 1-8

Door Box Group Number 01-32

Extension Number Max. 4 digits

Default No setting

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Door Box

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 32-02 (Door Box Ring Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 32 02

32-02-01 DOOR 1 Mode1=01 TEL


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

32-02-xx DOOR x Modex=xxTELxxxx 4. Select the Door Box Number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. .

Programming Manual

- 288 -

IN SA SB

Program 32: Door Box Setup


32-03: Door Box Basic Setup

Description
Use Program 32-03 : Door Box Basic Setup to select the chime pattern and gain level for each Door Box. There are six distinctive chime patterns. The chime tones are defined in Program 80-01.

Input Data
Door Box Number 1-6 Related Program

Prog. No. 32-03-01

Item Chime Pattern

Input Data 0 : No ringing tone 1 : Door Box ring 1 2 : Door Box ring 2 3 : Door Box ring 3 4 : Door Box ring 4 5 : Door Box ring 5 6 : Door Box ring 6 1-63 : (-15.5..+15.5dB)

Default Door Box 1 : 1 Door Box 2 : 2 Door Box 3 : 3 Door Box 4 : 4 Door Box 5 : 5 Door Box 6 : 6 32

80-01

32-03-02

32-03-03

CODEC Transmit Gain Setup (2PGDU to Door Box) CODEC Receive Gain Setup (Door Box to 2PGDU)

1-63 : (-15.5..+15.5dB)

32

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Door Box

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 32-03 (Door Box Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 32 03

32-03-01 DOOR 1 Chime Pattern 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

32-03-xx DOOR x xxxxx 4. Select the Door Box Number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 289 -

Programming Manual

Program 32: Door Box Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 290 -

IN SA SB

Program 33: Analogue Interface Ports Setup


33-01 Analogue Interface Port Type Setup

Description
Use Program 33-01 : Analogue Interface Port Type Setup to set the function of each software port on an Analogue Communications Interface. Each Analogue Interface Port can have only one function (input, output or none).

Input Data
Analogue Interface Port Number Analogue Interface Port Type 0 : No setting 1 : Input 2 : Input/Output 3 : BGM Input 4 : EXMOH Input Default Related Program

1-6

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Analogue Interface Port

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 33-01 (Analogue Interface Port Type Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 33 01

33-01-01ACIPort1 ACI Type 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

33-01-xx ACIPortx xxxxx 4. Select the Analogue Interface port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 291 -

Programming Manual

Program 33: Analogue Interface Ports Setup


33-02: Analogue Interface Group Assignment Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 33-02 : Analogue Interface Group Assignment to assign Analogue Interface Ports (1-6) to Department Groups. There are 4 ACI Department Groups. An ACI port can only be in one group. Also use this program to set the ACI ports priority. When a call comes into the ACI Department Group, it connects to the ACI port in order of their priority. A higher priority port (e.g., 1) receives calls before a lower priority port (e.g., 6).

Input Data
Analogue Interface Port Number 1-6 Group Number 1-4 Priority 1-6 Default See Default

Default
Analogue Interface Port 1 2 : 6 Group Number 1 1 : 1 Priority Order 1 2 : 6

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Analogue Interface Port

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 33-02 (Analogue Interface Group Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 33 02

33-02-01ACIPort1 ACI Group No 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

33-02-xx ACIPortx xxxxx 4. Select the Analogue Interface port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 292 -

IN SA SB

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-01: E&M Tie Line Basic Setup

Description
Use Program 34-01 : E&M Tie Line Basic Setup to defines the basic settings for each E&M tie line.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 Related Program

Prog. No. 34-01-01

Item DID/E&M Start Signaling

Input Data 0 : 2nd Dial Tone 1 : Wink 2 : Immediate 3 : Delay 0 : Dial Pulse 1 : DTMF

Default 0

Description Set the start signaling mode for DID and tie trunks. DID and tie trunks can use either immediate start or wink start signaling. For DID and tie trunks, use this option to set the trunks signaling type (Dial Pulse or DTMF)

34-01-02

DID/E&M Incoming Signaling Type

34-01-03

E&M Dial-In Mode

34-01-04

E&M Line Dial tone

0 : Extension Number Specify 1 : Use conversion table 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-01 (E&M Tie Line Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 01

34-01-01TrkPrt1 Signal Type 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-01-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. - 293 Programming Manual

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-02: E&M Tie Line Class of Service Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 34-02 : E&M Tie Line Class of Service to assign a Class of Service to a tie line (there are 15 tie line Classes of Service). The Class of Service options are defined in Program 20-14. For each tie line, you make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 Day/Night Mode 1-8 Class of Service 1-15 Default 1 Related Program 20-14

Conditions
You cannot use Program 20-06 to assign Class of Service to tie lines.

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-02 (E&M Tie Line Class of Service): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 02

34-02-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 Class No1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-02-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.
32

Programming Manual

- 294 -

IN SA SB

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-03: Trunk Group Routing for E&M Tie Lines

Description
Use Program 34-03 : Trunk Group Routing for E&M Tie Lines to assign the trunk group route (1-25) chosen when a user seizes a tie line and dials 9. (Set Trunk Group Routing in Program 14-07.) If the system has Automatic Route Selection, dialing 9 accesses ARS. You make a separate entry for each tie line - for each Night Service Mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 Day/Night Mode 1-8 Route Table Number 0-25(0 : No setting) Default 1 Related Program 14-06 14-01-07

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-03 (Trunk Group Routing for E&M Tie Lines): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 03

34-03-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 RouteTbl1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-03-xxTrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 295 -

Programming Manual

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-04: E&M Tie Line Toll Restriction Class Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 34-04 : E&M Tie Line Toll Restriction Class to enter a Toll Restriction Class for each tie line. There are 15 Toll Restriction Classes which are defined in Programs 21-05 and 21-06. For each tie line, you make a separate Toll Restriction Class entry for each Night Service mode.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 Day/Night Mode 1-8 Toll Restriction Class 1-15 Default 1 Related Program 21-05 14-01-08

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-04 (E&M Tie Line Toll Restriction Class): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 04

34-04-01TrkPrt1 Mode1 T/RClass1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-04-xx TrkPrtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 296 -

IN SA SB

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-05: Tie Line Outgoing Call Restriction

Description
Use Program 34-05 : Tie Line Outgoing Call Restriction to build a restriction matrix for outgoing trunk calls placed from an inbound trunk (e.g., dialed from a tie line). For each inbound trunk group, enable or disable access to each CO trunk group.

Input Data
Incoming Trunk Group Number 1-25 Outgoing Trunk Group Number 1-25 Input Data 0 : Tandem Connect Allowed 1 : Tandem Connect Restricted Default See Default Related Program

Default
Outgoing Trunk Groups 1 1 2 3 4 : 25 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 Incoming Trunk Groups 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 25 0 0 0 0 0 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

- 297 -

Programming Manual

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-05: Tie Line Outgoing Call Restriction Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 34-05 (Tie Line Outgoing Call Restriction): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 05

IN SA SB

34-05-01INCGrp1 Out TRK Grp01 =0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-05-xx INCGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Incoming trunk Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 298 -

IN SA SB

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-06: Add/Delete Digit for E&M Tie Line

Description
Use Program 34-06 : Add / Delete Digit for E&M Tie Line to set digits that the system should add or delete for tie lines. Delete Digit Some tie line networks pass the location number and extension number to the remote side. This program allows the system to ignore such numbers for a call. If individual extensions do not want to receive an incoming call, you could delete all of the digits including the extension number. Add Digit If a tie line network requires additional digits to reroute the call to a location, the digits for the location can be added to the received digits.

Input Data
Incoming Trunk Group Number 1-25

Prog. No. 34-06-01 34-06-02

Item Delete Digit Additional Dial Digits

Input Data 0-255(255 : Delete all digits) Up to 4 digits

Default 0 No setting

Description

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-06 (Add/Delete Digits for E&M Tie Line): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 06

34-06-01INCGrp1 Delete Digit 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-06-xx INCGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Incoming trunk Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. - 299 Programming Manual

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


34-07: E&M Tie Line Timer Description
Use Program 34-07 : E&M Tie Line Timer to define the system service tone timers.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 34-07-01 34-07-02 34-07-03 34-07-04 34-07-05 Item 1st Digit Pause(E&M Immediate Start) 1st Digit Pause(E&M Wink Start) 1st Digit Pause(LDT) Leased Line Guard(LDT) Trunk Answer Detect Timer for E&M /E1 Input Data 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) 0-64800(sec.) Default 3 0 3 0 30 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-07 (E&M Tie Line Timer): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 07

34-07-01 E&M Mark

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-07-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 300 -

IN SA SB

Program 34: Tie Line Setup


COPY 34-08: Toll Restriction Data for E&M Tie Lines

Description
Use Program 34-08 : Toll Restirction Data for E&M Tie Lines to define the toll restriction data for E&M tie lines. This data should be defined if Toll Tie Line Restriction is enabled in Program 21-05-13.

Input Data
Class of Service 1-15 Table No. 01-20 Dial Data Up to 10 digits Default No setting Related Program 21-05-13

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 34-08(Toll Restriction Data for E&M Tie Lines): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 34 08

34-08-01TolCls1 01Dial
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

34-08-xx TolClsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 301 -

Programming Manual

Program 34: Tie Line Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 302 -

IN SA SB

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-01: SMDR Options

Description
Use Program 35-01 : SMDR Options to set the SMDR (Station Message Detail Recording) options for the SMDR port. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

Input Data
SMDR Port Number 1,2

Prog. No. 35-01-01

Item Output Port Type This option specifies the type of connection used for SMDR. The baud rate for the COM port should be set in Program 10-21-02. -Not UsedHeader Language Specify the language in which the SMDR header should be printed. Omit Digits The number of digits entered in this option do not print on the SMDR report. For example, if the entry is 10, the first 10 digits a user dials do not appear on the SMDR report. Min. Digits Outgoing calls must be at least this number of digits for inclusion in the SMDR report. Min. Call Duration The duration of a call must be at least this interval to be included on the SMDR report. Min. Ring Time A call must ring for at least this interval to be included on the SMDR report.

Input Data 0 : No Setting 1 : COM Port (EXIFU) 3 : LAN port (EXIFU) 0 : English 4 : Spanish 0-36 (0 : Not applied)

Default 0

Related Program

35-01-02 35-01-03

35-01-04

35-01-05

0-36 (0 : Not applied)

35-01-06

0-65535 (0 : All)

35-01-07

0-65535 (0 : All)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

- 303 -

Programming Manual

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-01: SMDR Options Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 35-01 (SMDR Options): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 35 01

IN SA SB

35-01-01 SMDR-P1 Output Type 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

35-01-xx SMDR-Px xxxxx 4. Select the SMDR port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 304 -

IN SA SB

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-02: SMDR Output Options

Description
Use Program 35-02 : SMDR Options to set the SMDR (Station Message Detail Recording) options for the SMDR port. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.

Input Data
SMDR Port Number 1,2

Prog. No. 35-02-01

Item Toll Restricted Call SMDR can include or exclude calls blocked by Toll Restriction. PBX Calls When the system is behind a PBX, SMDR can include all calls or just calls dialed using the PBX trunk access code. Trunk Number or Name Select whether the system should display the trunk name (0) or the number (1) on SMDR reports. If this option is set to 1, Program 35-02-14 must be set to 0 Summary (Daily) Set this option to (1) to have the SMDR report provide a daily summary (at midnight every night). Summary (Weekly) Set this option to (1) to have the SMDR report provide a weekly summary (every Saturday at midnight). Summary (Monthly) Set this option to (1) to have the SMDR report provide a monthly summary (at midnight on the last day of the month). Toll Charge Cost Set this option to (1) have the SMDR report include toll charges. Incoming Call Enable this option (1) to have the SMDR report include incoming calls. If you disable this option (0), incoming calls will not print. Extension Number or Name Set this option (1) to have the SMDR report include extension numbers. Set this option (0) to have the SMDR report include extension names.

Input Data 0 : Not Output 1 : Output 0 : Not Output 1 : Output

Default 1

Related Program

35-02-02

35-02-03

0 : Name 1 : Number

35-02-04

0 : Not Output 1 : Output

35-02-05

0 : Not Output 1 : Output

35-02-06

0 : Not Output 1 : Output

35-02-07

0 : Not Output 1 : Output 0 : Not Output 1 : Output

35-02-08

35-02-09

0 : Name 1 : Number

- 305 -

Programming Manual

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-02: SMDR Output Options
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 35-02-10 35-02-11 35-02-12 35-02-13 35-02-14 Item All Busy (ALB) Output Walking Number Toll Restriction Table Input Data 0 : Not Output 1 : Output 0 : Not Output 1 : Output 0 : Not Output 1 : Output 0 : Not Output 1 : Output 0 : Not Output 1 : Output Default 0 1 0 0 0

IN SA SB
Related Program

DID Table Name Output CLI Output When DID to Trunk Date Determine whether the date should be displayed on SMDR reports. This option must be set to 0 if the trunk name is set to be displayed in Program 35-02-03. CLI / DID Number Switching Trunk Name or Received Dialed Number Determine how the SMDR should print incoming calls on ANI/DNIS or DID trunks. If set to (1), ANI/DNIS trunks can print DNIS digits. If set to (0) trunk names are printed instead

35-02-15 35-02-16

0 : Calling Party No. 1 : Called Party No. 0 : Trunk port Name 1 : Received Dial Number

0 0

-SMDR Printout Format12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890 XX/XX/XX PAGE XXX CLASS aa bbbb TIME LINE DURATION STATION DIALLED No./CLI RD/COST ACCOUNT

cc:cc dddddddddd ee:ee:ee ffffffffff gggggggggggggggg hhhhhhh iiiiiiii

*Column 1(aa) : Call Number Indicate the number. Up to 55 calls are printout per a page. *Column 2(bbbb) : Class of Call Indicate the type of call as below; Item Description AIN Incoming Call on Analogue Trunk AOT Outgoing Call on Analogue Trunk IIN Incoming Call on ISDN Trunk IOT Outgoing Call on ISDN Trunk PIN Incoming Call on Tie Line

Item POT TOT ALB BRD BFL

Description Outgoing Call on Tie Line Outgoing Call by Tandem trunk All Trunk Busy Barred Outgoing Call Buffer Full

*Column 3(cc:cc) : Time Indicate a time(24 hours format) of incoming/outgoing/transferred call. *Column 4(dd) : Trunk Number/Name Indicate a Trunk Number or Name. *Column 5(ee:ee:ee) : Call Duration Time Indicate a call duration time of call. *Column 6(ff.) : Extension name Indicate a Extension Name. *Column 7(gg.) : Dialed data or received Caller-ID Data Indicate the dialed data of outgoing call. And also, indicate the received Caller-ID data.

Programming Manual

- 306 -

IN SA SB

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-02: SMDR Output Options

*Column 8(hh.) : Ring Duration or Cost Indicate a ringing duration time at the extension for incoming call. And also, indicate the calling cost data for outgoing call. However the calling cost data is not exactly same value as the PTTs calculation cost. <Note>Calling cost data will be provided from Line Provider by using Metering Pulse or Advice of Charge of ISDN. For these services availability, ask your countrys Line Provider. *Column 9(ii.) : Account Code or Password index No. of Walking Toll Restriction Indicate a Account Code or Password index No. if Walking Toll Restriction is used.

-Summary Data Printout FormatFor Example) Daily Summary


OUTGOING CALL/COST SUMMARY FOR DAY OF DD/MM/YY TOTAL NO. OF OUTGOING PSTN TOTAL NO. OF OUTGOING ISDN NO. OF OUTGOING PSTN CALLS NO. OF OUTGOING PSTN CALLS CALLS: CALLS: COSTED:XXXXX COST:XXXXXX.XX COSTED:XXXXX COST:XXXXXX.XX

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 35-02 (SMDR Output Options): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 35 02

35-02-01 SMDR-P1 T/R Call 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

35-02-xx SMDR-Px xxxxx 4. Select the SMDR port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 307 -

Programming Manual

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-03: SMDR Port Assignment for Trunk Group Description
COPY

IN SA SB

Use Program 35-03 : SMDR Port Assignment for Trunk Group to assign the SMDR port for each trunk group.

Input Data
Trunk Group No. 1-25 SMDR Port No. 1,2 Default 1 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) Trunk Group Routing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 35-03 (SMDR Port Assignment for Trunk Group): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 35 03

35-03-01TrkGrp1 SMDR Port 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

35-03-xxTrkGrpxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 308 -

IN SA SB

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


COPY 35-04: SMDR Port Assignment for Department Group

Description
Use Program 35-04 : SMDR Port Assignment for Department Groups to assign the SMDR port for each Department Group.

Input Data
Department Group No. 1-32 SMDR Port No. 1,2 Default 1 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 35-04 (SMDR Port Assignment for Department Groups): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 35 04

35-04-01 Ex.Gr1 SMDR Port 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

35-04-xx Ex.Grxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

32

- 309 -

Programming Manual

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-05: Account Code Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 35-05 : Account Code Setup to set various Account Code options for an extensions Class of Service. Assign a Class of Service to extensions in Program 20-06.

Input Data
Class of Service Number 1-15

Prog. No. 35-05-01

Item Account Code Mode Use this option to select the Account Code Mode (0-3).

Input Data 0 : Account Codes disable 1 : Account Codes optional 2 : Account Codes required but not verified. 3 : Account Codes required and verified. 0 : Account Codes for toll and local calls 1 : Account Codes just for toll calls. 0 : Account Codes for Incoming calls disabled. 1 : Account Codes for Incoming calls enabled. 0 : Account Codes displayed 1 : Account Codes hidden * is displayed

Default 0

Related Program

35-05-02

35-05-03

35-05-04

Forced Account Code Toll Call Setup Use this option enable Account Codes for all calls or just toll calls (for mode 2 or 3in Item 01 above). Account Codes for Incoming Calls Use this option to allow users to enter Account Codes for incoming calls. If disabled, any codes entered dial out on the connected trunk. Hiding Account Codes Use this option to either hide or show the Account codes on a telephones display.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Account Codes

Programming Manual

- 310 -

IN SA SB

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-05: Account Code Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 35-05 (Account code Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 35 05

35-05-01 F-Cls1 Account Code 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

35-05-xx F-Clsxx xxxxx 4. Select the Class of Service number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 311 -

Programming Manual

Program 35: SMDR and Account Code Setup


35-06: Verified Account Code Table Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 35-06 : Verified Account Code Table to enter Account Codes into the Verified Account Code list. You can enter up to 2000 codes from 3-16 digits long, using the characters 0-9 or #. Use the FLASH key to enter a wild card. For example, the entry FLASH234 means the user can enter 0234-9234.

Input Data
Verified Account Code Table No. 1-2000 Verified Account Code 0-9,#,@ (@ : Wild Card) (Up to 16 digits) Default No setting Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Account Code

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 35-06 (Verified Account Code Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 35 06

35-06-01 TBL1 Acct CD


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

35-06-xx TBLxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Verified Account Code Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 312 -

IN SA SB

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-01: Voice Mail Basic Setup

Description
Use Program 40-01 : Voice Mail Basic Setup to define the basic operation of Voice Mail (DSPDB).

Input Data
Prog. No. 40-01-01 Item Exclusive Channel for Voice Mail Specify the number of channels of DSPDB which voice mail occupies. Time Stamp Conversation Recording Mode for After Transfer Use this program to set up whether after Hold Transfer continues recording, when recording conversation. Automated Attendant (Voice Mail) for No Existing Extension Maintenance Time Specify time to maintain for DSPDB record media. Automatically Erase Message 0-16 Input Data Default 0 Related Program

40-01-02 40-01-03

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : Not Continued 1 : Continued

1 0

40-01-04 40-01-05

0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0000-2359 (0000 = No setting) 0-180(day)

0 0000

40-01-06

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-01 (Voice Mail Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 01

40-01-01 VM Channel

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. - 313 Programming Manual

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-02: Mailbox Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 40-02 : Mailbox Setup to define the mailbox of the Voice Mail (DSPDB). There are a maximum of 300 mailboxes in the DSPDB. Use this program to set the box number and password linked to the extension number (or pilot number) for each mailbox.

Input Data
DSPDB Message Box Number 001-300

Prog. No. 40-02-01

Item Mailbox Number A mailbox number should use the same number of an extension. Mailbox Password If not required, leave this option empty.

Input Data Up to 4 digits

Default No setting

Related Program

40-02-02

Dial 4 digits Fixed

No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-02 (SMDR Output Options): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 02

40-02-01MgBox1 Mail box No.


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-02-xxMgBoxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Message Box number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 314 -

IN SA SB

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-03: Message Recording Setup

Description
Use Program 40-03 : Message Recording Setup to define the auto-answering operation of the Voice Mail (DSPDB).

Input Data
Prog. No. 40-03-01 40-03-02 40-03-03 Item Voice Mail Recording Time A Guidance message in case recording is not allowed A response message is automatically sent out when busy Input Data 1-10 (minute) 0 : Fixed Guidance Message 1 : Answer Message of Mailbox 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Default 1 0 0 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-03 (Message Recording Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 03

40-03-01 VM RecordingTM1
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-03-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 315 -

Programming Manual

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-04: Live Recording Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 40-04 : Live Recording Setup to define the conversation recording operation of the Voice Mail (DSPDB).

Input Data
Prog. No. 40-04-01 40-04-02 40-04-03 Item The Operation mode when destination is not defined. Temporary Mailbox Number Setup the temporary mailbox number. Live Recording Display Enables or disables the systems ability to display the recording feature active. Input Data 0 : Temporary Mailbox 1 : Callback Operation 0-300 0 : Enable 1 : Disable Default 0 0 0 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-04 (Live Recording Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 04

40-04-01 Operation Mode 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 316 -

IN SA SB

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-05: Call Information Setup

Description
Use Program 40-05 : Call Information Setup to define the incoming notice of the Voice Mail (DSPDBU).

Input Data
Prog. No. 40-05-01 40-05-02 40-05-03 40-05-04 40-05-05 40-05-06 40-05-07 Item Maximum number of outgoing call simultaneously Trunk Route Number ISDN Calling Party Number Call interval for intercom call Call interval for external call Maximum number of intercom call Maximum number of external call 0-8 0-25 0-9,*,# (Max.16 digits) 1-30 minutes 1-30 minutes 1-100 1-100 Input Data Default 1 1 No setting 10 10 3 3 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-05 (Call Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 05

40-05-01 SimultaneousMax1
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-05-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 317 -

Programming Manual

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-06: Voice Mail Automated Attendant Data Setup Description
Use Program 40-06 : Voice Mail Automated Attendant Data Setup to define the outside lines to use the automated attendant recording operation of the Voice Mail (DSPDB).

IN SA SB

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

Day/Night Mode

1-8

Prog. No. 40-06-01 40-06-02 40-06-03 Operation Mode

Item

Input Data 0 : Automated Attendant 1 : Not Used 0-48 0-300

Default 0 0 0

Related Program

Guidance Message Number Message Box Number for Leaving a Message

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-06 (Voice Mail Automated Attendant Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 06

40-06-01 Trunk1 Mode1 OPE-Mode 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-06-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 318 -

IN SA SB

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-07: Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Voice Mail

Description
Use Program 40-07 : Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Voice Mail to specify the language to be used for the voice mail (DSPDB).

-This feature is currently not Available.(English only)Input Data


Prog. No. 40-07-01 Item Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Voice Mail Although the system allows this option to be changed in programming, the language will only change if the DSPDB has the firmware which provides the newly selected language. Input Data 1 : English Default 1 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-07 (Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Voice Mail): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 07

40-07-01 Sys Lang

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-07-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 319 -

Programming Manual

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-08:
Voice Prompt Language Assignment for each Mail Box

IN SA SB

Description
Use Program 40-08 : Voice Prompt Language Assignment for each Mail Box to specify the language to be used for the voice mail.

-This feature is currently not Available.(English Only.)Input Data


Mail Box Number 1-300

Prog. No. 40-08-01

Item Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Mailboxes Although the system allows this option to be changed in programming, the language will only change if the DSPDB has the firmware which provides the newly selected language.

Input Data 1 : English

Default 1

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-08 (Voice Prompt Language Assignment for each Mail Box): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 08

40-08-01MgBox1 Mail Lang 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-08-xx MgBoxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Mail Box number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.32

Programming Manual

- 320 -

IN SA SB

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-09: Voice Mail Multiple Address Group Setup

Description
Use Program 40-09 : Voice Mail Multiple Address Group Setup to define the broadcast group of a Voice Mail (DSPDB) mailbox.

Input Data
Multiple Address Group Number 1-10 Destination Box Number 1-100 Box Number Dial (Up to 4 digits) Default No setting Related Program 40-02

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (DSPDB)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-09 (Voice Mail Multiple Address Group Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 09

40-09-01Mlt GP1 Dest001 BoxNo


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-09-xx Mlt GPxx xxxxx 4. Select the Multiple Address Group number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 321 -

Programming Manual

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-10: Voice Announcement Service Option Description
Use Program 40-10 : Voice Announcement Service Option define the system options for the Voice Announcement feature.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 40-10-01 Item VRS Fixed Message Enable (1) or disable (0) the systems ability to play the fixed VRS messages (such as You have a message.). General Message Number This item assigns the VAU message number to be used as the General Message. VRS No Answer Destination This item assigns the transferred Ring Group when the VRS is unanswered after Call Forwarding with Personal Greeting Message. VRS No Answer Time If an extension has Personal Greeting enabled and all VRS ports are busy, a DIL or DISA call to the extension will wait this interval for a VRS port to become free. Park and Page Repeat Timer If a Park and Page is not picked up within this interval, the Paging announcement repeats. Input Data 0 : Not Used 1 : Used Default 1 Related Program

40-10-02

40-10-03

0-48 (0 : No General message) 0-25 (Incoming Ring Group No.) 0-64800(sec.)

0 (No Setting) 0

40-10-04

40-10-05

0-64800(sec.)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Response System (VRS)

Programming Manual

- 322 -

IN SA SB

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-10: Voice Announcement Service Option

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-10 (Voice Announce Service Option): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 10

40-10-01 VRS Fixed Msg

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-10-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 323 -

Programming Manual

Program 40: Voice Mail Setup


40-11: Pre-Amble Message Assignment Description

IN SA SB

In Program 40-11 : Pre-Amble Message Assignment to assign the VAU message number to be used as the Pre-amble Message for each trunk. When the extension user answers the incoming call, the assigned VAU message will be sent to the outside caller.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 Day/Night Mode 1-8 VAU Message Number 0-48(0 : No Service) Default 0 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Response System (VRS)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 40-11 (Pre-Amble Message Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 40 11

40-11-01 Trunk1 Mode1 Msg No.0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

40-11-xx Trunkxx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 324 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-01: System Options for ARS/F-Route

Description
Use Program 44-01 : System Options for ARS/F-Route to define the system options for the ARS/F-Route feature.

Input Data
Prog. No. 44-01-01 Item ARS/F-Route Time Schedule Input Data 0 : Not Used 1 : Used Default 0 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-01 (System Options for ARS/F-Route): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 01

44-01-01 F-Rout Schedul 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 325 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-02: Dial Analysis Table for ARS/F-Route Access Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 44-02 : Dial Analysis Table for ARS/F-Route Access to set the Pre-Transaction Table for selecting ARS/F-Route. Service Type 1 (Extension number) The number goes to an extension after deleting the front digit(s). Additional data Assign the digit(s) to be deleted on top of the number for extension number usage. There must be at least one digit deleted. Service Type 2 (ARS/F-Route select) The number is controlled by ARS/F-Route table. Additional data Assign the ARS/F-Route table number for Program 44-05. (If the ARS/F-Route Time schedule is not used.) Assign the ARS/F-Route selection number for Program 44-04. (If the ARS/F-Route Time schedule is used.) Service Type 3 (Dial Extension Analyze Table select) The total length of the number exceeds more than 5 digits. Additional data Assign the referring Dial Extension Analyze Table number for Program 44-03.

Input Data
Dial Analysis Number 1-120

Prog. No. 44-02-01 44-02-02 Dial

Item Up to 4 digits

Input Data

Default No setting 0

Related Program

Service Type

44-02-03

Additional Data

0 : No setting 1 : Select Extension Call 2 : Select ARS/F-Route Access 3 : Select Dial Extension Analyze Table When Select 1 (Select Extension Call) from 44-02-02 : 0-255 (Delete Digit) (255 : delete all digit) When Select 2 (Select ARS/F-Route Access) from 44-02-02 : - Not Used F-Route Time Schedule [Program 44-01 : 0] 0-500 (ARS/F-Route table Number) (0 : No setting) <Refer to Program 44-05> - Used F-Route Time Schedule [Program 44-01 : 1] 0-500 (ARS/F-Route select table Number) (0 : No setting) <Refer to Program 44-04> When Select 3 (Select Dial Extension Analyze Table) from 44-02-02 : 0-4 (Dial Extension Analyze Table Number) (0 : No setting) <Refer to Program 44-03>

44-01 44-02-02

44-02-04

Dial Tone Simulation

0 : Off 1 : On

Programming Manual

- 326 -

IN SA SB
Conditions None

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-02: Dial Analysis Table for ARS/F-Route Access

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-02 (Dial Analysis Table for ARS/F-Route Access): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 02

44-02-01A-TBL1 Dial
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-02-xx A-TBLxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Analyze table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 327 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-03: Dial Analyze Extension Table Description
Use Program 44-03 : Dial Analyze Extension Table to set the dial extension analyze table.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Extension Table Area Number 1-4

Dial Analysis Table Number

1-252

1. Dial Analysis Table Number 1-250: Prog. No. 44-03-01 44-03-02 Dial ARS/F-Route Select Table Number Item Up to 36 digits [Program 44-01 : 0] 0-500 (ARS/F-Route Table Number) <Program 44-05> [Program 44-01 : 1] 0-500 (ARS/F-Route select table Number) <Program 44-04> Input Data Default No setting 0 Related Program

2. Dial Analysis Table Number 251: Prog. No. 44-03-03 Item ARS/F-Route Select Table Number Input Data [Program 44-01 : 0] 0-500 (ARS/F-Route Table Number) <Program 44-05> [Program 44-01 : 1] 0-500 (ARS/F-Route select table Number) <Program 44-04> Default 0 Related Program

3. Dial Analysis Table Number 252: Prog. No. 44-03-04 Item Next Table Area Number 0-4 Input Data Default 0 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Programming Manual

- 328 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-03: Dial Analyze Extension Table

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-03 (Dial Analyze Extension Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 03

44-03-01Exp-TBL1 001:Dial=
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-03-xx Exp-TBLx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension Table Area number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 329 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-04: ARS/F-Route Selection for Time Schedule Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 44-04 : ARS/F-Route Selection for Time Schedule to assign each ARS/F-Route Selection number to an ARS/F-Route table number for each ARS/F-Route time mode. There are 8 time modes for ARS/F-Route Access.

Input Data
ARS/F-Route Selection Number 1-500

ARS/F-Route Time Mode 1-8

ARS/F-Route Table Number 0-500

Default 0

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-04 (ARS/F-Route Selection for Time Schedule): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 04

44-04-01SelNo1 F-RouteMode1=0
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-04-xxSelNoxxx xxxxx 4. Select the ARS/F-Route Selection number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 330 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-05: ARS/F-Route Table

Description
Use Program 44-05 : ARS/F-Route Table to set the ARS/F-Route table. There are 4 kinds of order. If the higher priority trunk groups are busy, the next order group will be used. If a lower priority route is selected, the caller may be notified with a beep tone.

Input Data
ARS/F-Route Table Number 1-500

Priority Number

1-4

Prog. No. 44-05-01

Item Trunk Group Number

Input Data 0 : (0 : No setting) 1-25 : Trunk Group Number 255 : (Extension Call) 0-255(0 : No setting, 255 : Delete All digits) 0-1000 0 : Off 1 : On 0-500 (0 : No setting) 0-500 (0 : No setting) 0-16 0-15

Default 0

Related Program

44-05-02 44-05-03 44-05-04 44-05-05 44-05-06 44-05-07 44-05-08

Delete Digits Additional Dial Number Beep Tone Gain Table Number for Internal Calls Gain Table Number for Tandem Connection ARS Class of Service Dial Treatment

0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

- 331 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-05: ARS/F-Route Table Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 44-05 (ARS/F-Route Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 05

IN SA SB

44-05-01FRout1 1:TRK Grp = 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-05-xxFRoutxxx xxxxx 4. Select the ARS/F-Route Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 332 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-06: Additional Dial Table

Description
Use Program 44-06 : Additional Dial Table to set the additional dial table to add prior to the dialed ARS/F-Route number.

Input Data
Additional Dial Table Number 1-1000 Additional Dial Up to 36 digits(0-9,*,#,Pause) Default No setting Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-06(Additional Dial Table): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 06

44-06-01 Add1 Dial


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-06-xx Addxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Additional Dial Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 333 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-07: Gain Table for F-Route Access Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 44-07 : Gain Table for ARS/F-Route Access to set the PAD table. If an extension dials ARS/F-Route number; The Extension Dial Gain Table is activated, which is assigned in Program 44-05. The Extension Dial Gain Table follows Outgoing transmit and Outgoing receive settings. If the incoming call is transferred to another line using ARS/F-Route; The Tandem Gain Table is activated, which is assigned in Program 44-05. The Tandem Gain Table follows the Incoming transmit and Incoming receive settings for incoming line, and Outgoing transmit and Outgoing receive settings for the outgoing line.
Note: For the ARS/F-Route call (in the above case), CODEC gain in Program 14-01-02 and 14-01-03 are not

activated

Input Data
Gain Table Number 1-500

Prog. No. 44-07-01 44-07-02 44-07-03 44-07-04

Item Incoming Transmit Incoming Receive Outgoing Transmit Outgoing Receive

Input Data 1-63 (-15.5..+15.5) 1-63 (-15.5..+15.5) 1-63 (-15.5..+15.5) 1-63 (-15.5..+15.5)

Default 32(0dB) 32(0dB) 32(0dB) 32(0dB)

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Programming Manual

- 334 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-07: Gain Table for F-Route Service

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-07(Gain Table for ARS/F-Route Access): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 07

44-07-01 Gain1 INC Transmit 32


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-07-xx Gainxx xxxxx 4. Select the Gain Table number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 335 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-08: Time Schedule for ARS/F-Route Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 44-08 : Time Schedule for ARS/F-Route to define the daily pattern of the ARS/F-Route feature. ARS/F-Route has 10 time patterns. These patterns are used in Program 44-09 and 44-10. The daily pattern consists of 20 time settings.

Input Data
Schedule Pattern Number 01-10

Time Number 01-20

Start Time 0000-2359

End Time 0000-2359

Mode 1-8

Default All Schedule Pattern : 0:00-0:00, Mode 1 Example 1: 0:00 Mode3 Midnight Time Pattern 1 8:00 Mode1 Day 18:00 Mode2 Night 22:00 0:00 Mode3 Midnight

To make the above schedule, it is necessary to set the data as follows: Time Setting 01 : 00:00 08:00 Mode 3 Time Setting 02 : 08:00 18:00 Mode 1 Time Setting 03 : 18:00 22:00 Mode 2 Time Setting 04 : 22:00 00:00 Mode 3

Example 2: 0:00

Time Pattern 2 0:00 Mode2 Night

To make the above schedule, it is necessary to set the data as follows: Time Setting 01 : 00:00 00:00 Mode 2

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Programming Manual

- 336 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-08: Time Schedule for ARS/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-08(Time Schedule for ARS/F-Route): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 08

44-08-01TimPtn1 01:Start =00:00


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-08-xxTimPtnxx xxxxx 4. Select the Schedule Pattern number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 337 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-09: Weekly Schedule for ARS/F-Route Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 44-09 : Weekly Schedule for ARS/F-Route to define a weekly schedule for using ARS/F-Route.

Input Data
Day Number 1 : Sunday 2 : Monday 3 : Tuesday 4 : Wednesday 5 : Thursday 6 : Friday 7 : Saturday 1-10 Pattern 1 44-08 Schedule Pattern Number Default Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-09(Weekly Schedule for ARS/F-Route): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 09

44-09-01 SUN Pattern=1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-09-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 338 -

IN SA SB

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup


44-10: Holiday Schedule for ARS/F-Route

Description
Use Program 44-10 : Holiday Schedule for ARS/F-Route to define a yearly schedule for ARS/F-Route. This schedule is used for setting special days such as national holidays.

Input Data
Date 0101-1231 Schedule Pattern Number 0-10 (0 : No setting) Default No setting Related Program 44-08

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Automatic Route Selection(ARS)/F-Route

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 44-10(Holiday Schedule for ARS/F-Route): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 44 10

44-10-01 Date01/01=PTTN0
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

44-10-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 339 -

Programming Manual

Program 44: ARS/F-Route Setup

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 340 -

IN SA SB

Program 45: Voice Mail Integration


45-01: Voice Mail Integration Options

Description
Use Program 45-01 :Voice Mail Integration Options to customize certain voice mail integration options.

Input Data
Prog. No. 45-01-01 Item Voice Mail Department Group Number Assign which Extension (Department) Group number is to be assigned as the voice mail group. Voice Mail Master Name Enter the Voice Mail master name. Voice Mail Screening Enable/disable the systems ability to process the Call Screening commands (1 + extension number) sent from the Voice Mail. You should normally enable this option to allow for Voice Mail Call Screening. Disable this option if your system has been modified so that extensions begin with the digit 1 (e.g., 101, 102, etc.). Also see the Flexible System Numbering feature. Park and Page Enable/disable the systems ability to process the Voice Mails Park and Page (*) commands. You should normally enable this option. Message Wait Enable/disable the systems ability to process the Voice Mails Message Wait (#) commands. You should normally enable this option. If enabled, be sure that the programmed Message Notification strings dont contain the code #9 for trunk access. Record Alert Tone Interval Time This timer sets the interval between voice Mail Conversation Record alerts -Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedInput Data 0-32 (0 : No Voice Mail) Default 0 Related Program

45-01-02 45-01-03

Up to 8 characters 0 : Off 1 : On

V.M. 1

45-01-04

0 : Off 1 : On

45-01-05

0 : Off 1 : On

45-01-06

0-64800 (sec.)

30

45-01-07 45-01-08 45-01-09

Conditions None

- 341 -

Programming Manual

Program 45: Voice Mail Integration


45-01: Voice Mail Integration Options Feature Cross Reference
Voice Mail (In-skin)

IN SA SB

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 45-01 (Voice mail Integration Options): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 45 01

45-01-01 STG No. of VM 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

45-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 342 -

IN SA SB

Program 45: Voice Mail Integration


45-02: NSL Option Setup

Description
Use Program 45-02 : NSL Option Setup to customize the NSL options for Voice Mail integration.

Input Data
Prog. No. 45-02-01 Item Send DTMF tone or 6KD Message Input Data 0 : Sending DTMF tone to SLT-VM port 1 : Sending 6KD Message to Serial Port 0 : Normal 1 : Forced 0 : Off 1 : On Default 0 Related Program

45-02-02 45-02-03

Forced Send Dial Tone Send 5IA Message

0 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (In-skin)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 45-02 (NSL Option Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 45 02

45-02-01 DTMF/6KD Msg.0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

45-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 343 -

Programming Manual

Program 45: Voice Mail Integration


45-03 NSL Timer Setup Description
Use Program 45-03 : NSL Timer Setup to customize the NSL timers for Voice Mail integration.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 45-03-01 45-03-02 45-03-03 45-03-04 45-03-05 45-03-06 45-03-07 Retry Timer Polling Interval ILS(Link Start Message) Interval Wait for ILS Time Wait for 2ET Time Restart LVP Check Interval Wait for ILR Time Item Input Data 0-64800 (sec.) 0-64800 (sec.) 0-64800 (sec.) 0-64800 (sec.) 0-64800 (sec.) 0-64800 (sec.) 0-64800 (sec.) Default 4 20 20 30 60 30 20 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Voice Mail (In-skin)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 45-03 (NSL Timer Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 45 03

45-03-01 Retry Timer 4


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

45-03-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 344 -

IN SA SB

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01: Service Tone Setup

Description
Use Program 80-01 : Service Tone Setup to define up to 64 Service Tones. Each service tone is defined by the combination of 32 Basic Tones.

Input Data
Service Tone Number 01-64

Prog. No. 80-01-01 Repeat Count

Item

Input Data 0-255 (0 : Endless)

Related Program

Unit Number

1-8

Prog. No. 80-01-02 80-01-03 80-01-04 *Basic Tone Basic Tone Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16

Item Basic Tone Number* Duration Count Gain level(dB)

Input Data 0-33 (0 : No Tone, 33: Default Time Slot) 1-255 (100-25500ms) 1-63 (-15.5..+15.5dB)

Related Program

Frequency (Hz) 420 520 580 660 700 800 880 1050 430 440/480 480/620 440 -Reserve520/650 650/780 780/1040

Level(dB) -13 -13 -13 -13 -13 -13 -13 -13 -13 -13/-13 -13/-13 -16 -19/-13 -19/-13 -19/-13

Basic Tone Number 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32

Frequency (Hz) 520/650 650/780 780/1040 1040 -Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-Reserve-

Level(dB) -13/-19 -13/-19 -13/-19 -13 -

- 345 -

Programming Manual

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01: Service Tone Setup
Default
Service Tone No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 Service Tone No Tone Internal Dial Tone Special Dial Tone Internal Recall Dial Tone Trunk Dial Tone Busy Tone DND Busy Tone B-busy tone Internal Reorder Tone Internal Interrupt Tone Internal Confirmation Tone Internal Hold Tone External Hold Tone Ring-Back Tone Override Tone Lock-out Tone Repeat Count 0 0 0 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 Unit Count 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 0 0 2 2 2 Basic Tone No. 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 6 0 0 3 0 0 6 0 6 6 0 6 0 0 4 4 2 2 2 0 7 7 5 5 5 0 Duration 10 2 3 1 9 1 2 10 5 5 2 2 5 5 5 5 1 1 5 1 0 0 10 20 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 7 0 2 2 3 4 6 5 2 2 3 4 6 5

IN SA SB
Gain Level (dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 26(-3 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 14(-9 dB) 32(0 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 14(-9 dB) 32(0 dB)

17 18

Clock alarm Tone BGM

0 0

4 0

19

Door Box Chime 1

20

Door Box Chime 2

Programming Manual

- 346 -

IN SA SB

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01: Service Tone Setup

Default(Contd
Service Tone No. Service Tone Repeat Count Unit Count Basic Tone No. 8 8 6 6 6 0 4 4 2 2 2 0 7 7 5 5 5 0 8 8 6 6 6 0 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 6 10 0 0 11 Duration 2 2 3 4 6 5 1 1 2 2 3 2 1 1 2 2 3 2 1 1 2 2 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 10 30 2 3 Gain Level (dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 14(-9 dB) 32(0 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 14(-9 dB) 32(0 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 14(-9 dB) 32(0 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 38(+3 dB) 26(-3 dB) 14(-9 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)

21

Door Box Chime 3

22

Door Box Chime 4

23

Door Box Chime 5

24

Door Box Chime 6

25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37

Service Set Tone Service Clear Tone Talk-back Tone Speaker Monitor Tone Door Relay Tone Door Box Call Tone Paging Tone Splash Tone 1 Splash Tone 2 Splash Tone 3 1 Sec Signal Tone External Audible Ring Tone External Re-order Tone

1 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 2 3 1 0 0

2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2

- 347 -

Programming Manual

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01: Service Tone Setup
Default(Contd
Service Tone No. 38 Service Tone External Busy Tone Repeat Count 0 Unit Count 2 Basic Tone No. 0 11 0 11 0 11 10 0 6 2 2 0 1 2 10 0 10 0 11 0 11 0 1 0 10 12 0 12 4 12 12 0 6 2 0 2 0 2 0 Duration 5 5 5 5 5 5 10 20 1 8 8 0 1 1 4 2 4 30 5 5 0 1 2 0 10 2 30 3 2 3 10 0 10 8 2 1 1 1 20

IN SA SB

39

Special Audible Ring-Busy Tone

Gain Level (dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32(0 dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 32 (0dB)

40 41 42 43 44

Internal Call Waiting Tone (Transfer, Call Waiting Tone) Intrusion Tone Conference Tone Intrusion Tone 2 External Dial Tone (DUD,DISA Dial Tone) External Ring Back Tone (Ring Tone DDI)

1 1 1 0 0

1 1 1 0 2

45

46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56

External Busy Tone (Busy Tone DDI) Number unobtainable tone VM message indication tone - Not Used External special audible ring tone External intercept tone External call waiting tone External executive override tone - Not UsedGenerate tone for TAPI2.1 Warning Beep Tone Signaling Headset Ear Piece Ringing Tone

0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1

2 1 2 0 3 2 1 1 0 1 1

57

Programming Manual

- 348 -

IN SA SB

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01: Service Tone Setup

Default(Contd
Service Tone No. Service Tone Opening Chime tone Repeat Count Unit Count Basic Tone No. 2 2 14 14 15 15 16 16 20 20 19 19 18 18 17 17 0 6 0 6 0 6 3 0 0 Duration 2 2 2 2 2 2 6 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 6 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 20 0 Gain Level (dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 8 (-12dB) 32 (0dB) 8 (-12dB) 32 (0dB) 8 (-12dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)

58

Ending Chime tone

59

60 61 62 63 64

Splash tone 1(Mute) Splash tone 2(Mute) Splash tone 3(Mute) External Speaker Ring-back Tone - Not Used -

1 2 3 0 0

2 2 2 2 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Selectable Ring Tones

- 349 -

Programming Manual

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-01: Service Tone Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 80-01(Service Tone Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 80 01

IN SA SB

80-01-01 Tone1 Repeat Count 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

80-01-xx Tonexx xxxxx 4. Select the Service Tone number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 350 -

MF SA SB

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-02: DTMF Tone Setup

Description
Use Program 80-02 : DTMF Tone Setup to define the duration (on time) and pause (off time) for DTMF dialing. This option affects all trunk line calls system wide. You make separate entries for duration and pause. It is also possible to adjust the level of both high and low frequency tone.

Input Data
Prog. No. 80-02-01 80-02-02 80-02-03 80-02-04 Duration Pause Tone Level (Low Group) Tone Level (High Group) Item Input Data 1-255 1-255 1-97(-45.0..+3) 1-97(-45.0..+3) Default 5 (100ms) 5 (100ms) 73 (-9dB) 77 (-7dB) Related Program

Duration

Pause

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 80-02(DTMF Tone Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 80 02

80-02-01 Duration Time 5


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

80-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 351 -

Programming Manual

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-03: DTMF Tone Receiver Setup Description

MF SA SB

Use Program 80-03 : DTMF Tone Receiver Setup to define the various levels and timers for the DTMF Tone Receiver

Input Data
DTMF Tone Receiver Type Number 1 : DTMF Receiver for Extension 2 : DTMF Receiver for Trunk 3,4,5 : -ReserveRelated Program

Prog. No. 80-03-01 Detect Level

Item

Input Data 0 : 0dBm....-25dBm 1 : - 5dBm-30dBm 2 : -10dBm-35dBm 3 : -15dBm-40dBm 4 : -20dBm-45dBm 5 : -25dBm-50dBm 6 : -30dBm-55dBm 0-255 (0.25ms 64ms) 0-15 detect level 0 : 10dBm(0) to 25dBm(15) detect level 1 : 15dBm(0) to 30dBm(15) detect level 2 : 20dBm(0) to 35dBm(15) detect level 3 : 25dBm(0) to 40dBm(15) detect level 4 : 30dBm(0) to 45dBm(15) detect level 5 : 35dBm(0) to 50dBm(15) detect level 6 : 40dBm(0) to 55dBm(15) 0-15 detect level 0 : 0dBm(0) to 15dBm(15) detect level 1 : 5dBm(0) to 20dBm(15) detect level 2 : 10dBm(0) to 25dBm(15) detect level 3 : 15dBm(0) to 30dBm(15) detect level 4 : 20dBm(0) to 35dBm(15) detect level 5 : 25dBm(0) to 40dBm(15) detect level 6 : 30dBm(0) to 45dBm(15) 0-9 (1dB10dB) 0-9 (1dB10dB) 1-255 (15+ 15ms3825ms) 1-255 (15+ 15ms3825ms)

80-03-02 80-03-03

Start delay time Min. detect level

80-03-04

Max. detect level

80-03-05 80-03-06 80-03-07 80-03-08

Forward twist level Backward twist level ON detect time OFF detect time

Programming Manual

- 352 -

MF SA SB
Default
Prog. No. 80-03-01 80-03-02 80-03-03 80-03-04 80-03-05 80-03-06 80-03-07 80-03-08

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-03: DTMF Tone Receiver Setup
Item Detect Level Start delay time Min. detect level Max. detect level Forward twist level Backward twist level ON detect time OFF detect time Type 1 0 0 10(-20dBm) 2 (-2dBm) 5 (6dBm) 0 (1dBm) 1 (30ms) 1 (30ms) Type 2 0 0 15(-25dBm) 2 (-2dBm) 5 (6dBm) 0 (1dBm) 1 (30ms) 1 (30ms) Type 3 0 0 10(-20dBm) 2 (-2dBm) 5 (6dBm) 0 (1dBm) 1 (30ms) 1 (30ms) Type 4 0 0 10(-20dBm) 2 (-2dBm) 5 (6dBm) 0 (1dBm) 1 (30ms) 1 (30ms) Type 5 0 0 10(-20dBm) 2 (-2dBm) 5 (6dBm) 0 (1dBm) 1 (30ms) 1 (30ms)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 80-03(DTMF Tone Detector Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 80 03

80-03-01DTMF Re Detect Level 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

80-03-xxDTMF Rex xxxxx 4. Select the DTMF Tone Receiver Type number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 353 -

Programming Manual

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-04: Call Progress Tone Detector Setup Description

MF SA SB

Use Program 80-04 : Call Progress Tone Detector Setup to define the various levels and timers for the Call Progress Tone Detector.

Input Data
Tone Detector Type Number 1 : Dial Tone for Trunk 2 : Busy Tone for Trunk 3 : Ring Back Tone for Trunk 4,5 : -ReserveRelated Program

Prog. No. 80-04-01 Detect Level

Item

Input Data 0 : 0dBm-25dBm 1 : -5dBm-30dBm 2 : -10dBm-35dBm 3 : -15dBm-40dBm 4 : -20dBm-45dBm 5 : -25dBm-50dBm 6 : -30dBm-55dBm 0-15 detect level 0 : 10dBm(0) detect level 1 : 15dBm(0) detect level 2 : 20dBm(0) detect level 3 : 25dBm(0) detect level 4 : 30dBm(0) detect level 5 : 35dBm(0) detect level 6 : 40dBm(0) 0-4 (0dB-20dB) 0-255 (30+30-7650ms) (0 : No detection) 1-255 1-255 (30+30-7650ms) 0-255 (30+30-7650ms) (0 : No detection) 1-255 (30+30-7650ms) 0-255 (30+30-7650ms) (0 : No detection) 0-8 0-8

80-04-02

Min. detect level

to 25dBm(15) to 30dBm(15) to 35dBm(15) to 40dBm(15) to 45dBm(15) to 50dBm(15) to 55dBm(15)

80-04-03 80-04-04 80-04-05 80-04-06 80-04-07 80-04-08 80-04-09 80-04-10 80-04-11

S/N ratio No tone time Pulse Count ON min. time ON max. time OFF min. time OFF max. time -- Reserve --- Reserve --

Programming Manual

- 354 -

MF SA SB
Default
Prog. No. 80-04-01 80-04-02 80-04-03 80-04-04 80-04-05 80-04-06 80-04-07 80-04-08 80-04-09 80-04-10 80-04-11

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-04: Call Progress Tone Detector Setup
Item Detect Level Min. detect level S/N ratio No tone time Pulse Count ON min. time ON max. time OFF min. time OFF max. time -- Reserve --- Reserve -Type 1(DT) Type 2(BT) Type 3(RBT) Type 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Type 5 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

0 (0..-25dBm) 0 (0..-25dBm) 0 (0..-25dBm) 15 (-25dBm) 4 (-20dB) 15 (-25dBm) 4 (-20dB) 15 (-25dBm) 4 (-20dB)

132 (3990ms) 132 (3990ms) 132 (3990ms) 1 63 (1920ms) 0 (No detect) 1 (60ms) 1 (60ms) 1 0 1 12 (390ms) 20 (630ms) 12 (390ms) 20 (630ms) 1 0 1 25 (780ms) 40 (1230ms) 52 (1590ms) 80 (2430ms) 1 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 80-04(Call Progress Tone Detector Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 80 04

80-04-01ToneRcv1 Detect Level 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

80-04-xxToneRcvx xxxxx 4. Select the Tone Detector Type number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 355 -

Programming Manual

Program 80: Basic Hardware Setup for System


80-05: Data Format for SMDR and System Reports Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 80-05 : Date Format for SMDR and System Reports to define the date format when printing out the SMDR, alarm report, system information report, etc.

Input Data
Data Format 0 : American Format (Month / Date / Year) 1 : Japanese Format (Year / Month / Date) 2 : European Format (Date/Month/Year) Default 2

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Station Message Detail Recording Time and Date

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 80-05(Data Format for SMDR and System Reports): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 80 05

80-05-01 Data Format

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

80-05-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 356 -

IN
SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-01: Analogue Trunk Initial Data Setup

Description
Use Program 81-01 : Analogue Trunk Initial Data Setup to define the various basic timers for the Trunk Interface of 308M/308E cards.

Input Data
Prog. No. 81-01-01 81-01-02 81-01-03 81-01-04 81-01-05 81-01-06 81-01-07 81-01-08 81-01-09 81-01-10 81-01-11 81-01-12 81-01-13 81-01-14 Item Companding method type Loop Current Detection Time Clear Signal (Open Loop)Detection Time Ring Signal Detection Min. Time Single Ringing Detection Min. Time Double Ringing Detection Min. Off Time Double Ringing Detection Max. Off Time Ringing Signal Not Detection Minimum Time Ringing Signal Stop Detection Time Continuous Ringing Minimum Time Continuous Ringing Maximum Time AC Impedance Timer Grounding Time Flash (Hooking 1) This sets the flash (Hooking 1) duration for analogue trunk calls. See Program 14-02-04. Flash (Hooking 2) This sets the flash (Hooking 2) duration for analogue trunk calls. See Program 14-02-04. Pause Time PFT Idle Detection Time Grounding Start Time Grounding Start Give-up Time Loop Reverse Detect Min. Time Loop Reverse Detect Max. Time Loop Disconnect Detect Min. Time Loop Disconnect Detect Max. Time On Hook Normal Detect Time On Hook Reverse Detect Time On Hook Disconnect Detect Time Input Data 0 : -law 1 : A-law 1-255(8-2040ms) 1-255(8-2040ms) 1-255(8-2040ms) 0-255(0,8-2040ms) 0-255 (0,8-2040mS) 0-255 (0,8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (64-16320mS) 0-255 (0,8-2040mS) 0-255 (0,8-2040mS) 1-255 (64-16320mS) 1-255 (16-4080mS) 1-255 (16-4080mS) Default 1(A-law) 75(600ms) 37(296ms) 13(104ms) 82(656ms) 13 (104ms) 50 (400ms) 88 (704ms) 47(3080ms) 38(304ms) 88(704ms) 4 (256ms) 9 (144ms) 50 (800ms)

81-01-15

1-255 (16-4080mS) 1-255(64-16320mS) 1-255(64-16320mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (64-16320mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (16-4080mS)

156(2496ms) 47(3008ms) 47(3008ms) 6 (48ms) 47 (3008ms) 13 (104ms) 107 (856ms) 63(504ms) 87(696ms) 3(24ms) 2 (16ms) 188 (3008ms)

81-01-16 81-01-17 81-01-18 81-01-19 81-01-20 81-01-21 81-01-22 81-01-23 81-01-24 81-01-25 81-01-26

- 357 -

Programming Manual

Program 81:
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 81-01-27 81-01-28 81-01-29 81-01-30 81-01-31 81-01-32 81-01-33 81-01-34 81-01-35

Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk 81-01: Analogue Trunk Initial Data Setup
Item Pulse Dial Break Time (10pps) Pulse Dial Make Time (10pps) Inter-digit Time (10pps) Pulse Dial Break Time (20pps) Pulse Dial Make Time (20pps) Inter-digit Time (20pps) Charging Pulse Minimum Duration Time Charging Pulse Minimum Period Time Charging Pulse Minimum Interval Time Input Data 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (32-8160mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (32-8160mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS) 1-255 (8-2040mS)

IN SA SB
Default 13(104ms) 7(56ms) 19(608ms) 6(48ms) 4 (32ms) 16 (512ms) 9 (72ms) 29 (232ms) 6 (48ms)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Placing

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 81-01 (Analogue Trunk Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 01

81-01-01 Compand'n Type0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 358 -

IN
SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-02: DIOPU Initial Data Setup

Description
Use Program 81-02 : DIOPU Initial Data Setup to define the various basic timers for the DIOPU cards.

Input Data
Prog. No. 81-02-01 81-02-02 81-02-03 81-02-04 81-02-05 81-02-06 81-02-07 81-02-08 81-02-09 81-02-10 81-02-11 81-02-12 81-02-13 81-02-14 81-02-15 81-02-16 81-02-17 81-02-18 81-02-19 81-02-20 81-02-21 81-02-22 81-02-23 Item Companding method type Answer Signal Time Clear Signal (Open Loop)Detection Min. Time Ring Signal Detection Min. Time Hook Flash Time Pause Time Wink/Delay Duration Time Incoming- Wink/Delay send Time Seizure-Wink/Delay Receive Max. Time Receive Wink/Delay Duration Min. Time Receive Wink/Delay Duration Max. Time Receive DP Make Min. Time Receive DP Make Max. Time Receive DP Break Min. Time Receive DP Break Max. Time Receive DP Inter-Digit Time Loop Off Guard Time DP Break Time (10pps) DP Make Time (10pps) DP Inter-Digit Time (10pps) DP Break Time (20pps) DP Make Time (20pps) DP Inter-Digit Time (20pps) Input Data 0 : -law 1 : A-law 1-255(10-2550ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(10-2550ms) 1-255(8-2040ms) 1-255(32-8160ms) 1-255(10-2550ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(10-2550ms) 1-255(10-2550ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(32-8160ms) 0-255(0,100-25500ms) 1-255(4-1020ms) 1-255(4-1020ms) 1-255(16-4080ms) 1-255(4-1020ms) 1-255(4-1020ms) 1-255(16-4080ms) Default 1(A-law) 6(60ms) 7(700ms) 10(100ms) 25(200ms) 94(3008ms). 20(200ms) 3(300ms) 48(4800ms) 13(130ms) 31(310ms) 5(10ms) 50(100ms) 5(10ms) 50(100ms) 6(192ms) 20(2000ms) 16(64ms) 8(32ms) 38(608ms) 8(32ms) 4(16ms) 29(464ms)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Central Office Calls, Placing

- 359 -

Programming Manual

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-02: DIOPU Initial Data Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 81-02 (DIOPU Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 02

IN
SA SB

81-02-01 Compand'n Type0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 360 -

IN SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-03: TLIU Initial Data Setup

Description
Use Program 81-03 : TLIU Initial Data Setup to define the various basic timers for the E&M tie line PCB.

Input Data
Prog. No. 81-03-01 81-03-02 81-03-03 81-03-04 81-03-05 81-03-06 81-03-07 81-03-08 81-03-09 81-03-10 81-03-11 81-03-12 81-03-13 81-03-14 81-03-15 81-03-16 81-03-17 81-03-18 81-03-19 81-03-20 81-03-21 81-03-22 81-03-23 81-03-24 Item Companding method type Answer Signal Time Clear Signal (Open Loop)Detection Min. Time Ring Signal Detection Min. Time Ring Signal Stop Detection Time Hook Flash Time Pause Time Wink/Delay Duration Time Incoming- Wink/Delay send Time Seizure-Wink/Delay Receive Max. Time Receive Wink/Delay Duration Min. Time Receive Wink/Delay Duration Max. Time Receive DP Make Min. Time Receive DP Make Max. Time Receive DP Break Min. Time Receive DP Break Max. Time Receive DP Inter-Digit Time Loop Off Guard Time DP Break Time (10pps) DP Make Time (10pps) DP Inter-Digit Time (10pps) DP Break Time (20pps) DP Make Time (20pps) DP Inter-Digit Time (20pps) Input Data 0 : -law 1 : A-law 1-255(10-1020ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(10-20240ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(10-20240ms) 1-255(60-15300ms) 1-255(10-20240ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(10-20240ms) 1-255(10-20240ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(8-2040ms) 0-255(0,100-25500ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(2-510ms) 1-255(32-8160ms) 1-255(2-512ms) 1-255(2-512ms) 1-255(32-8160ms) Default 1(A-law) 6(60ms) 7(700ms) 10(100ms) 7(700ms) 20(200ms) 50(3000ms). 20(200ms) 3(300ms) 48(4800ms) 13(130ms) 31(310ms) 5(10ms) 50(100ms) 5(10ms) 50(100ms) 13(104ms) 20(2000ms) 32(64ms) 16(32ms) 19(608ms) 16(32ms) 8(16ms) 16(512ms)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Tie Lines - 361 Programming Manual

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-03: TLIU Initial Data Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 81-03 (TLIU Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 03

IN SA SB

81-03-01 Compandn Type0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-03-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 362 -

MF
SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-04: ISDN BRI Layer 1(T-Point) Initial Data Setup

Description
Use Program 81-04 : ISDN BRI Layer 1 (T-Point) Initial Data Setup to define the various basic options for layer- 1 of ISDN BRI.

Input Data
Prog. No. 81-04-01 81-04-02 Item Waiting Time for Physical Activation (Timer 3) Detection Time for Physical Deactivation Input Data 1-255(200-5100ms) 1-255(200-5100ms) Default 100(20 sec.) 5(1 sec.)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 81-04 (ISDN BRI Layer 1(T-Point) Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 04

81-04-01 Physical Act 100


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 363 -

Programming Manual

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-05: ISDN BRI Layer 2(T-Point) Initial Data Setup Description

MF
SA SB

Use Program 81-05 : ISDN BRI Layer 2 (T-Point) Initial Data Setup to define the various basic options for layer- 2 of ISDN BRI.

Input Data
Prog. No. 81-05-01 81-05-02 81-05-03 81-05-04 81-05-05 81-05-16 81-05-07 Timer T200 Timer T201 Timer T202 Timer T203 N200 N201 N202 Item Input Data 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255 1-65535(Byte) 1-255 Default 10(1 sec.) 10(1 sec.) 20(2 sec.) 250(25 sec.) 3 260 3

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 81-05 (ISDN BRI Layer 2(T-Point) Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 05

81-05-01 Timer T200

10

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-05-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 364 -

IN
SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-06: ISDN BRI Layer 3(T-Point) Timer Setup

Description
Use Program 81-06 : ISDN BRI Layer 3(T-Point) Timer Setup to define the various basic options for layer- 3 of ISDN BRI.

Input Data
Layer 3 Timer Type Number 1-5

Prog. No. 81-06-01 81-06-02 81-06-03 81-06-04 81-06-05 81-06-06 81-06-07 81-06-08 81-06-09 81-06-10 81-06-11 81-06-12 81-06-13 81-06-14 81-06-15 81-06-16 81-06-17 81-06-18 81-06-19 81-06-20 T301 T302 T303 T304 T305 T306 T307 T308 T309 T310 T312 T313 T314 T316 T317 T318 T319 T320 T321 T322

Item

Input Data 0,180-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 0-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 0-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 0-180(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) ( T317+1 )-254(sec) 1-( T316-1 ) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec)

Default 180(sec) 15(sec) 4(sec) 30(sec) 30(sec) 30(sec) 180(sec) 4(sec) 90(sec) 180(sec) 6(sec) 4(sec) 4(sec) 120(sec) 60(sec) 4(sec) 4(sec) 30(sec) 30(sec) 4(sec)

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

- 365 -

Programming Manual

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-06: ISDN BRI Layer 3(T-Point) Initial Data Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 81-06 (ISDN BRI Layer 3(T-Point) Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 06

IN
SA SB

81-06-01L3Timer1 T301 180


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-06-xxL3Timerx xxxxx 4. Select the Layer 3 Timer type number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 366 -

IN SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-07: CODEC Filter Setup for Analogue Trunk Ports

Description
Use Program 81-07 : CODEC Filter Setup for Analogue Trunk Ports to define the CODEC (QSLAC) Filter for each analogue trunk port(308M/308E).

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51

CODEC Filter Type 0 : No filter 1 : 0 dB Loss 2 : 4 dB Loss 3 : 8 dB Loss 4 : Specified Data

Default

Related Program

81-09

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 81-07 (CODEC Filter Setup for Analogue Trunk Ports): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 07

81-07-01 Trunk1 CODEC Filter 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-07-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 367 -

Programming Manual

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-09: Analogue Trunk CODEC Filter Setup Description

IN
SA SB

Use Program 81-09 : Analogue Trunk CODEC Filter Setup to define the CODEC (QSLAC) Filter data for each analogue Trunk Interface(308M/308E card). This setting is applied when CODEC filter type4 (Specified Data) is set in PRG81-07.

Input Data
Prog. No. 81-09-01 81-09-02 81-09-03 81-09-04 81-09-05 81-09-06 81-09-07 81-09-08 81-09-09 81-09-10 81-09-11 81-09-12 81-09-13 81-09-14 81-09-15 81-09-16 B1 Filter Setup(1) B1 Filter Setup(2) B1 Filter Setup(3) B1 Filter Setup(4) B1 Filter Setup(5) B1 Filter Setup(6) B1 Filter Setup(7) B1 Filter Setup(8) B1 Filter Setup(9) B1 Filter Setup(10) B1 Filter Setup(11) B1 Filter Setup(12) B1 Filter Setup(13) B1 Filter Setup(14) B2 Filter Setup(1) B2 Filter Setup(2) Item 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 Input Data Default 74 226 171 42 21 33 234 26 51 82 99 47 162 224 162 192

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Programming Manual

- 368 -

IN SA SB

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk


81-09: Analogue Trunk CODEC Filter Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 81-09 (Analogue Trunk CODEC Filter Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 81 09

81-09-01 B1 Filter(01)74
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

81-09-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Trunk port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 369 -

Programming Manual

Program 81: Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 370 -

IN
SA SB

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-01: Not Used

Description
This command is currently not available.

- 371 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-02: Key Telephone LED Pattern Setup Description
COPY

MF SA SB

Use Program 82-02 : Key Telephone LED Pattern Setup to set the five LED types (PRG82-02-01 to PRG82-02-05) for each state of the functions. A key telephone can show eight LED patterns. Refer to under LED patterns. This program defines the LED patterns on each function for a key telephone. After changed this commands, it requires for system reset.

Input Data
Prog. No. 82-02-01 Item Incoming Call from Trunk/Extension, Voice Call, Camp On / Callback, Follow Me (Source side), Monitor (Destination side), Call Forward (Destination side), Message Waiting (Destination side) Hold by other extension, Normal Hold Follow Me (Destination side), Monitor (Source side) Call Forward (Source side) Exclusive Hold, Message Waiting (Source side) Incoming Call on Trunk Key, Callback to Trunk Key I-use of Trunk Key Input Data Default Related Program

82-02-02

0-7

1 3 0 7

30-05

82-02-03 82-02-04 82-02-05

Programming Manual

- 372 -

MF
SA SB
Conditions None

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-02: Key Telephone LED Pattern Setup

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 82-02 (Key Telephone LED Pattern Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 82 01

82-02-01
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

82-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 373 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-03: Not Used Description
This command is currently not available.

IN
SA SB

Programming Manual

- 374 -

IN SA SB

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-04: Analogue Station Initial Data Setup

Description
Use Program 82-04 : Analogue Station Initial Data Setup to define the various basic timers for the 308M/308ME Card.

Input Data
Prog. No. 82-04-01 82-04-02 82-04-03 82-04-04 82-04-05 82-04-06 82-04-07 82-04-08 82-04-09 82-04-10 82-04-11 82-04-12 82-04-13 82-04-14 Item Companding method type Ringing frequency Maximum Break Time Minimum Break Time Minimum Make Time Maximum Make Time Maximum Hook Flash Time Minimum Hook Flash Time Minimum Ground Flash Time Maximum Off-Hook Time No detection time after Off-Hook No detection time after pulse dial detection Loop disconnect time, Reversal time Ring, Message wait period time Input Data 0 : -law 1 : A-law 0 : 25Hz 1 : 20Hz 2 : 16Hz 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) 1-255(5ms-1275ms) Default 1 (A-law) 0 (25Hz) 2 (10ms) 20 (100ms) 2 (10ms) 20 (100ms) 21 (105ms) 200 (1000ms) 21 (105ms) 21 (105ms) 60 (300ms) 70 (350ms) 60 (300ms) 150 (750ms) Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

- 375 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-04: Analogue Station Initial Data Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 82-04 (Analogue Station Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 82 04

IN
SA SB

82-04-01 Compandn type 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

82-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 376 -

MF
SA SB

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-05: ISDN BRI Layer 2(S-Point) Initial Data Setup

Description
Use Program 82-05 : ISDN BRI Layer 2 (S-Point) Initial Data Setup to define the various basic options for the layer 2 of ISDN BRI S-Point.

Input Data
Prog. No. 82-05-01 82-05-02 82-05-03 82-05-04 82-05-05 82-05-06 82-05-07 Timer T200 Timer T201 Timer T202 Timer T203 N200 N201 N202 Item Input Data 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255(100-25500ms) 1-255 1-65535(Byte) 1-255 Default 10(1sec) 10(1sec) 20(1sec) 100(10sec) 3 260 3 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 82-05 (ISDN BRI Layer 2(S-Point) Initial Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 82 05

82-05-01 Timer T200

10

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

82-05-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 377 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-06: ISDN BRI Layer 3(S-Point) Timer Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 82-06 : ISDN BRI Layer 3 (S-Point) Timer Setup to define the various basic timers for the layer 3 of ISDN BRI S-Point.

Input Data
Layer 3 Timer Type Number 1-5

Prog. No. 82-06-01 82-06-02 82-06-03 82-06-04 82-06-05 82-06-06 82-06-07 82-06-08 82-06-09 82-06-10 82-06-11 82-06-12 82-06-13 82-06-14 82-06-15 82-06-16 82-06-17 82-06-18 82-06-19 82-06-20 T301 T302 T303 T304 T305 T306 T307 T308 T309 T310 T312 T313 T314 T316 T317 T318 T319 T320 T321 T322

Item

Input Data 0,180-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 0-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 0-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 0-180(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) ( T317+1 )-254(sec) 1-( T316-1 ) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec) 1-254(sec)

Default 180(sec) 10(sec) 4(sec) 20(sec) 30(sec) 30(sec) 180(sec) 4(sec) 90(sec) 30(sec) 6(sec) 4(sec) 4(sec) 120(sec) 60(sec) 4(sec) 4(sec) 30(sec) 30(sec) 4(sec)

Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


ISDN Compatibility

Programming Manual

- 378 -

IN SA SB

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-06: ISDN BRI Layer 3(S-Point) Timer Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 82-06 (ISDN BRI Layer 3(S-Point) Timer Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 82 06

82-06-01 T301 180


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

82-06-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 379 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-07: CODEC Filter Setup for Analogue Station Ports Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 82-07 : CODEC Filter Setup for Analogue Station Ports to define the CODEC (QSLAC) Filter for each analogue extension port. The CODEC filter operates according to a set value of PRG82-09 when CODEC filter type 4(Specified Data) is set in this setting.

Input Data
Extension Port Number 01-72

CODEC Filter Type 0 : No filter 1 : 0 dB Loss 2 : 4 dB Loss 3 : 8 dB Loss 4 : Specified Data

Default

Related Program

82-09

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 82-07 (CODEC Filter Setup for Analogue Station Ports): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 82 07

82-07-01Ex Prt1 CODEC Filter 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

82-07-xx Ex Prtxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension port number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 380 -

IN SA SB

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-08: Not Used

Description
This command is currently not available.

- 381 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-09: Analog Station CODEC Filter Data Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 82-09: Analogue Station CODEC Filter Data Setup to define the Analogue Station CODEC (QSLAC) Filter data. This setting is applied when CODEC filter type 4 (Specified Data) is set in PRG82-07.

Input Data
Prog. No. 82-09-01 82-09-02 82-09-03 82-09-04 82-09-05 82-09-06 82-09-07 82-09-08 82-09-09 82-09-10 82-09-11 82-09-12 82-09-13 82-09-14 82-09-15 82-09-16 Item B1 Filter Setup (1) B1 Filter Setup (2) B1 Filter Setup (3) B1 Filter Setup (4) B1 Filter Setup (5) B1 Filter Setup (6) B1 Filter Setup (7) B1 Filter Setup (8) B1 Filter Setup (9) B1 Filter Setup (10) B1 Filter Setup (11) B1 Filter Setup (12) B1 Filter Setup (13) B1 Filter Setup (14) B2 Filter Setup (1) B2 Filter Setup (2) 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 Input Data Default 42 111 53 171 206 235 189 194 126 168 122 183 34 112 188 1 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Programming Manual

- 382 -

IN SA SB

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension


82-09: Analog Station CODEC Filter Data Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 82-09 (Analogue Station CODEC Filter Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 82 09

82-09-01 B1 Filter(01)42
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

82-09-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 383 -

Programming Manual

Program 82: Basic Hardware Setup for Extension

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

- 384 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-01: CODEC Information Basic Setup

Description
Use Program 84-01 : CODEC Information Basic Setup to define the data of H.323.

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-01-01 84-01-02 84-01-03 - Not Used Number of G711 Audio Frame G.711 Silence Detection Mode Item 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : A-law 1 :-law 1 : 10ms 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 4 : 40ms 5 : 50ms 6 : 60ms 7 : 70ms 8 : 80ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms Input Data Default 3 0 Maximum number of G711 Audio Frame Define whether the silence detection enables on G711 or not Set the type of G711 (A-law or -law) Maximum number of G729 Audio Frame Description

84-01-04 84-01-05

G.711 Type G.729 Audio Frame

0 3

84-01-06 84-01-07 84-01-08 84-01-09 84-01-10 84-01-11 84-01-12 84-01-13 84-01-14 84-01-15

G.729 Voice Activity Detection Mode G.729 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (max.) - Not Used Number of G723 Audio Frame G.723 Voice Activity Detection Mode Maximum value of Jitter Delay - Not Used Jitter Buffer Mode

0 30 60 120 Set the minimum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer

1 : 30ms 2 : 60ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-65535ms 1 : static 2 : adaptive during silence 3 : adaptive immediately

1 0 60ms 3 Set the mode of Jitter Buffer Maximum number of G723 Audio Frame Maximum value of Jitter Delay for audio delay

- 383 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-01: CODEC Information Basic Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-01-16 84-01-17 84-01-18 84-01-19 84-01-20 84-01-21 84-01-22 Item G.711 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (max.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (max.) VAD threshold Input Data 0-145ms 0-145ms 0-145ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-30 (-20dB.+10dB) 0 : -20dB(-50dBm) 1 : -19dB(-49dBm) : 20 : 0 dB(-30dBm) : 29 : 9 dB(-21dBm) 30 : 10dB(-20dBm) 5000-7000 (-5000..-7000dBm) 5000 : -5000dBm : 7000 : -7000dBm 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 1 : 8ms 2 : 16ms 3 : 32ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 40-70 (-40 .-70) 40 : -40dBm : 70 : -70dBm 0adaptive 1fixed 0Disable 1Enable 0-28 (-14dbm..+14dbm) 0-14dBm 1-13dBm : 14 0dBm : 2713dBm 2814dBm Default 30 60 120 30 60 120 20 Description

IN SA SB

Set the minimum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the minimum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Threshold of silence detection Change Value based -30dBm Become invalid item if item 03 is set to Disable

84-01-23

Idle Noise Level

7000

Noise Level of Silence

84-01-24 84-01-25

Echo canceller mode Echo canceller tail size

1 3

Use Echo canceller or not Become invalid item if 24 is set to Disable Non-Linear processing mode Become invalid item if 26 is set to Disable

84-01-26 84-01-27

Echo canceller nlp mode

1 70

Echo canceller nlp noise

84-01-28 84-01-29 84-01-30

Echo canceller cng cfg Echo canceller 4w det TX Gain

0 0 10

Become invalid item if 26 is set to Disable

Programming Manual

- 384 -

IN SA SB
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-01-31 RX Gain

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-01: CODEC Information Basic Setup
Item Input Data 0-28 (-14dbm..+14dbm) 0-14dBm 1-13dBm : 14 0dBm : 2713dBm 2814dBm 0G711_PT 1G723_PT 2G729_PT 0 : Off 1 : On 0-65535 kbps 0: V.27ter, 2400bps 1: V.27ter, 4800bps 2: V.29, 7200 bps 3: V.29, 9600 bps 4: V.17, 12000 bps 5: V.17, 14400 bps 0-600 ms 20-48 bytes 0-13 (0-13dBm) 0 : -26dBm 1 : -33dBm 2 : -43dBm 10-32000 sec 0 : Open Channel defined packet encapsulation 1 : T.38 UDP 2 : T.38/RTP UDP 10-80 ms 0-8 0-2 1 : TCF is locally generated and checked 2 : TCF is sent over the network Default 10 Description

84-01-32 84-01-33

- Not used Audio Capability Priority

0 The option selected here determines what other options are applied from this program.

84-01-34 84-01-35 84-01-36

Band Control Mode Max Bandwidth Fax Max Rate

0 0 5

84-01-37 84-01-38 84-01-39 84-01-40

Fax Playout FIFO Nominal Delay Fax Packet Size Fax Modem Transmit Level Fax Modem CD Threshold Fax No activity Timeout duration Override Encapsulation Method

300ms 20 6(-6dBm) 1

84-01-41 84-01-42

30 1 In case of select T.38/RTP UDP, close-re-open is required for the change of voice-FAX.

84-01-43 84-01-44 84-01-45 84-01-46

High-speed Data Packet Rate Low speed data redundancy High speed data redundancy TCF handling method

60 0 0 1 For H.323 negotiation

- 385 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-01: CODEC Information Basic Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-01-47 84-01-48 84-01-49 84-01-50 84-01-51 84-01-52 84-01-53 84-01-54 84-01-55 84-01-56 84-01-57 84-01-58 84-01-59 84-01-60 84-01-61 Item Maximum low speed data packetization Transmit Network Timeout Eflag start timer Eflag stop timer Fax Relay: scan line fix up feature Fax Relay: Eflags for first DIS Fax Relay: FOP enhancement protocol Input Data 1-65535 bytes 10-32000 sec 0-65535ms 0-65535ms 0Disable 1Enable 0Disable 1Enable 0Disable 1Enable 0Disable 1Enable 0Disable 1Enable 0Disable 1Enable 0-65535 0-65535 0Disable 1Enable 0-3 0-5 Default 1 150sec 2600ms 2300ms 1 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Description

IN SA SB

Fax Relay: NSF override T30: ECM T30: MR page compression NSF country code NSF vendor code Fax Relay Function Echo Canceler config Type Auto Gain Control

Fax Relay : Invalid, when NSF override is Disable Fax Relay : Invalid, when NSF override is Disable

Set the type of Echo Canceller.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Programming Manual

- 386 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-01: CODEC Information Basic Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-01 (CODEC Information Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 01

84-01-02 G711 Aud Frame 3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 387 -

Programming Manual

Program 84:
Description

Hardware Setup for VoIP

84-02: H.225, H.245 Information Basic Setup

IN SA SB

Use Program 84-02 : H.225, H.245 Information Basic Setup to define the data of H.225 and H.245.

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-02-01 84-02-02 84-02-03 84-02-04 84-02-05 84-02-06 84-02-07 84-02-08 84-02-09 84-02-10 Item H.225 Alerting Timer H.225 setup Acknowledge Timer H.225 setup Timer H.225 Info Ack Timer H.225 Call Proceeding Timer - Not used H.245 master slave determination Timer H.245 master slave determination Retry Count H.245 capability exchange Timer H.245 logical channel establishment Timer H.245 moderequest procedures Timer H.245 close logical channel Timer H.245 round trip delay Timer H.245 maintenance loop RAS GRQ Timer GRQ Retry Count RAS RRQ Timer RRQ Retry Count RAS URQ Timer URQ Retry Count RAS ARQ Timer ARQ Retry Count RAS BRQ Timer BRQ Retry Count RAS IRR Timer Input Data 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 50 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 50 sec 50 sec 50 sec 50 sec 5 sec 2 5 sec 3 3 1 5 sec 2 5 sec 2 5 sec Default 180 sec 9 sec 4 sec 9 sec 10 sec 5 sec 3 sec 5 sec Unidirectional or bi-directional logical channel establishment timer Description

84-02-11 84-02-12 84-02-13 84-02-14 84-02-15 84-02-16 84-02-17 84-02-18 84-02-19 84-02-20 84-02-21 84-02-22 84-02-23 84-02-24 84-02-25

Programming Manual

- 388 -

IN SA SB
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-02-26 84-02-27 84-02-28 84-02-29 84-02-30 84-02-31 84-02-32 84-02-33 84-02-34 84-02-35 84-02-36 84-02-37

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-02: H.225, H.245 Information Basic Setup
Item IRR Retry Count RAS DRQ Timer DRQ Retry Count RAS LRQ Timer LRQ Retry Count Input Data 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-255 sec 0-255 0-65535 0:Disable 1:Enable 0-65535 0-255 Default 2 8 sec 2 5 sec 2 3 sec 2 1730 1 20001 60 H.245 Terminal type Description

RAS RAI Timer


RAI Retry Count Call Signaling Port Number - Not use Fast Start mode RAS Unicast Port Number Terminal Type

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-02 (H.225, H.245 Information Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 02

84-02-01 H225 AlertTM 180


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 389 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-04: VoIPU PCB DHCP Server Mode Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 84-04 : VoIPU PCB DHCP Server Mode Setup to define whether or not the DHCP Server on the VoIPU PCB is used.

Input Data
Item DHCP Server Mode Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Default 0 Description Define whether or not the DHCP Server is used.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-04 (VoIPU PCB DHCP Server Mode Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 04

84-04-01 DHCP Client 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 390 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-05: VoIPU IP Address Setup

Description
Use Program 84-05 : VoIPU IP Address Setup to define the IP Address of the VoIPU PCB.

Input Data
Slot Number 1-18

Prog. No. 84-05-01

Item IP Address

Input Data 0.0.0.1126.255.255.254 128.0.0.1191.255.255.254 192.0.0.1223.255.255.254

Default 172.16.0.20

Description Set IP Address of VoIPU PCB. IP Address will be increased in accordance with number of slot. NIC Auto Negotiation.

Related Program 84-04 ; This become invalid data if Program 84-04 is set to 0: Disable.

84-05-02

LAN

0: Auto Detect 1: 100Mbps, Full Duplex 2: 100Mbps, Half Duplex 3: 10Mbps, Full Duplex 4: 10Mbps, Half Duplex

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-05 (VoIPU IP Address Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 05

84-05-01 Slot1 172.16 .0 .20


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-05-xx Slotxx xxxxx 4. Select the Slot number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 391 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-06: VoIPU Setup Description
Use Program 84-06 : VoIPU Setup to setup the details of VoIPU PCB.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Slot Number 1-18

Prog. No. 84-06-01 84-06-02 84-06-03 84-06-04

Item RTP Port Number RTCP Port Number H.245 Port Number Fract lost threshhold

Input Data 0-65534 RTP Port Number +1 0-65535 0-4294967295

Default 10020 10021 10100 0

Description It has to be RTP Port Number + 1. The data will be sent to the Main-CPU if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the Main-CPU if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the Main-CPU if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the Main-CPU if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the Main-CPU if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the Main-CPU if the value exceeds the defined value.

84-06-05

Pkts Lost threshold

0-4294967295

84-06-06

Ext High Seq. threshold

0-4294967295

84-06-07

Jitter threshold

0-4294967295 (sec.)

84-06-08

Last SR threshold

0-4294967295 (sec.) 0-4294967295 (/65546 sec. ) 0 : DTMF Relay disabled 1 : In-Band DTMF relay, do NOT report to Host processor 2 : Out of Band DTMF relay, do not pass tones as voice 0-65535 0Off 1On 1...G.711/G.729AB 2...G.711/G.723.1 1...8ms 2...46ms 3...32ms 4...64ms 5...128ms

84-06-09

Delay LSR threshold DTMF behavior

84-06-10

84-06-11 84-06-12 84-06-13

Ready/Ready-Answer port Number Long Tail Echo Mode Long Tail Echo Codec Type Long Tail Echo Tail Size

4000 0 1 Set the CODEC type in Long Tail Echo Mode. It is effective when Item 12 is set to 1(On) Set the Echo Tail Size in Long Tail Echo Mode. It is effective when Item 12 is set to 1(On).

84-06-14

Programming Manual

- 392 -

IN SA SB
Conditions None

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-06: VoIPU Setup

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-06 (VoIPU Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 06

84-06-01 Slot 1 RTP Port 10020


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-05-xx Slotxx xxxxx 4. Select the Slot number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 393 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-09: VLAN Setup Description
Use Program 84-09 : VLAN Setup to setup the VLAN data.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-09-01 84-09-02 84-09-03 Item VLAN Mode VLAN ID Priority Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 1-4094 0-7 Default 0 1 0 Description

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-09 (VLAN Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 09

84-09-01 VLAN Mode

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-09-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 394 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-10: ToS Setup

Description
Use Program 84-10 : ToS Setup to setup the ToS data.

Input Data
1 : DRS 2 : Protims 3 : Voice Control 4 : H.323 5 : RTP_RTCP 6 : SIP

Protocol Type

Prog. No. 84-10-01 ToS Mode

Item

Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : IP Precedence 2 : Diffserve 0-7 0-1 0-1 0-1 0-1 0-63

Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Description

84-10-02 84-10-03 84-10-04 84-10-05 84-10-06 84-10-07

Priority (IP Precedence) Low Delay (IP Precedence) Wide Band (IP Precedence) High Reliability (IP Precedence) Low Cost (IP Precedence) Priority (Diffserve)

It is used when ToS mode is 1:IP Precedence at 84-10-01. It is used when ToS mode is 1:IP Precedence at 84-10-01. It is used when ToS mode is 1:IP Precedence at 84-10-01. It is used when ToS mode is 1:IP Precedence at 84-10-01. It is used when ToS mode is 1:IP Precedence at 84-10-01. It is used when ToS mode is 2:Diffserve at 84-10-01.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

- 395 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-10: ToS Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 84-10 (ToS Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 10

IN SA SB

84-10-01Protocl1 ToS Mode 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-10-xxProtoclx xxxxx 4. Select the Protocol Type number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 396 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-12: H.323 Phone CODEC Information Basic Setup

Description
Use Program 84-12 : H.323 Phone CODEC Information Basic Setup to define the data of H.323.

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-12-01 84-12-02 Item Number of G711 Audio Frame G.711 VAD Mode Input Data 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : A-law 1 : -law 0-145ms 0-145ms 0-145ms 2-8 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 4 : 40ms 5 : 50ms 6 : 60ms 7 : 70ms 8 : 80ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 1 : 30ms 2 : 60ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 1 : static 2 : adaptive during silence 3 : adaptive immediately Default 3 0 Description Maximum number of G711 Audio Frame Define whether the silence detection enables on G711 or not Set the type of G711 (A-law or -law) Set the minimum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Maximum Number of G.729 Audio Frame

84-12-03 84-12-04 84-12-05 84-12-06 84-12-07

G.711 Type G.711 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (max.) Number of G729 Audio Frame

0 30 60 120 3

84-12-08 84-12-09 84-12-10 84-12-11 84-12-12 84-12-13 84-12-14 84-12-15 84-12-16 84-12-17

G.729 VAD Mode G.729 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (max.) Number of G723 Audio Frame G.723 VAD Mode G.723 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (max.) Jitter Buffer Mode

0 30 60 120 1 0 30 60 120 3 Maximum number of G723 Audio Frame Set the minimum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the mode of Jitter Buffer Set the minimum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer

- 397 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-12: H.323 Phone CODEC Information Basic Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-12-18 Item VAD threshold Input Data 0-30 (-20dB.+10dB) 0 : -20dB(-50dBm) 1 : -19dB(-49dBm) : 20 : 0 dB(-30dBm) : 29 : 9 dB(-21dBm) 30 : 10dB(-20dBm) 5000-7000 (-5000..-7000dBm) 5000 : -5000dBm : 7000 : -7000dBm 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 1 : 8ms 2 : 16ms 3 : 32ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 40-70 (-40 .-70) 40 : -40dBm : 70 : -70dBm 0adaptive 1fixed 0Disable 1Enable 0-28 (-14dbm..+14dbm) 0-14dBm 1-13dBm : 14 0dBm : 2713dBm 2814dBm 0G711_PT 1G723_PT 2G729_PT 0 : Auto(Type 4 or Type 5) 1 : Type1 2 : Type2 3 : Type3 0-5 Default 20 Description

IN SA SB

Threshold of silence detection Change Value based -30 Become invalid item if item 03 is set to Disable

84-12-19

Idle Noise Level

7000

Noise Level of Silence

84-12-20 84-12-21

Echo canceller mode Echo canceller tail size

1 3

Use Echo canceller or not Become invalid item 84-12-20 is set to Disable Non-Linear processing mode Become invalid item 84-12-22 is set to Disable if if

84-12-22 84-12-23

Echo canceller nlp mode

1 70

Echo canceller nlp noise

84-12-24 84-12-25 84-12-26

Echo canceller cng cfg Echo canceller 4w det TX Gain

0 0 10

Become invalid item 84-12-22 is set to Disable

if

84-12-27

RX Gain

84-12-28

Audio Capability Priority

84-12-29 Echo Canceler config Type

The option selected here determines what other options are applied from this program. Select the Echo Canceller config Type by type no. of 84-17.

84-12-30

Auto Gain Control

Programming Manual

- 398 -

IN SA SB
Conditions None

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-12: H.323 Phone CODEC Information Basic Setup

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-12 (H.323 Phone CODEC Information Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 12

84-12-01 G711 Aud Frame 3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-12-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 399 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-13: SIP Trunk CODEC Information Basic Setup Description
Use Program 84-13 : SIP Trunk CODEC Information Basic Setup to define the data of SIP Trunk.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-13-01 84-13-02 Item Number of G711 Audio Frame G.711 VAD Mode Input Data 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : A-law 1 : -law 0-145ms 0-145ms 0-145ms 2-8 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 4 : 40ms 5 : 50ms 6 : 60ms 7 : 70ms 8 : 80ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 1 : 30ms 2 : 60ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 1 : static 2 : adaptive during silence 3 : adaptive immediately Default 2 0 Description Maximum number of G711 Audio Frame Define whether the silence detection enables on G711 or not Set the type of G711 (A-law or -law) Set the minimum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer

84-13-03 84-13-04 84-13-05 84-13-06 84-13-07

G.711 Type G.711 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (max.) Number of G729 Audio Frame

0 30 60 120 3

84-13-08 84-13-09 84-13-10 84-13-11 84-13-12 84-13-13 84-13-14 84-13-15 84-13-16 84-13-17

G.729 VAD Mode G.729 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (max.) Number of G723 Audio Frame G.723 VAD Mode G.723 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (max.) Jitter Buffer Mode

0 30 60 120 1 0 30 60 120 3 Maximum number of G723 Audio Frame Set the minimum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the mode of Jitter Buffer Set the minimum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer

Programming Manual

- 400 -

IN SA SB
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-13-18

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-13: SIP Trunk CODEC Information Basic Setup
Item VAD threshold Input Data 0-30 (-20dB.+10dB) 0 : -20dB(-50dBm) 1 : -19dB(-49dBm) : 20 : 0 dB(-30dBm) : 29 : 9 dB(-21dBm) 30 : 10dB(-20dBm) 5000-7000 (-5000..-7000dBm) 5000 : -5000dBm : 7000 : -7000dBm 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 1 : 8ms 2 : 16ms 3 : 32ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 40-70 (-40 .-70) 40 : -40dBm : 70 : -70dBm 0adaptive 1fixed 0Disable 1Enable 0-28 (-14dbm..+14dbm) 0-14dBm 1-13dBm : 14 0dBm : 2713dBm 2814dBm 0G711_PT 1G723_PT 2G729_PT 0 : Auto(Type 4 or Type 5) 1 : Type1 2 : Type2 3 : Type3 0-5 96-127 0 : Disable 1 : RFC2833 Default 20 Description Threshold of silence detection Change Value based -30 Become invalid item if item 03 is set to Disable

84-13-19

Idle Noise Level

7000

Noise Level of Silence

84-13-20 84-13-21

Echo canceller mode Echo canceller tail size

1 3

Use Echo canceller or not Become invalid item 84-12-20 is set to Disable Non-Linear processing mode Become invalid item 84-12-22 is set to Disable if if

84-13-22 84-13-23

Echo canceller nlp mode

1 70

Echo canceller nlp noise

84-13-24 84-13-25 84-13-26

Echo canceller cng cfg Echo canceller 4w det TX Gain

0 0 10

Become invalid item 84-12-22 is set to Disable

if

84-13-27

RX Gain

84-13-28

Audio Capability Priority

84-13-29 Echo Canceler config Type

The option selected here determines what other options are applied from this program. Select the Echo Canceller config Type by type no. of 84-17.

84-13-30 84-13-31 84-13-32

Auto Gain Control DTMF Payload Number DTMF Relay Mode

0 110 0 Payload Number for DTMF Set the DTMF Mode

- 401 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-13: SIP Trunk CODEC Information Basic Setup
Conditions None

IN SA SB

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-13 (SIP Trunk CODEC Information Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 13

84-13-01 G711 Aud Frame3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-13-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 402 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-14: SIP Trunk Basic Information Setup

Description
Use Program 84-14 : SIP Trunk Basic Information Setup to define the data of SIP Trunk.

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-14-01 84-14-02 84-14-03 84-14-04 84-14-05 84-14-06 84-14-07 84-14-08 84-14-09 Item INVITE ReTx Count Request ReTx Count Response ReTx Count Request ReTx Start time Request Max ReTx Interval SIP Trunk Port Number Session Timer Value Minimum Value Session Timer Input Data 0-255 0-255 0-255 0-65535 (0ms-6553500ms) 0-65535 (0ms-6553500ms) 1-65535 0-65535 s (0...No setting) 0-65535 s 0 : Request URI 1 : TO Header Default 7 11 7 5: 500ms 40 : 4000ms 5060 0 1800 0 Description *Set the Repeat count for INVITE Message. *Set the Repeat count for Request Message except INVITE. *Set the Repeat count for Response Message. *Set the Repeat Start Time for Request Message. *Set the Max. Repeat duration for Request Message. Set the Port Number for SIP Trunk.

Called Party Info

* Use for SIP Extension too.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-14 (SIP Trunk Basic Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 14

84-14-01 INVITE RetCnt7


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-14-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 403 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-15: H.323/SIP Phone Keep Alive Setup Description
Use Program 84-15 : H.323/SIP Phone Keep Alive Setup to define the Keep Alive Configuration data of H.323/SIP Phone.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-15-01 84-15-02 84-15-03 84-15-04 Item Registration Info Automatic Deletion (Use for H.323 only) Keep Alive Message Interval Keep Alive Message Timeout Keep Alive Timeout Input Data 0Disable 1Enable 1-10 min 1-10 sec 1-5 times Default 0 1 5 3 Sending Interval for Ping (System-> H.323 Terminal) Waiting time for Ping Answer. (H.323 Terminal-> System) Description

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-15 (H.323/SIP Phone Keep Alive Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 15

84-15-01 AutoDel

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-15-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 404 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-16: VoIPU Limiter Control Gain Setup

Description
Use Program 84-16 : .VoIPU Limiter Control Gain Setup to define the Limiter Control Gain Configuration of VoIPU.

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-16-01 RX limiter control gain 0-30 (-15dbm +15dbm) 0 : -15 dBm : 15 : 0 dBm : 30 : 15 dBm gain gain ~ 15 (0dB) 15 (0dB) Item Input Data Default Description This option controls the limiter gain for IP to PCM direction. This option adds gain to the voice input from the LAN and removes it from the voice output to highway. This option controls the limiter gain for PCM to IP direction. This option adds the gain to the voice input from highway and removes it from the voice output to the LAN. This option controls the limiter gain for a Trunk call in the IP to PCM direction. This option controls the limiter gain for a Trunk call in the PCM to IP direction.

84-16-02 TX limiter control gain

84-16-03

RX limiter control (for Analogue Trunk) TX limiter control (for Analogue Trunk)

15 (0dB) 15 (0dB)

84-16-04

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-16 (VoIPU Limiter Control Gain Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 16

84-16-01 RX LMT Gain 15


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-16-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. - 405 Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-17: VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 84-17 : VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup to setup the Echo Canceller Control Configuration of VoIPU.

Input Data
1 : Type 1 2 : Type 2 3 : Type 3 4 : Type 4 (for Analog Trunk) 5 : Type 5 (for Digital Trunk)

Type

Prog. No. 84-17-01 84-17-02 84-17-03

Item Echo canceller mode Echo canceller tail size Echo canceller nlp mode

Input Data 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 1 : 8ms 2 : 16ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0adaptive 1fixed 40-70 (-40 .-70) 40 : -40dBm : 70 : -70dBm 0:+ 1:0-32768 (Item06=0:0-32767 Item06=1: 0-32768) 0-32767 0 : Disable 1 : Enable

Default 1 2 0 : (type1-3) 1 : (type4) 0 : (type5) 0 60

Description Use Echo canceller or not Become invalid item if 84-17-01 is set to Disable Non-Linear processing mode Become invalid item if 84-17-03 is set to Disable Become invalid item if 84-17-04 is set to Disable

84-17-04 84-17-05

Echo canceller cng cfg

Echo canceller nlp noise

84-17-06 84-17-07

NLP Aggressiveness Control NLP Aggressiveness Control value NLP comfort noise configuration Echo canceller 4w det

1 11000 NLP intensity.

84-17-08

Set the comfort Noise (Pink or White Noise) 0 is Pink Noise.

84-17-09

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Programming Manual

- 406 -

IN SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-17: VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-17 (VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 17

84-17-01 Type1 EC Mode 1


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-17-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Protocol Type number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 407 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-18: VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup Description

MF SA SB

Use Program 84-18 : VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup to setup the Echo Canceller Control Configuration of VoIPU.

Input Data
1 : Type 1 2 : Type 2 3 : Type 3 4 : Type 4 (for Analog Trunk) 5 : Type 5 (for Digital Trunk)

Type

Prog. No. 84-18-01 84-18-02 84-18-03 84-18-04 84-18-05

Item NLP Level configuraion Coeff_control Auto update control Search Freeze control (Debug) MIPS Agent control

Input Data 0 : OFF 1 : ON 0 : keep 1 : reset 0 : ON 1 : OFF 0 : freeze 1 : execute 0 : execute 1 : freeze

Default 0 0 0 1 0

Description

Auto update MIPS Optimization control

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-18 (VoIPU Echo Canceller Control Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 18

84-18-01 Type1 NLP Level cfg 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-18-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Select the Protocol Type number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 408 -

MF SA SB

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-19: SIP Extension CODEC Information Basic Setup

Description
Use Program 84-19 : SIP Extension CODEC Information Basic Setup to define the data of SIP Extension.

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-19-01 84-19-02 Item Number of G711 Audio Frame G.711 VAD Mode Input Data 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0 : A-law 1 : -law 0-145ms 0-145ms 0-145ms 2-8 2 : 20ms 3 : 30ms 4 : 40ms 5 : 50ms 6 : 60ms 7 : 70ms 8 : 80ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 1 : 30ms 2 : 60ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 0-500ms 0-500ms 0-500ms 1 : static 2 : adaptive during silence 3 : adaptive immediately Default 3 0 Description Maximum number of G711 Audio Frame Define whether the silence detection enables on G711 or not Set the type of G711 (A-law or -law) Set the minimum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.711 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.711 Jitter Buffer

84-19-03 84-19-04 84-19-05 84-19-06 84-19-07

G.711 Type G.711 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.711 Jitter Buffer (max.) Number of G729 Audio Frame

0 30 60 120 3

84-19-08 84-19-09 84-19-10 84-19-11 84-19-12 84-19-13 84-19-14 84-19-15 84-19-16 84-19-17

G.729 VAD Mode G.729 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.729 Jitter Buffer (max.) Number of G723 Audio Frame G.723 VAD Mode G.723 Jitter Buffer (min.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (typ.) G.723 Jitter Buffer (max.) Jitter Buffer Mode

0 30 60 120 1 0 30 60 120 3 Maximum number of G723 Audio Frame Set the minimum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.723 Jitter Buffer Set the mode of Jitter Buffer Set the minimum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the average value of G.729 Jitter Buffer Set the maximum value of G.729 Jitter Buffer

- 409 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-19: SIP Extension CODEC Information Basic Setup
Input Data(Contd)
Prog. No. 84-19-18 Item VAD threshold Input Data 0-30 (-20dB.+10dB) 0 : -20dB(-50dBm) 1 : -19dB(-49dBm) : 20 : 0 dB(-30dBm) : 29 : 9 dB(-21dBm) 30 : 10dB(-20dBm) 5000-7000 (-5000..-7000dBm) 5000 : -5000dBm : 7000 : -7000dBm 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 1 : 8ms 2 : 16ms 3 : 32ms 0 : Disable 1 : Enable 40-70 (-40 .-70) 40 : -40dBm : 70 : -70dBm 0adaptive 1fixed 0Disable 1Enable 0-28 (-14dbm..+14dbm) 0-14dBm 1-13dBm : 14 0dBm : 2713dBm 2814dBm 0G711_PT 1G723_PT 2G729_PT 0 : Auto(Type 4 or Type 5) 1 : Type1 2 : Type2 3 : Type3 0-5 96-127 Default 20 Description

MF SA SB

Threshold of silence detection Change Value based -30 Become invalid item if item 03 is set to Disable

84-19-19

Idle Noise Level

7000

Noise Level of Silence

84-19-20 84-19-21

Echo canceller mode Echo canceller tail size

1 3

Use Echo canceller or not Become invalid item 84-12-20 is set to Disable Non-Linear processing mode Become invalid item 84-12-22 is set to Disable if if

84-19-22 84-19-23

Echo canceller nlp mode

1 70

Echo canceller nlp noise

84-19-24 84-19-25 84-19-26

Echo canceller cng cfg Echo canceller 4w det TX Gain

0 0 10

Become invalid item 84-12-22 is set to Disable

if

84-19-27

RX Gain

84-19-28

Audio Capability Priority

84-19-29 Echo Canceler config Type

The option selected here determines what other options are applied from this program. Select the Echo Canceller config Type by type no. of 84-17.

84-19-30 84-19-31

Auto Gain Control DTMF Payload Number

0 110 Payload Number for DTMF

Programming Manual

- 410 -

MF SA SB
Conditions None

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-19: SIP Extension CODEC Information Basic Setup

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-19 (SIP Extension CODEC Information Basic Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 19

84-19-01 G711 Aud Frame3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-19-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 411 -

Programming Manual

Program 84: Hardware Setup for VoIP


84-20: SIP Extension Basic Information Setup Description
Use Program 84-20 : SIP Extension Basic Information Setup to define the Basic data of SIP Extension.

MF SA SB

Input Data
Prog. No. 84-20-01 84-20-02 Item Registrar/Proxy Port Session Timer Value 0s 0-65535 84-20-03 Minimum Session Timer Value Input Data 1-65535 Default 5070 Description Set a port number to await Registrar/Proxy. Session Timer Value. 0 means not using a timer. The recommendation value in the case of using a timer is 1800s or more, and surely set up a larger value than the 84-20-03 Session Timers minimum value. Minimum Session Timer Value. This timer is used when the setting value of 84-20-02 is except "0." The initial value (1800) of this timer is a recommendation value. As calling information in a SIP Invite message, it sets up whether Request URI is used or TO header is used. The Calling effective time is set up when an Expires header does not exist in the Invite message. When there is no cutting request from a caller for exceeding this timer, the call is terminated.

180 0 : Request URI 1 : TO Header 0-256 60

84-20-04

Called Party Info

84-20-05

Expire Value of Invite

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 84-20 (SIP Extension Basic Information Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 84 20

84-20-01 Re/Pr Port

5070

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

84-20-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section. Programming Manual

- 412 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-01: Installation Date

Description
Use Program 90-01 : Installation Date to define the installation date of system.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-01-01 90-01-02 90-01-03 Item Year Month Day Input Data 00-99 01-12 01-31 Default 00No setting 00No setting 00No setting Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-01 (Installation Date): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter90 01

90-01-01 Install Year 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 413 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-02: Setting the Programming Password Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-02 : Setting the Programming Password to set the system passwords. For password entry purposes, the system allows 8 users to be defined. Each user can have a: Unique alphanumeric name (up to 10 alphanumeric characters long. Password entry of up to 8 digits (using 0-9, # and *) Password level The IN level password is used by the System Installer for system programming purposes. The SA or SB level password cannot access the IN level programs. The reverse type (white on black) just beneath the Description heading is the programs access level. You can only use the program if your access level meets or exceeds the level the program requires. (SA level password can access to SA or SB programs, and SB level password can access to SB programs only.)

!! Caution !!
It is NOT recommended to change this data unnecessarily. If the digits are changed and then forgotten, there may be no normal way to enter the program mode again.

Input Data
User Number 1-8

Prog.No. 90-02-01 90-02-02

Item User Name Password Max. 10 characters Up to 8 digits

Input Data

Related Program

90-02-03

User Level

0- Prohibited user 1- MF (Manufacturer level - for NEC-i use only) 2- IN (Installer level) 3- SA (System administrator level 1) 4- SB (System administrator level 2)

Default
User No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 User Name NEC-I TOPAZ ADMIN1 ADMIN2 -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedPassword 12345678 0000 9999 -Not Used-Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedLevel 1 (MF) 2 (IN) 3 (SA) 4 (SB) Level Description Blocked User (Manufacturer programming access only) Installer Level - Access to all programs this manual System Administrator Level 1 Restricted access System Administrator Level 2 - More restricted access

Conditions
Two extensions can be in the programming mode.

Programming Manual

- 414 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-02: Setting the Programming Password

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-02 (Setting the Programming Password): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 02

90-02-01 User1 Name -NEC-I


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Select the User number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 415 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-03: Save Data Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-03 : Save Data to save the programmed data on the SRAM and Flash ROM to the Removable Compact Flash Memory. This program should be used after changing the programmed data.

Input Data
[Data Save] : Dial 1 and HOLD key (Press only HOLD key for cancel)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-03 (Save Data): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 03

90-03-01 Data Save


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-03-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 416 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-04: Load Data

Description
Use Program 90-04 : Load Data to load the system data from the inserted Compact Flash Memory to the SRAM and Flash ROM in the system.

Input Data
[Data Load] : Dial 1 and HOLD key (Press only HOLD key for cancel)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-04 (Load Data): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 04

90-04-01 Load Data 3. Enter the number of the item you want to program. 90-04-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 417 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-05: Slot Control Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-05 : Slot Control to close (turn off) or delete (uninstall) circuit boards (slots 1-18). Delete allows you to completely uninstall the PCB. You might want to do this if you want to remove a PCB and plug it into a different slot - and still retain the port assignments. If a different type of interface card is being installed into a slot previously used (example; changing from a BRIU to VOIPU PCB), the slot should be deleted (Menu 1) first before installing the new interface card. Reset allows you to send a reset code.

Input Data
Menu Number 1 : Delete 2 : Reset

Slot Number 1-18 (0 : No Setting)

Conditions When you delete or reset a PCB, you must first remove it from its slot then run Program 90-05. When reusing the slot for another PCB, you must plug the PCB in or reset the system before the system will use the slot again.

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-05 (Slot Control): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 05

90-05-01 Menu 1 Slot Number


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-05-xx Menux xxxxx 4. Select the Menu number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 418 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-06: Trunk Control

Description
Use Program 90-06 : Trunk Control is used for the trunk maintenance. Busy Out lets you block a PCB from placing outgoing calls. Once busied out, none of the ports on the PCB can be used for new calls. Existing calls, however, are not torn down.

Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1-51 1 : Set Busy Out 2 : Reset/Release Busy Out

Menu Number

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-06 (Trunk Control): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 05

90-06-01 Trunk1 Menu


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-06-xx Trunkx xxxxx 4. Select the Menu number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 419 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-07: Extension Control Description
Use Program 90-07 : Extension Control is used for the extension maintenance.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Menu Number 1 : Hardware Reset 2 : Software Reset

Extension Number Up to 4 digits

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-07 (Extension Control): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 07

90-07-01 Ext No.

Menu1

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-07-xx Menux xxxxx 4. Select the Menu number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 420 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-08: System Reset

Description
Use Program 90-08 : System Reset is used to perform a system reset.

Input Data
[System-Reset] : Dial 1 and HOLD key (Press only HOLD key for cancel)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-08 (System Reset): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 08

90-08-01 SYS-Reset 1
3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-08-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 421 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-09: Automatic System Reset Time Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-09 : Automatic System Reset Time to define the time the system will automatically reset.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-09-01 90-09-02 90-09-03 90-09-04 Item Month Day Hour Minute Input Data 00-12(Note 1) 00-31(Note 2) 00-23 00-59 Default 00 00 00 00 Related Program

Note 1. If the Month is set to 00 and Day has been set, the system will automatically be reset every month of

defined day.
Note 2. If the Day is set to 00 and the Time (Hour and Minute) has been set, the system will automatically be

reset every day of defined time.

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-09 (Automatic System Reset Time Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 09

90-09-01 SysReset Month0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-09-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 422 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-10: System Alarm Setup

Description
Use Program 90-10 : System Alarm Setup to assign a status to system alarms. You can designate an alarm as Major or Minor. This program also assigns whether or not the alarm is displayed to a key telephone and whether or not the alarm information is reported to the pre-defined destination.

Input Data
Alarm Number 001-100

Prog.No. 90-10-01 90-10-02

Item Alarm Type Report

Input Data 0 : Not set 1 : Major Alarm 2 : Minor Alarm 0 : Not report (No Auto-Dial) 1 : Report (Auto-Dial)

Related Program

Default
Alarm 1 2 3 Type 2(MIN) 2(MIN) 2(MIN) Report 0 0 0 Note Board Initialization Error Board Installation Error Communication Error between Board and EXIFU Is Used To Advise of.. Initialization Failure or the PCB is defective PCB was unplugged without using the proper procedure. PCB communication failure has occurred. Action Remove and reinstall the PCB. Check the PCB installation. Remove and reinstall the PCB. If RECover message is received in the alarm report, the PCB is good. If not, replace with a new PCB. After unblocking the PCB, if RECover message is received in the alarm report, it is corrected. If not, then replace the system flash card. Check the terminal wiring and reconnect properly. Then unplug and plug in the PCB. If RECover message is received in the alarm report, it is correct. If not, replace the PCB and/or terminal. Check the battery connector. If it is connected correctly, then replace the battery. -

2(MIN)

PCB Program Download Error

Download may have failed because the PCB is blocked(disabled) or the sub -program does not exist on the system flash card. Failure may have occurred because: Terminal blocking detected. Terminal is unplugged. Wire is disconnected. 308 card is defective. RAM backup battery on the 308M PCB is unplugged or defective. -

5 6

0 0

0 0

-Not UsedBlocking (No default setting)

7 8

1(MAJ) 1(MAJ)

0 0

-Not UsedRAM Backup Battery Error -Not Used-

- 423 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-10: System Alarm Setup
Default(Contd)
Alarm 10 11 12 13 14 15 : 29 30 31 : 49 50 51 52 53 : 100 Type 0 0 0 0 0 0 : 0 2(MIN) 0 : 0 1(MAJ) 0 0 0 : 0 Report 0 0 0 0 0 0 : 0 0 0 : 0 0 0 0 0 : 0 Note ISDN Link Error CTI Link Error ACD-MIS Link Error TMR Link Error EXIFU-LAN Link Error -Not Used: TRM output Buffer Full SMDR output Buffer Full -Not Used-Not UsedSystem Start Up System Data Change VM/HD -Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedIs Used To Advise of.. Action

IN SA SB

The SMDR Buffer is Full -

Check the printer for the SMDR. -

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-10 (System Alarm Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 10

90-10-01Alarm1 Alarm Type 2


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-10-xx xxxxx 4. Select the Alarm number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 424 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-11: System Alarm Report Setup

Description
Use Program 90-11 : System Alarm Report to define the details of the system alarm report.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-11-01 Item System Alarm Display Telephone Assign the display KTS port that should receive system alarms. Report Method -Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedSMTP Host Name SMTP Host Port Number To Address Reply Address From Address DNS Primary Address DNS Secondary Address Customer Name Input Data Up to 4 digits 0- No report 1- Auto-Call (by E-mail) to outside Up to 255 characters 0-65535 Up to 255 characters Up to 255 characters Up to 255 characters 0.0.0.0-255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0-255.255.255.255 Up to 255 characters Default No setting

90-11-02 90-11-03 90-11-04 90-11-05 90-11-06 90-11-07 90-11-08 90-11-09 90-11-10 90-11-11 90-11-12 90-11-13

0 No setting 25 No setting No setting No setting 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

- 425 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-11: System Alarm Report Setup Telephone Programming Instructions
To enter data for Program 90-11 (System Alarm Report): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 11

IN SA SB

90-11-01 ALM Disp.TEL


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-11-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 426 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-12: System Alarm Output

Description
Use Program 90-12 : System Alarm Output to set the options for the alarm report. This program has 6 separate menu options. Define the output port to be used as the output for system alarm report and set the system alarm options. The system can have up to 50 reports.

Input Data
Prog.No. Item Output Port Type Indicate the type of connection used for the System Alarms. The baud rate for the COM port should be set in Program 10-21-02. -Not UsedOutput All Alarm Reports Printout New Alarm Reports Clear All Alarm Reports Output Mode Input Data 0 : No setting 1 : COM Port (EXIFU) Print All? (Yes : 1) Print New? (Yes: 1) All Clear? (Yes : 1) 0 : Manual 1 : Auto Default 0 0

90-12-01

90-12-02 90-12-03 90-12-04 90-12-05 90-12-06

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-12 (System Alarm Output): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 12

90-12-01 Output Type

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-12-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 427 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-13: System Information Output Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-13 : System Information Output to define the output port to be used as the system information output. The baud rate for the COM port should be set in Program 10-21-02.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-13-01 90-13-02 90-13-03 Item Output Port Type Indicate the type of connection used for the SMDR. -Not UsedDialing 1 from this program sends the system report to the connected device. Input Data 0No setting 1COM Port (EXIFU) Dial 1 and press HOLD (Press only HOLD key for cancel) Default 0 -

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-13 (System Information Output): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 13

90-13-01 Output Type

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-13-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 428 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-16: Main Software Information

Description
Use Program 90-16 : Main Software Information to display the main software information on the CPU. This information can also be viewed outside of system programming by pressing OPAC Key and Dial 3 then the on any display keyset.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-16-01 Item Version Number Software Release Data Data 01.00 - 99.99 May 22 2004 17:53:46 <PCPro> May 22 04 17:53 <TELPro> Component ASCII Code (5 Byte) ASCII Code (20 Byte) <PCPro> ASCII Code (16 Byte) <TELPro>

90-16-02

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-16 (Main Software Information): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 16

90-16-01 Version No

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-16-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 429 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-17: Firmware Information Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-17 : Firmware Information to display the firmware information on the 308M and other PCBs.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-17-01 90-17-02 90-17-03 90-17-04 90-17-05 90-17-06 90-17-10 90-17-11 90-17-12 90-17-13 Item DSP Firmware Version Number DSPDB Firmware Version Number -Not Used-Not Used-Not UsedBRIU Firmware Version Number TLIU Firmware Version Number DIOPU Firmware Version Number -Not Used-Not UsedData 00.00.00.00 15.15.15.15 00.00.00.00 15.15.15.15 00.00 15.15 00.00 15.15 00.00 15.15 Component BCD Code (2 Byte) BCD Code (2 Byte) BCD Code (1 Byte) BCD Code (1 Byte) BCD Code (1 Byte) -

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-17 (Firmware Information): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 17

90-17-01 DSP . .

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-17-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 430 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-19: Dial Block Release

Description
When the extension number is entered in Program 90-19 : Dial Block Release, the extension will be released from the Dial Block restriction.

Input Data
Extension Number Up to 4 digits

Input Data [CLR Dial Block] : Dial 1 and press HOLD key (Press only HOLD key for cancel)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Toll Restriction

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-19 (Dial Block Release) 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 19

90-19-01 TELxxx CLR Dial Block


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-19-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 431 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-20: Traffic Report Data Setup Description
Use Program 90-20 : Traffic Report Data Setup to define the details of the traffic report.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-20-01 90-20-02 90-20-03 90-20-04 90-20-05 90-20-06 90-20-07 90-20-08 90-20-09 90-20-10 Call Traffic Output -Not UsedAll Line Busy Output DTMF Receiver Busy Output Dial Tone Detector Busy Output Caller-ID Receiver Busy Output Voice Mail Channel All Busy Output -Not UsedAttendant Channel All Busy Output Base Station All Busy Output Item Input Data 0 : Not measured 1 : Measured 0 : Not detected 1-256 : (Report when the data is reached to the defined value) Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Traffic Management Reporting(TMS)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-20 (Traffic Report Data Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 20

90-20-01 Call Traffic 0


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-20-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 432 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-21: Traffic Report Output

Description
Use Program 90-21 : Traffic Report Output to define the output port to be used as the traffic report output.

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-21-01 Output port type Item Input Data 0 : No setting 1 : COM port(EXIFU) Default 0

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


Traffic Management Reporting(TMS)

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-21 (Traffic Report Output): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 21

90-21-01 Output Port

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-21-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 433 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-23: Deleting Registration of IP Telephones Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-23 : Deleting Registration of IP Telephones to delete the registered IP telephone from the system.

Input Data
Extension Number Up to 4 digits

Input Data [Del.IP-Phone] : Dial 1 and press HOLD key (Press only HOLD key for cancel)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-23 (Deleting Registration of IP Telephones) 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 23

90-23-01 TEL Del.IP-Phone


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-23-xx TELxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Extension number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 434 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-24: System Alarm Report Notification Time Setup

Description
Use Program 90-24 : System Alarm Report Notification Time Setup to set up when the alarm report will print..

Input Data
Prog.No. 90-24-01 90-24-02 90-24-03 90-24-04 Item Month Day Hour Minute Input Data 00-12(0 : disabled) 00-31 00-23 00-59 Default 00 00 00 00 Related Program

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-24 (System Alarm Report Notification Time Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 24

90-24-01 Month

Noti

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-24-xx Notixx xxxxx 4. Select the Notification number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 435 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-25: System Alarm Report CC Mail Setup Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 90-25 : System Alarm Report CC Mail Setup to define the mail address to receive the system alarm report CC Mail setup.

Input Data
CC Number 1-5

Prog.No. 90-25-01 CC Mail Address

Item

Input Data Up to 255 characters

Default No setting

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-25 (System Alarm Report CC Mail Setup): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 25

90-25-01 Address

CC No1

3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-25-xx xxxxx 4. Select the CC number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 436 -

IN SA SB

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-26: System Data Programming Level Assignment

Description
Use Program 90-26 : System Data Programming Level Setup to define the programming access level of each command.

Input Data
Program Number 1001-9201

Prog.No.

Item Maintenance Level

Input Data 1 : MF(Manufacturing Level) 2 : IN(Installer Level) 3 : SA(System Administrator A) 4 : SB(System Administrator B)

Default Refer to each header of Programming Manual

90-26-01

Conditions You can only set a level equal or lower than the level you are logged on. e.g. if you log on as installer you can not set any to manufacturer level.

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-26 (System Data Programming Level Assignment): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 26

90-26-01 PRG1001 Maintenance LVL3


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-26-xx PRGxxxx xxxxx 4. Select the Program number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

- 437 -

Programming Manual

Program 90: Maintenance Program


90-30: VoIPU Firmware Information Description
Use Program 90-30 : Firmware Information to display the firmware information on the VoIPU.

IN SA SB

Input Data
Slot Number 1-18

Prog.No. 90-30-01 90-30-02 90-30-03

Item Firmware Version Number Long Tail Echo Mode Long Tail Echo CODEC

Display Data 00.00-1.155 0 : Off 1 : On 0 : No setting 1 : G.729 2 : G.723

Default 0 0

Data Format BCD Code(1Byte)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


VoIP

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 90-30(VoIPU Firmware Information): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter 90 26

90-30-01 Slot1 FW Ver. xx.xx


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

90-30-xx Slotxx xxxxx 4. Select the Slot number to be programmed by pressing the FLASH or the VOLUME or VOLUME keys. 5. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 6. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

Programming Manual

- 438 -

IN SA SB

Program92: Copy Program


92-01: Copy Command

Description
Use Program 92-01 : Copy Program to copy the data for one program to another keyset, port, group, etc. Refer to the following charts to see which programs which can be copied.

Input Data
Program Number xx-xx

Prog.No. 92-01-01

Item Source Number Enter the extension, trunk, group, etc.. from which the data will be copied. Destination Number (From) Enter the first extension, trunk, group, etc. number to which the information is to be copied. Destination Number (To) Enter the last extension, trunk, group, etc. number to which the information is to be copied. If the information is only be copied to one extension, trunk, group, etc., enter the information entered in the Destination Number (From) entry.

Input Data In case of Trunk Base . Trunk Port Number 1-51 In case of Trunk Group Base. Trunk Group Number 1-25 In case of Extension Base. Extension Number (Up to 4 digits) In case of Department Group Base. Department Group Number 1-32 In case of DSS. DSS Console Number 1-9

92-01-02

92-01-03

Note) Copy Program is applicable only for the following programs. 1. Trunk Port Base
Prog.No. 14-01 14-02 14-04 14-08 14-09 21-03 21-12 22-02 22-03 22-05 22-08 31-05 Program Name Trunk Basic Data Setup Analogue Trunk Data Setup Behind PBX Setup Music on Hold Source for Trunks Conversation Recording Destination for Trunk Trunk Group Routing for Trunks ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunk Incoming Service Type Setup Trunk Ring Tone Setup IRG Assignment for Normal Ring Trunk Second IRG Setup for unanswered DIL / IRG Incoming Ring Tone Audible on External Speaker Note Copy all data except Trunk Name (14-01-01)

- 439 -

Programming Manual

Program 92: Copy Program


92-01: Copy Command
2. Trunk Group Base
Prog.No. 35-03 Program Name SMDR Port Assignment for Trunk Group Note

IN SA SB

3. Extension Base
Prog.No. 15-01 15-02 15-03 15-06 15-07 15-08 15-09 15-10 15-11 15-12 20-06 21-02 21-04 21-11 23-03 23-04 24-03 31-02 Program Name Extension Basic Data Setup (include Virtual Extension) Multi-Line Telephone Basic Data Setup Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup Trunk Access Map for Extension Programmable Function Key Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup Virtual Extension Ring Assignment Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment Conversation Recording Destination for Extension Class of Service for Extension Trunk Group Routing for Extensions Toll Restriction Class for Extensions Hotline Assignment Ringing Line Preference Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions Park Group Assignment Internal Paging Group Assignment Note Copy all data except extension name(15-01-01)

4. Department Group Base


Prog.No. 16-01 35-04 Program Name Department (Extension) Group Basic Data Setup SMDR Port Assignment for Department Group Note Copy all data except Group Name (16-01-01).

Programming Manual

- 440 -

IN SA SB
5. DSS Console Base
Prog.No. 30-03 Program Name DSS Key Assignment

Program92: Copy Program


92-01: Copy Command

Note

Conditions Using this program to copy a keysets Programmable Function Keys will copy all the keys whether they exist on the phone to which the programming is being copied. This may cause confusion when trying to define a key which is already defined but which doesnt exist on the phone (will display as DUPLICATE DATA). It is recommend to either clear these non-existent keys or to only copy from an extension which has the same or fewer number of keys than the extension to which the programming is being copied.

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 92-01 (Copy Command): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter92 01

92-01-01 Copy Func.


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

92-01-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section

- 441 -

Programming Manual

Program 92: Copy Program


92-02: Delete All Extension Number Description

IN SA SB

Use Program 92-02 : Delete All Extension Number to delete all extension numbers(PRG11-02,PRG11-04), However, the extension number of first port is not deleted.

Input Data
[Ext No. Del YES:1] Press Dial 1 + HOLD Key. (Only Press HOLD key is canceled.)

Conditions None

Feature Cross Reference


None

Telephone Programming Instructions


To enter data for Program 92-02 (Delete All Extension Number): 1. Enter the programming mode. 2. Enter92 02

92-02-01 Ext No. Del


3. Enter the number of the item you want to program.

92-02-xx xxxxx 4. Enter data for the item you selected + HOLD. 5. Enter data for the next item in the program. OR Press DC once to enter a new item number. OR Press DC until youve exited that seriess programming section.

Programming Manual

- 442 -

- For your Notes -

Programming Manual

Programming Manual

Issue-1a July. 2004

You might also like